GRL100B 6F2S0835 2.7
GRL100B 6F2S0835 2.7
GRL100B 6F2S0835 2.7
INSTRUCTION MANUAL
LINE DIFFERENTIAL RELAY
GRL100 - B
( Ver. 2.7 )
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Safety Precautions
Before using this product, please read this chapter carefully.
This chapter describes the safety precautions recommended when using the GRL100. Before
installing and using the equipment, this chapter must be thoroughly read and understood.
DANGER
WARNING
CAUTION
CAUTION
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
DANGER
Current transformer circuit
Never allow the current transformer (CT) secondary circuit connected to this equipment to be
opened while the primary system is live. Opening the CT circuit will produce a dangerously high
voltage.
WARNING
Exposed terminals
Do not touch the terminals of this equipment while the power is on, as the high voltage generated
is dangerous.
Residual voltage
Hazardous voltage can be present in the DC circuit just after switching off the DC power supply.
It takes approximately 30 seconds for the voltage to discharge.
Fiber optic
Invisible laser radiation
Do not view directly with optical instruments.
Class 1M laser product (Transmission distance: 30km class)
- the maximum output of laser radiation:
0.2 mW
79.2 ns
1310 nm
CAUTION
Earth
The earthing terminal of the equipment must be securely earthed.
CAUTION
Operating environment
The equipment must only used within the range of ambient temperature, humidity and dust
detailed in the specification and in an environment free of abnormal vibration.
Ratings
Before applying AC voltage and current or the DC power supply to the equipment, check that
they conform to the equipment ratings.
Printed circuit board
Do not attach and remove printed circuit boards when the DC power to the equipment is on, as
this may cause the equipment to malfunction.
External circuit
When connecting the output contacts of the equipment to an external circuit, carefully check the
supply voltage used in order to prevent the connected circuit from overheating.
Connection cable
Carefully handle the connection cable without applying excessive force.
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Modification
Do not modify this equipment, as this may cause the equipment to malfunction.
Short-bar
Do not remove a short-bar which is mounted at the terminal block on the rear of the relay before
shipment, as this may cause the performance of this equipment such as withstand voltage, etc., to
reduce.
Tripping circuit connections
Must connect the FD (Fault Detector) output contact with A- to C-phase tripping output contacts
in series in case of the model 400 and 500 series.
Disposal
This product does not contain expendable supplies nor parts that can be recycled. When
disposing of this product, do so in a safe manner according to local regulations.
This product contains a lithium-ion battery, which should be removed at the end-of-life of the
product. The battery must be recycled or disposed of in accordance with local regulations. The
battery can be removed by withdrawing the Signal Processing module (SPM) from the relay
case, and cutting the connecting leads and plastic strap which hold the battery.
Plastics material
This product contains the following plastics material.
- ABS, Polycarbonate, Acrylic resins
(SJ/T11364-2006)
/
The Mark and Information are applicable for People's Republic of China only.
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Contents
Safety Precautions
1.
Introduction
2.
Application Notes
12
2.1
2.2
13
14
14
14
15
16
17
19
19
25
27
28
30
30
32
41
45
47
49
52
55
58
61
61
63
80
81
81
82
Protection Schemes
Current Differential Protection
2.2.1 Operation of Current Differential Protection
2.2.2 Segregated-phase Current Differential Protection
2.2.3 Zero-phase Current Differential Protection
2.2.4 Fail-safe Function
2.2.5 Remote Differential Trip
2.2.6 Transmission Data
2.2.7 Synchronized Sampling
2.2.8 Charging Current Compensation
2.2.9 Blind Zone Protection
2.2.10 Application to Three-terminal Lines
2.2.11 Dual Communication Mode
2.2.12 Application to One-and-a-half Breaker Busbar System
2.2.13 Setting
2.3 Overcurrent Backup Protection
2.4 Transfer Trip Function
2.5 Out-of-step Protection
2.6 Thermal Overload Protection
2.7 Breaker Failure Protection
2.8 Tripping Output
2.9 Fault Detector
2.10 Autoreclose
2.10.1 Application
2.10.2 Scheme Logic
2.10.3 Autoreclose Output Signals
2.11 Characteristics of Measuring Elements
2.11.1 Segregated-phase Current Differential Element DIF and DIFSV
2.11.2 Zero-phase Current Differential Element DIFG
2.11.3 Inverse Definite Minimum Time (IDMT) Overcurrent Element OCI and
EFI
2.11.4 Thermal Overload Element
2.11.5 Out-of-Step Element OST
2.11.6 Voltage and Synchronism Check Elements OVL, UVL, OVB, UVB and
SYN
2.11.7 Current change detection element OCD
2.11.8 Level Detectors
2.11.9 Fault Detector Elements
83
84
84
85
86
86
86
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
2.12 Communication System
2.12.1 Signaling Channel
2.12.2 Linking to Communication Circuit
2.12.3 Setup of Communication Circuit
2.12.4 Telecommunication Channel Monitoring
2.13 Fault Locator
2.13.1 Application
2.13.2 Calculation of Distance to Fault
2.13.3 Starting Calculation
2.13.4 Fault Location Display
2.13.5 Setting
3.
Technical Description
102
3.1
102
102
109
110
111
116
118
119
119
122
122
123
123
123
124
125
126
126
126
126
126
127
128
128
129
129
130
131
133
3.2
3.3
3.4
3.5
4.
89
89
90
91
94
95
95
96
98
98
98
Hardware Description
3.1.1 Outline of Hardware Modules
3.1.2 Transformer Module
3.1.3 Signal Processing and Communication Module
3.1.4 Binary Input and Output Module
3.1.5 Human Machine Interface (HMI) Module
3.1.6 Fault Detector Module
Input and Output Signals
3.2.1 Input Signals
3.2.2 Binary Output Signals
3.2.3 PLC (Programmable Logic Controller) Function
Automatic Supervision
3.3.1 Basic Concept of Supervision
3.3.2 Relay Monitoring
3.3.3 CT Circuit Current Monitoring
3.3.4 CT Circuit Failure Detection
3.3.5 Differential Current (Id) Monitoring
3.3.6 Telecommunication Channel Monitoring
3.3.7 GPS Signal Reception Monitoring (For GPS-mode only)
3.3.8 Relay Address Monitoring
3.3.9 Disconnector Monitoring
3.3.10 Failure Alarms
3.3.11 Trip Blocking
3.3.12 Setting
Recording Function
3.4.1 Fault Recording
3.4.2 Event Recording
3.4.3 Disturbance Recording
Metering Function
User Interface
134
4.1
134
134
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
4.2
4.3
4.4
4.5
4.6
5.
6.
136
138
138
141
143
147
151
152
174
180
180
181
181
Installation
182
5.1
5.2
5.3
5.4
5.5
Receipt of Relays
Relay Mounting
Electrostatic Discharge
Handling Precautions
External Connections
182
182
182
182
183
185
6.1
6.2
185
186
186
186
187
188
188
189
190
191
192
192
209
211
212
212
213
213
213
213
216
216
216
218
6.3
6.4
6.5
6.6
6.7
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
6.7.4 Resumption of Service
6.7.5 Storage
7.
220
220
221
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Appendix A Block Diagram
223
227
255
257
269
279
287
299
321
325
331
343
347
351
357
359
363
377
383
Appendix T Ordering
385
The data given in this manual are subject to change without notice. (Ver.2.7)
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
1. Introduction
The GRL100 provides high-speed phase-segregated current differential protection for use with
telecommunication systems, and ensures high reliability and security for diverse faults including
single-phase and multi-phase faults and double-faults on double-circuit lines, evolving faults
and high-impedance earth faults.
The GRL100 is used as a main protection for the following two- or three-terminal lines in EHV
or HV networks:
Overhead lines or underground cables
The GRL100 can be used for lines associated with one-and-a-half busbar arrangement as well as
single or double busbar arrangement.
Furthermore, in addition to current differential protection, the GRL100 provides overcurrent backup,
thermal overload, out-of-step and breaker failure protection.
The GRL100 is a member of the G-series family of numerical relays which utilise common
hardware modules with the common features:
The GRL100 provides the following metering and recording functions.
-
Metering
Fault record
Event record
Fault location
Disturbance record
The GRL100 provides the following menu-driven human interfaces for relay setting or viewing
of stored data.
- Relay front panel; 4 40 character LCD, LED display and operation keys
- Local PC
- Remote PC
Password protection is provided to change settings. Eight active setting groups are provided.
This allows the user to set one group for normal operating conditions while other groups may be
set to cover alternative operating conditions.
GRL100 provides either two or three serial ports, and an IRIG-B port for an external clock
connection. A local PC can be connected via the RS232C port on the front panel of the relay.
Either one or two rear ports (RS485 or fibre optic) are provided for connection to a remote PC
and for IEC60870-5-103 communication with a substation control and automation system.
Further, Ethernet LAN port (TCP/IP protocol) can be provided as option.
Further, the GRL100 provides the following functions.
-
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
-
Model 100 has the minimum configuration, having only the segregated phase current differential
protection, overcurrent backup protection scheme and thermal overload protection.
Models 200 through 500 have a full protection scheme including additional high-sensitivity differential
protection for high-impedance earth faults, breaker failure protection, out-of-step protection,
fault locator and autoreclose function. Models 200 and 400 have a single- and multi-shot
autoreclose function and are used for single breaker autoreclose schemes. Models 300 and 500
have only a single-shot autoreclose function and are used for one-and-a-half breaker
(two-breaker) autoreclose schemes. Models 400 and 500 have an independent fault detector in
the form of a check relay, and provide the highest security. Models 503 and 513 have a CT
saturation countermeasure against the external through fault current in one-and-a-half breaker
schemes.
10
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Table 1.1 GRL100 Models
101B
102B
DIF
BU
THM
ARC
301B
302B
401B
501B
503B
1CB
1CB
2CB
2CB
1CB
2CB
2CB
FD
TFC
DIFG
CCC
BF
OST
FL
(b) Three-terminal line application / Dual communication for two-terminal line application
Model
111B
112B
211B, 214B
212B, 216B
311B
312B
411B
511B
513B
DIF
BU
THM
1CB
1CB
2CB
2CB
1CB
2CB
2CB
ARC
FD
TFC
DIFG
CCC
BF
OST
FL
Legend DIF:
BU:
THM:
ARC:
FD:
TFC:
DIFG:
CCC:
BF:
OST:
FL:
11
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
2. Application Notes
GRL100 is applicable to telecommunication systems which employ dedicated optical fibre, 64 kbit/s
multiplexed communication channels or microwave links and provided with the following three
communication mode settings:
A-MODE: applied when the remote terminal relay(s) is an old version of GRL100,
namely the following models.
GRL100-101A/102A/201A/202A/301A/302A/ 401A/501A/503A
GRL100-111A/112A/211A/212A/311A/312A/411A/511A/513A
GRL100-201N
B-MODE: standard operating model which provides relay address monitoring function
and customisation of transmission data. (default)
GPS-MODE: performs synchronised sampling using GPS. (This mode is suited to
applications where the differential relays communicate over modern switched
telecommunication networks such as Synchronous Digital Hierarchy (SDH), etc.)
Table 2.1 shows available functions of each mode. The details of functions are described later.
Table 2.1 Communication Mode and Available Function
Communication Mode [COMMODE]
Function
A-MODE
B-MODE
GPS-based synchronisation
GPS-MODE
Transfer signal
12
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
2.1
Protection Schemes
The GRL100 provides the following protection schemes (Appendix A shows block diagrams of the
GRL100 series):
The GRL100 utilises with the microwave or fibre optic digital telecommunication systems to
transmit instantaneous current values sampled synchronously at each terminal.
13
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
2.2
2.2.2
DIF-A
&
&
82: DIF-A_TRIP
42
DIF-B
&
&
&
&
DIF.FS-B_TP
&
403
84: DIF-C_TRIP
Communication
failure
DIF.FS-C_TP
&
1585 DIF_BLOCK
DIF.FS-A_TP
402
83: DIF-B_TRIP
43
DIF-C
401
&
400
DIF.FS_TRIP
1
1544 CRT_BLOCK
&
43C ON
TELEPROTECTION OFF
(from IEC103 command)
1616 DIF-A_FS
1617 DIF-B_FS
DIF.FS_OP
1618 DIF-C_FS
14
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Tripping output signals can be blocked by the PLC command DIF_BLOCK and CRT_BLOCK.
The output signals of DIF-A, DIF-B and DIF-C are also blocked when a communication circuit
failure is detected by the data error check, sampling synchronism check or interruption of the
receive signals. For DIF-A_FS, DIF-B_FS and DIF-C_FS signals, see Section 2.2.4.
The differential elements DIF have a percentage restraining characteristic with weak restraint in
the small current region and strong restraint in the large current region, to cope with CT
saturation. (For details of the characteristic, see Section 2.11.)
Erroneous current data may be transmitted from the remote terminal when the remote relay is
out-of-service for testing or other purposes. To prevent false operation in this case, the relay sets
the receiving current data to zero in the differential current calculation upon detecting that the
remote terminal is out-of-service.
If the relay is applied to a three-terminal line, the zero setting is performed only for the current
data received from an out-of-service terminal.
Figure 2.2.2.2 shows the remote terminal out-of-service detection logic. The local terminal
detects that the remote terminal is out-of-service by receiving a signal LOCAL TEST which is
transmitted when the scheme switch [L. TEST] is set to "ON" at the terminal under test. As an
alternative means, the local terminal can detect it by using the circuit breaker and disconnector
status signal CBDS-A, B and C transmitted from the remote out-of-service terminal. The signal
CBDS-A is "1" when both the circuit breaker and disconnector are closed. Thus, out-of-service
is detected when either the circuit breaker or disconnector is open in all three phases.
Zero setting of the receive current data is also performed at the terminal under test. If the scheme
switch [L. TEST] is set to "ON" or the signal R.DATA_ZERO is input by PLC, all the receive
current data transmitted from the in-service terminal is set to zero and this facilitates the local
testing. The zero setting of the receive current data is not performed by the alternative way as
mentioned above.
The out-of-service detection logic can be blocked by the scheme switch [OTD].
1623 R.DATA_ZERO
LOCAL_TEST1
Receiving
signal from CBDS-A
Remote
Terminal 1 CBDS-B
&
[Open1]
CBDS-C
(+)
"ON "
[OTD]
(+)
207
REM1_IN_SRV
208
REM1_OFF_SRV
209
REM1_NON_USE
"ON"
2.2.3
15
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
The zero-phase current differential element has a percentage restraining characteristic with weak
restraint. For details of the characteristic, see Section 2.11.
The scheme logic is shown in Figure 2.2.3.1. The output signal of the differential element DIFG
performs time-delayed three-phase tripping of the circuit breaker with the tripping output signal
DIFG.FS_TRIP. DIFG.FS_TRIP can start the incorporated autoreclose function when the
scheme switch [ARC-DIFG] is set to "ON".
Tripping output signal can be blocked by the PLC command DIFG_BLOCK and CRT_BLOCK.
The output signal is also blocked when a communication circuit failure is detected by data error
check, sampling synchronism check or interruption of the receive signals. For DIFG_FS signal,
see Section 2.2.4.
Since the DIFG is used for high-impedance earth fault protection, the DIFG output signal is
blocked when zero-phase current is large as shown in the following equation:
I01 2 pu or I02 2 pu
where,
I01: Scalar summation of zero-phase current at local terminal relay
I02: Scalar summation of zero-phase current at remote terminal relay
pu:
44
&
I012PU
TDIFG
t
0 85
DIFG_TRIP
86
&
&
404
DIFG.FS_TRIP
0.00-10.00s
I022PU
[DIFG]
Communication failure
1586 DIFG_BLOCK
"ON"
43C ON
DIFG.FS_OP
1619 DIFG_FS
2.2.4
Fail-safe Function
GRL100 provides OC1, OCD and EFD elements. These are used for fail-safe to prevent
unnecessary operation caused by error data in communication failure. OC1 is phase overcurrent
element and its sensitivity can be set. OCD is phase current change detection element, and EFD
is zero-sequence current change detection element. Both of the OCD and EFD sensitivities are
fixed. The scheme logic is shown in Figure 2.2.4.1.
The outputs of DIF.FS_OP and DIFG.FS_OP signals are connected to DIF-A_FS, DIF-B_FS,
DIF-C_FS and DIFG_FS respectively by PLC function. These are connected at the default
setting.
The fail-safe functions are disabled by [DIF-FS] and [DIFG-FS] switches. In the [DIF-FS], OC1
or OCD or both elements can be selected. If these switches are set to OFF, the signals of
DIF.FS_OP and DIFG.FS_OP are 1 and the fail-safe is disabled.
16
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
OC1-A
&
409
DIF.FS-A_OP
410
OC1-B
&
OC1-C
&
DIF.FS-B_OP
411
DIF.FS-C_OP
412
DIFG.FS_OP
OCD-A
408
DIF.FS_OP
DIF-A_FS
DIF-B_FS
DIF-C_FS
(see Fig. 2.2.2.1.)
&
OCD-B
&
OCD-C
&
[DIF-FS]
"OC"
"OCD"
"BOTH"
"OFF"
EFD
&
DIFG_FS
(see Fig. 2.2.3.1.)
[DIFG-FS]
"ON"
"OFF"
2.2.5
GRL100
GRL100
The remote differential trip (RDIF) function enables the disabled terminal to trip by receiving a
trip command from the sound terminal, which continues to perform current differential
protection.
17
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Figure 2.2.5.2(a) and (b) show the RDIF scheme logic at RDIF command sending terminal (=
sound terminal) and command receiving terminal (= disabled terminal). The sound terminal
sends the command when the tripping signals RDIF-A-S, RDIF-B-S, RDIF-C-S or RDIF-S are
output locally and the scheme switches [RDIF] and [TERM] are set to ON and 3-TERM
respectively. The RDIF command is sent to the remote terminal via the 64kb/s digital link
together with other data and signals.
The receiving terminal outputs a local three-phase trip signal RDIF-TRIP under the conditions
that when the command RDIF1 or RDIF2 is received from either of the remote terminals, local
differential protection does not operate, the scheme switches [RDIF] and [TERM] are set to
ON and 3-TERM respectively and no communication channel failure exists in the channel
which received the RDIF command.
When the RDIF function is applied, the command sending signals and receiving signals must be
assigned by PLC function.
DIF-A_TRIP
DIF-B_TRIP
DIF-C_TRIP
DIF-G_TRIP
&
&
&
451
RDIF-A-S
452
RDIF-B-S
453
RDIF-C-S
454
&
RDIF-S
RDIF_ON
Receiving
signal from
Remote
Terminal 1
1684 RDIF-A-R1
&
&
1685 RDIF-B-R1
&
&
&
&
1
1649 RDIF_3PTP
1716 RDIF-A-R2
1717 RDIF-B-R2
1718 RDIF-C-R2
1
1624 RDIF-A_FS
1719 RDIF-R2
1625 RDIF-B_FS
DIF elements not operated
&
43C ON
DIF.FS_OP
1626 RDIF-C_FS
[TERM]
3-TERM
&
RDIF_ON
[RDIF]
+
RD.FS-B TP
ON
18
RD.FS-C TP
RD.FS_TRIP
455
&
1598 RDIF_BLOCK
1
1
1687 RDIF-R1
RD.FS-A TP
1686 RDIF-C-R1
Receiving
signal from
Remote
Terminal 2
1
457 RD.FS-B_ TRIP
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
2.2.6
Transmission Data
The following data are transmitted to the remote terminal via the 64kb/s digital link. The data
depends on the communication mode and whether a function is used or not. The details are
shown in Appendix N.
A-phase current
B-phase current
C-phase current
Residual current
Positive sequence voltage
A-phase differential element output signal
B-phase differential element output signal
C-phase differential element output signal
A-phase breaker and disconnector status
B-phase breaker and disconnector status
C-phase breaker and disconnector status
Scheme switch [LOCAL TEST] status
Scheme switch [TFC] status
Reclose block command
Sampling synchronization control signal
Synchronized test trigger signal
User configurable data
Current and voltage data are instantaneous values which are sampled every 30 electrical degrees
(12 times per cycle) and consist of eleven data bits and one sign bit. This data is transmitted
every sample to the remote terminal.
Three differential element outputs and the transfer trip command are related to remote terminal
tripping and are transmitted every sampling interval.
Other data is transmitted once every power cycle.
The data transmission format and user configurable data are also shown in Appendix N.
A synchronized test trigger signal is used to test the differential protection simultaneously at all
terminals. For details, see Section 6.5.3.
In addition to the above data, cyclic redundancy check bits and fixed check bits are transmitted to
monitor the communication channel. If a channel failure is detected at the local terminal, all the
local and remote current and voltage data at that instant are set to zero and outputs of the
differential protection and out-of-step protection are blocked, and these protections of remote
terminal are also blocked because the channel failure is also detected at the remote terminal.
2.2.7
Synchronized Sampling
The GRL100 performs synchronized simultaneous sampling at all terminals of the protected
line. Two methods are applied for the sampling synchronization; intra-system synchronization
and GPS-based synchronization. The former is applied to communication modes A-MODE and
19
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
B-MODE, and the latter is applied to GPS-MODE.
The intra-system synchronization keeps the sampling timing error between the terminals within
10s or 20s and the GPS-based system keeps it within 5s or 10s for two- or
three-terminal applications.
In both methods, the sampling synchronization is realized through timing synchronization
control and sampling address synchronization control. These controls are performed once every
two power cycles.
2.2.7.1
To perform timing synchronization for the slave terminal, the sampling time difference between
master and slave terminals is measured. The measurement principle of the sampling time
difference T is indicated in Figure 2.2.7.1. The master terminal and slave terminal perform
their own sampling and send a signal that becomes the timing reference for the other terminal.
Td2
TM
Master
terminal
Sampling
timing
Slave
terminal
t
Td1
TF
Each terminal measures the time TM and TF from its own sampling instant to the arrival of the
signal from the other terminal. As is evident from the figure, the times TM and TF can be
obtained by equation (1) and (2) where Td1 and Td2 are the transmission delay of the channel in
each direction. The sampling time difference T can be obtained from the resulting equation (3).
TM = Td1 T
(1)
TF = Td2 + T
(2)
(3)
The slave terminal advances or retards its sampling timing based on the time T calculated from
equation (3), thereby reducing the sampling time difference with the master terminal to zero.
This adjustment is performed by varying the interval of the sampling pulse generated by an
20
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
oscillator in the slave terminal.
The difference of the transmission delay time Tdd (= Td1 Td2) is set to zero when sending and
receiving take the same route and exhibit equal delays. When the route is separate and the
sending and receiving delays are different, Tdd must be set at each terminal to be equal to the
sending delay time minus the receiving delay time. The maximum Tdd that can be set is 10ms.
(For setting, see Section 4.2.6.7. The setting elements of transmission delay time difference are
TCDT1 and TCDT2.)
The time TM measured at the master terminal is sent to the slave terminal together with the
current data and is used to calculate the T.
The permissible maximum transmission delay time of the channel is 10ms.
In case of the three-terminal line application, the communication ports of the GRL100 are
interlinked with each other as shown in Figure 2.2.7.2, that is, port CH1 of one terminal and port
CH2 of the other terminal are interlinked. For the setup of the communication system, see
Section 2.12.3.
When terminal A is set as the master terminal by the scheme switch [SP.SYN], the
synchronization control is performed between terminals A and B, and terminals B and C. The
terminal B follows the terminal A and the terminal C follows the terminal B. The slave terminals
perform the follow-up control at their communication port CH2.
When the master terminal is out-of-service in A-MODE, the slave terminal that is interlinked
with port 1 of the master terminal takes the master terminal function. In the case shown in Figure
2.2.7.2, terminal B takes the master terminal function when the master terminal A is
out-of-service. In B-MODE and GPS-MODE, even if the master terminal is out-of-service, the
master terminal is not changed. If DC power supply of the out-of-service terminal is OFF,
differential elements at all terminals are blocked. Therefore, the [TERM] setting change from
3TERM to 2TERM is required.
Terminal B
Terminal A
CH2
CH1
GRL100
GRL100
CH2
CH1
Slave
Master
Communication
port
CH1
CH2
GRL100
Slave
Terminal C
21
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Td = ({To (T TM)}/2 + Tdd)/2
(4)
The calculated transmission delay time Td1 is divided by the sampling interval T. The mantissa
is truncated and the quotient is expressed as an integer. If the integer is set to P, the reception at
the slave terminal of the signal sent from the master terminal occurs at P sampling intervals from
the transmission. Accordingly, by performing control so that the sampling address of the slave
terminal equals integer P when the sampling address = 0 signal is received from the master
terminal, the sampling address of the slave terminal can be made the same as the master terminal.
T
TM
Master
terminal
Slave
terminal
t
TF
Td2
Td1
TO
2.2.7.2
The relays at all terminals simultaneously receive the GPS clock signal once every second.
Figure 2.2.7.4 shows the GPS-based synchronized sampling circuit at one terminal. The GPS
clock signal is received by the GPS receiver HHGP1 and input to a time difference measurement
circuit in the GRL100. The circuit measures the time difference T between the GPS clock and
the internal clock generated from the crystal oscillator. The oscillator is controlled to
synchronize with the GPS clock using the measured T and outputs 2,400 Hz (50Hz rating)
sampling signals to the current sampling circuit (analog to digital converter).
GPS
Line
GRL100
GPS receiver
HHGP1
Time
difference
measurement
Crystal
oscillator
Analog/digital
converter
Lead/lag control
Synchronous control
Timing synchronization
When the GPS signal is received normally at every line terminal, the GRL100 performs
synchronized sampling based on the received clock signal. The GRL100 can provide a backup
synchronization system if the GPS signal is interrupted at one or more terminals, and perform
synchronized sampling without any external reference clock. The backup system becomes valid
by setting the scheme switch [GPSBAK] to "ON".
22
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
In the backup modes, the percentage restraint in the small current region can be increased from
the normal 16.7% ((1/6)Ir in Figure 2.9.10.1) in accordance with the PDTD setting which is the
probable transmission delay time difference between send and receive channels.
Backup modes, Mode 1, 2A and 2B are initialised when the backup system is set valid.
If the GPS signal interruption occurs when the backup is set invalid, the sampling runs based on
the local clock. When the arrival time of the remote signal measured from local sampling instant
deviates from a nominal time, the protection is blocked.
Mode 0: When the GPS signal is received normally, the sampling is performed synchronizing
with the received clock signal thus realizing synchronized sampling at all terminals. Difference
of the transmission delay time for the channel in each direction and fluctuation of the delay time
can be permitted.
The GRL100 performs the protection based on the nominal current differential characteristics.
When the GPS signal has interrupted for more than ten seconds at any of the terminals, the mode
changes to Mode 1 at all terminals.
Mode 1: The terminal which loses its GPS signal first functions as the slave terminal. If all
terminals lose their signals simultaneously, then the scheme switch [SP.SYN] setting determines
which terminal functions as the slave or master. The slave terminal adjusts the local sampling
timing to synchronize the sampling with other terminal which is receiving the GPS signal
regularly or with the master terminal.
Note: When two terminals are receiving the GPS signal regularly, the slave terminal
synchronizes with the terminal that is interlinked with port 2 of the slave terminal.
When the GPS signal has been restored, the mode shifts from Mode 1 back to Mode 0.
If, during Mode 1 operation, a failure occurs in the communication system, the sampling timing
adjustment is disabled and each terminal runs free. If the free running continues over the time
determined by the PDTD setting or the apparent phase difference exceeds the value determined
by the PDTD setting, the mode shifts from Mode 1 to Mode 2A at all terminals.
Mode 2A: In this mode, the intra-system synchronization described in 2.2.7.1 is applied
assuming that the transmission delay time for the channel in each direction is identical.
Fluctuation of the delay time can be permitted.
The current differential protection is blocked in this mode.
When the GPS signal has been restored, the mode shifts from Mode 2A to Mode 0.
If the GPS signal interruption occurs a set period following energisation of the relay power
supply or the mode returned to Mode 0 from Mode 1, 2A or 2B, then the transmission delay time
measurement will not be completed in Mode 0, and the mode changes to Mode 2A.
When the apparent current phase difference has stayed within the value determined by the PDTD
setting, the scheme switch [AUTO2B] for automatic mode change is set to "ON" and [TERM] is
set to "2TERM", the mode changes from Mode 2A to Mode 2B at both terminals.
The mode can be changed to Mode 2B manually through a binary input signal "Mode 2B
initiation" or user interface. Before this operation, it must be checked that the transmission delay
time difference between send and receive terminals is less than the PDTD setting and the SYNC
ALARM LED is off. If these conditions are not satisfied, the operation may cause a false
tripping.
Note: The mode change with the binary input signal is performed by either way:
If the binary input contact is such as to be open when the relay is in service, set
the BI to "Inv" (inverted). The mode changes when the contact is closed more
23
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
than 2 seconds and then open.
If the binary input contact is such as to be closed when the relay is in service, set
the BI to "Norm" (normal). The mode changes when the contact is open more
than 2 seconds and then closed.
For the BISW4, see Section 3.2.1.
In the three-terminal application, the mode change to Mode 2B is available even
when one of the three communication routes is failed.
Mode 2B: The same intra-system synchronization as in Mode 2A is applied.
When the GPS signal has been restored, the mode shifts from Mode 2B to Mode 0.
If a failure occurs in the communication system, the sampling timing adjustment is disabled and
each terminal runs free.
The mode shifts from Mode 2B to Mode 2A, when the apparent load current phase difference
exceeds the value determined by the PDTD setting for pre-determined time.
Checking the current phase difference (For two-terminal application setting only)
The current phase difference is checked using the following equations:
I1A cos < 0
I1A I1B sin < I1A I1B sin s
I1A > OCCHK
I1B > OCCHK
Where,
I1A = Positive sequence component of load current at local terminal
I1B = Positive sequence component of load current at remote terminal
= Phase difference of I1B from - I1A
s = Critical phase difference
= CHKHYS
CHK =
PDTD(s)
360
+ 8.5
2
20000(s)
I1B
-I1A
s
I1A
24
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Sampling address synchronization
The same method as described in section 2.2.7.1 is employed in Mode 0 and Mode 2A where the
sampling synchronization must be established. It is not employed in Mode 1 and 2B because the
sampling address synchronization has already been established in the previous mode.
2.2.7.3
Synchronized sampling allows correct calculation of differential current even in the presence of
a transmission time delay. This processing is indicated in Figure 2.2.7.6. As indicated in the
figure, sampling synchronization is established between terminals A and B, and both the
sampling timing and sampling address match. The instantaneous current data and sampling
address are both sent to the other terminal. The GRL100 refers to the sampling address affixed to
the received data and uses local data with the same sampling address to calculate the differential
current. This allows both terminals to use data sampled at the same instant to perform the
differential current calculation, no matter how large the transmission time delay is.
Terminal A
iB(1)
iA(0)
iB(0)
iA(1)
Terminal B
0
2
iA(0)
t
3
4
Sampling address number
2.2.8
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
lines, the charging current which flows as a result of the capacitance of the line (see Figure
2.2.8.1) appears to the protection relay as an erroneous differential current.
Terminal A
Terminal B
GRL100
GRL100
Ic
The charging current can be compensated for in the setting of the relays differential protection
sensitivity but only at the expense of reduced sensitivity to internal faults. In addition, the actual
charging current varies with the running voltage of the line and this must be taken into account in
the setting.
In order to suppress the effect of the charging current while maintaining the sensitivity of the
differential protection, GRL100 is equipped with a charging current compensation function,
which continuously re-calculates the charging current according to the running line voltage and
compensates for it in its differential current calculation. The running line voltage is measured by
VT inputs to GRL100.
The user enters values for line charging current and for the line voltage at which that charging
current was determined in the settings [DIFIC] and [Vn], and these values are used by the relay
to calculate the capacitance of the line. The relays at each line end share the line capacitance
between them, that is they divide by two for a two-terminal line, and by three for a three-terminal
line. In the case of a three-terminal line, if the relay at one terminal is out-of-service for testing
(see out-of-service terminal detection), the other two terminals are automatically re-configured
to divide the line capacitance by two.
Each terminal continuously calculates its share of the charging current at the running line voltage
on a sample by sample basis as follows:
Ic = C dV / dt
where,
Ic = line charging current
C = line capacitance calculated from settings [DIFIC] and [Vn]
V = measured line voltage
The relay then calculates the line current compensated for the charging current on a sample by
sample basis as follows:
I = I - Ic
where,
I = compensated current
I = actual measured current
Note that since GRL100 calculates both the charging current and compensated line current on a
sample by sample basis, all necessary phase information is inherently taken into account.
26
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
2.2.9
27
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
IR (=IF)
IL (=IF)
LOCAL
LINE
Blind Zone
DS
CB
REMOTE
FAULT
BUSBAR
PROT.
DIFF RELAY GRL100
(REMOTE)
89L1
DIFF RELAY GRL100
(LOCAL)
CBDS-A,B,C
CBDS-A,B,C
CB CLOSE COMMAND
1
IR (Current)
IR (Current)
CBDS-A
CBDS-B
CBDS-C
IR
&
IL
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
A
C
Case 1
A
Open
J
C
Case 2
The larger current outflows from terminal C when the fault location is closer to terminal B and
the power source behind terminal C is weaker. In case of a double-circuit three-terminal line,
50% of the fault current flowing in from terminal A can flow out from terminal C if terminal C is
very close to the junction and has no power source behind it.
These outflows must be considered when setting the differential element.
CT saturation for an external fault condition
In case of a two-terminal line, the magnitude of infeeding and outflowing currents to the external
fault is almost the same. If the CTs have the same characteristics at the two terminals, the CT
errors are offset in the differential current calculation.
A
C
Case 1
A
Open
J
C
Case 2
But in case of a three-terminal line, the magnitude of the current varies between the terminals
and the terminal closest to the external fault has the largest magnitude of outflowing fault
current. Thus, the CT errors are not offset in the differential current calculation. Thus, it is
29
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
necessary to check whether any fault causes CT saturation, particularly in the terminal with
outflow, and the saturation must be accommodated utilising the DIFI2 setting of the DIF
element.
CH1
CH1
GRL100
GRL100
CH2
CH2
Terminal B
F1
F2
DS
A scheme switch [STUB] and stub fault detection logic as shown in Figure 2.2.12.2 are provided
to avoid unnecessary trippings of the breakers in these cases.
DS
&
STUB ON
[STUB]
(+)
"ON"
If the switch is set to "ON" and the disconnector is open (DS = 0), the signal STUB ON is
30
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
generated and used to reset the receiving current data from terminal B to zero. Thus, terminal A
does not need to operate unnecessarily in response to fault F2.
Terminal B detects that terminal A is out-of-service with the out-of-service detection logic and
resets the receiving current data from terminal A to zero, and so does not operate in response to
fault F1.
The signal STUB ON also brings the local tripping into three-phase final tripping.
Through current for a close-up external fault
In the close-up external fault shown in Figure 2.2.12.3, a large fault current may flow through
current transformers CT1 and CT2 at terminal A and a small fault current flows in at terminal B.
This large through fault current may cause an erroneous differential current if the characteristics
of CT1 and CT2 are not identical.
GRL100
CT2
GRL100
CT1
Terminal A
Terminal B
The models 503 and 513 have individual input terminals for CT1 and CT2 secondary current.
Thus, sufficient restraining current can be obtained by summing the scalar values of CT1 and
CT2 secondary currents.
In this manner, terminal A can have sufficient restraining current against the erroneous
differential current mentioned above and demonstrate correct non-operation. But terminal B
cannot have a sufficient restraining current and may operate in response to the fault incorrectly.
To cope with this, the GRL100 has a scheme switch [T.F.C] and the scheme logic of the
differential protection shown in Figure 2.2.2.1 is switched to that of Figure 2.2.12.4. When the
[T.F.C] is set to "ON" locally or at the remote terminal, tripping commands are output under the
condition that the differential protection operates at both ends.
In this case, the tripping time is delayed by the transmission time of the remote terminal
operation signal.
31
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
DIF-A
DIF-B
DIF-C
&
DIFAT
&
DIFBT
&
DIFCT
Remote Terminal
DIF-A
&
DIF-B
&
DIF-C
&
[T.F.C]
"ON"
[T.F.C]
"ON"
DIF.BLOCK
Terminal B
2.2.13 Setting
The following shows the setting elements necessary for the current differential protection and
their setting ranges. The settings can be made on the LCD screen or PC screen.
32
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Element
Range
Step
Default
DIF
Remarks
Communication Mode
A
GPS
Residual current
Phase current
0.50 10.00A
0.01A
5.00A
(0.10 2.00A
0.01A
1.00A)(*1)
3.0 120.0A
0.1A
15.0A
(0.6 24.0A
0.1A
3.0A)
0.25 5.00A
0.01A
2.50A
(0.05 1.00A
0.01A
0.50A)
0.00 5.00A
0.01A
0.00 A
(0.00 1.00A
0.01A
0.00 A)
Vn
100 - 120V
1V
110V
TDIFG
0.00 10.00s
0.01s
0.50s
DIFSV
0.25 10.00A
0.01A
0.50A
(0.05 2.00A
0.01A
0.10A)
TIDSV
0 60s
1s
10s
OCCHK (*5)
0.5 5.0A
0.1A
0.5A
--
--
(0.10 1.00A
0.01A
0.10A)
HYS (*5)
1 5 deg
1 deg
1 deg
--
--
TDSV
100 - 16000
1s
6000s
TCDT1
10000 10000
1s
0s
TCDT2
10000 10000
1s
0s
PDTD
200 - 2000s
1s
1000s
--
--
RYID
0-63
--
RYID1
0-63
--
RYID2
0-63
--
[DIFG]
ON/OFF
ON
[STUB]
ON/OFF
ON or
OFF(*2)
[RDIF]
ON/OFF
ON
--
[T.F.C]
ON/OFF
OFF
--
--
[OTD]
ON/OFF
OFF
[DIF-FS]
OFF / OC / OCD /
Both
OFF
Fail-safe function
[DIFG-FS]
ON/OFF
OFF
Fail-safe function
[COMMODE]
A / B / GPS
Communication mode
GPS
[TERM]
2TERM/3TERM
/Dual (*3)
3TERM
[SP.SYN]
Master/Slave
Master(*4)
Sampling synchronization
[CH. CON]
Normal/Exchange
Normal
DIFI1
DIFI2
DIFG
DIFIC
DIFGI
33
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Element
Range
Step
Default
Remarks
Communication Mode
A
GPS
[T.SFT1]
ON/OFF
OFF
[T.SFT2]
ON/OFF
OFF
[B.SYN1]
ON/OFF
ON
[B.SYN2]
ON/OFF
ON
[LSSV]
ON/OFF
OFF
[GPSBAK]
OFF/ON
ON
Backup synchronization
--
--
[AUTO2B] (*6)
OFF/ON
OFF
--
--
[SRC](*5)
Disable / I
--
--
[IDSV]
OFF/ALM&BLK/A
LM
OFF
Id monitoring
[RYIDSV]
OFF/ON
ON
--
(*1) Current values shown in parentheses are in the case of 1A rating. Other current values are in the
case of 5A rating.
(*2) This setting depends on the relay model.
(*3) This setting is valid for three-terminal application models of the GRL100.
(*4) In the actual setting, one terminal is set to "Master" and other terminal(s) to "Slave".
(*5) OCCHK, [SRC] and HYS are enabled by setting the [TERM] to "2TERM".
(*6) [AUTO2B] is enabled by setting the [TERM] to "2TERM" and [SRC] to "I".
(*7) This setting is only used when there is a fixed difference between the sending and receiving
transmission delay time. When the delay times are equal, the default setting of 0s must be
used.
(*8) If the channel delay time of CH1 or CH2 exceeds the TDSV setting, then the alarm "Td1 over"
or "Td2 over" is given respectively.
CT Ratio matching
When the CT ratio is different between the local terminal and the remote terminal(s), the CT
ratio matching can be done as follows:
The differential element settings are respectively set to the setting values so that the primary fault
detecting current is the same value at all terminals. Figure 2.2.13.1 shows an example of CT ratio
matching. The settings for DIFI2, DIFGI, DIFSV and DIFIC should also be set with relation to
the primary current in the same manner of the DIFI1 setting.
Primary sensitivity = 800A
Terminal-B
Terminal-A
GRL100
GRL100
CT ratio : 2000/1A
CT ratio : 4000/1A
DIFI1=800A / CT ratio(2000/1A)
= 0.4A
DIFI1=800A / CT ratio(4000/1A)
= 0.2A
34
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
If the CT secondary ratings at the local and remote terminals are different, relay model suitable
for the CT secondary rating is used at each terminal and then CT ratio matching can be applied
the same as above. The differential element settings are respectively set to the setting values so
that the primary fault detecting current is the same value at all terminals. Figure 2.2.13.2 shows
an example of CT ratio matching. The settings for DIFI2, DIFGI, DIFSV and DIFC should also
be set with relation to the primary current in the same manner of the DIFI1 setting.
Primary sensitivity = 800A
Terminal-A
Terminal-B
GRL100
5A rated model
GRL100
1A rated model
CT ratio : 2000/1A
CT ratio : 2000/5A
DIFI1=800A / CT ratio(2000/1A)
= 0.4A
DIFI1=800A / CT ratio(2000/5A)
= 2.0A
Setting of DIFI1
The setting of DIFI1 is determined from the minimum internal fault current to operate and the
maximum erroneous differential current (mainly the internal charging current) during normal
service condition not to operate.
DIFI1 should therefore be set to satisfy the following equation:
KIc < DIFI1 < If / K
where,
K:
Ic:
I f:
For the GRL100 provided with the charging current compensation, the condition related to the
charging current can be neglected.
The setting value of DIFI1 must be identical at all terminals. If the terminals have different CT
ratios, then the settings for DIFI1 must be selected such that the primary settings are identical.
Setting of DIFI2
The setting of DIFI2 is determined from the following two factors:
Maximum erroneous current generated by CT saturation in case of an external fault
Maximum load current
Maximum outflow current in case of an internal fault
In the first factor, the DIFI2 should be set as small as possible so that unwanted operation is not
caused by the maximum erroneous current generated by CT saturation on the primary side by a
through current at an external fault. It is recommended normally to set DIFI2 to 2In (In:
secondary rated current) for this factor.
In the second factor, the DIFI2 should be set large enough such that it does not encroach on load
current.
The third factor must be considered only when the GRL100 is applied to three-terminal
35
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
double-circuit lines, lines with outer loop circuit, or double-circuit lines with one-and-a-half
busbar system. DIFI2 should be set larger than the possible largest value of outflow current in
case of an internal fault.
As the occurrence of current outflow depends on the power system configuration or operation, it
is necessary to check whether it is possible for the fault current to flow out of the line. If so, the
factor must be taken into consideration when making the setting.
In other applications, only the first and second factors need be considered.
Setting of DIFGI
The setting of DIFGI is determined from the high-impedance earth fault current.
The setting value of DIFGI must be identical at all terminals. If the terminals have different CT
ratios, then the settings for DIFGI must be selected such that the primary settings are identical.
Setting of DIFSV
When using the differential current monitoring function, the setting of DIFSV is determined
from the maximum erroneous differential current during normal service condition.
KIerr < DIFSV < DIFI1 / (1.5 to 2)
Ierr: maximum erroneous differential current
For the GRL100 provided with the charging current compensation, the condition related to the
charging current can be neglected.
The setting value of DIFSV must be identical at all terminals. If the terminals have different CT
ratios, then the settings for DIFSV must be selected such that the primary settings are identical.
Setting of DIFIC
The internal charging current under the rated power system voltage is set for DIFIC. The
charging current is measured by energizing the protected line from one terminal and opening the
other terminal.
If the measured power system voltage differs from the rated one, the measured charging current
must be corrected.
The setting value of DIFIC must be identical at all terminals. If the terminals have different CT
ratios, then the settings for DIFIC must be selected such that the primary settings are identical.
Setting of OCCHK
This setting is available for [COMMODE]=GPS-MODE setting. The OCCHK must be set
larger than any of the following three values, taking the errors due to charging current and
measurement inaccuracy into consideration. If the differential current setting in the small current
region DIFI1 differs between terminals due to different CT ratios, the larger DIFI1 is applied.
14 charging current (A)
0.5 DIFI1 setting (A)
0.5A (or 0.1A in case of 1A rating)
Setting of PDTD, [COMMODE], [GPSBAK], [AUTO2B], [TERM], [SRC ] and [RYIDSV]
The setting of these items must be identical at all terminals.
COMMODE: generally set to B-MODE which is standard operating mode. Set to A-MODE
if the opposite terminal relay is an old version of GRL100, that is GRL100-A,
-N or -Y. If the relay is applied to the GPS-based synchronization, set to
36
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
GPS-MODE. The GPS-MODE is only available for the relay provided with a
GPS interface.
PDTD, GPSBAK, AUTO2B, SRC : Available for [COMMODE]=GPS-MODE setting. See
Section 2.2.7.
Note: Do not set [TERM] to Dual in GPS-mode.
CH1
RELAY A
5000s
3000s
CH1
1000s
1000s
CH2
1000s
CH2
RELAY C
2000s
CH1
RELAY B
Setting of [SP.SYN]
One of terminals must be set to MASTER and others SLAVE.
If not, the synchronized sampling fails under the intra-system synchronized sampling or backup
modes of the GPS-based synchronized sampling.
Note: As the simultaneous setting change at all terminals is not practical, it is not recommended to
change the settings when the relay is in service.
Setting of [CH.CON]
In case of the two-terminal line application, the communication ports of the GRL100 are
interlinked with port CH1 as shown in Figure 2.2.13.3(a) and (b). In case of three-terminal
application, port CH1 of one terminal and port CH2 of the other terminal are linked as shown in
Figure 2.2.13.3(c).
In these normal linkages, the communication port exchange switch [CH.CON] is set to
"Normal".
Setting of [T.SFT1], [T.SFT2], [B.SYN1], and [B.SYN2]
T.SFT1: is used to synchronise the relay with multiplexer by shifting the send signal by a half-bit
when the distance from the relay to the multiplexer is long. When electrical interface
X.21, CCITT G.703-1.2.2 or -1.2.3 is applied and the distance (cable length from relay to
multiplexer) is 300m or more, the setting is set to 'ON'. (for channel 1)
T.SFT2: same as above. (for channel 2)
37
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
B.SYN1: is set to 'ON' when the relay is linked via multiplexer, and set to 'OFF' when direct link
is applied. (for channel 1)
This setting is available for CCITT G703-1.2.1, 1.2.2, 1.2.3, X21 and optical interface
(short distance: 2km class). In the case of optical interface 30km and 80km class, this
setting is neglected.
B.SYN2: same as above. (for channel 2)
Setting of RYID, RYID1 and RYID2
Relay address number RYID must take a different number at each terminal.
If the relay address monitoring switch [RYIDSV] is "OFF", their settings are ignored. The
RYID2 setting is enabled by setting the [TERM] to "3TERM" or "Dual".
Two-terminal application: Set the local relay address number to RYID and the remote relay
address number to RYID1. The RYID1 is equal to the RYID of the
remote relay. See Figure 2.2.13.3.
In Dual setting, the RYID2 setting must be the same as the RYID1
setting.
Three-terminal application: Set the local relay address number to RYID and the remote relay 1
address number to RYID1 and the remote relay 2 address number to
RYID2. The RYID1 is equal to the RYID of the remote 1 relay and
the RYID2 equal to the RYID of the remote 2 relay. See Figure
2.2.13.3.
Note: The remote 1 relay is connected by CH1 and the remote 2 relay connected by CH2
Terminal B
Terminal A
RYID=0
CH1
CH1
RYID=1
RYID1=0
RYID1=1
CH2
CH2
Communication port
Terminal A
RYID=0
RYID1=1
RYID2=1
CH1
CH1
CH2
CH2
RYID=1
RYID1=0
RYID2=0
Terminal B
CH1
CH2
CH2
CH1
CH1
CH2
RYID=1
RYID1=2
RYID2=0
RYID=2
RYID1=0
RYID2=1
Terminal C
38
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Setting depending on communication mode
The setting depending on communication mode is shown in the following table.
Setting
A-MODE
B-MODE
GPS-MODE
Default setting
Remarks
Communication
mode
COMMODE
Must select A of
A/B/GPS
Must select B of
A/B/GPS
GPS backup
mode
GPSBAK
--
--
On/Off
On
MODE2B shifted
automatically
AUTO2B
--
--
On/Off
Off
Phase difference
check
SRC
--
--
Disable/I
Terminal
application
TERM
2TERM/3TERM/
DUAL
2TERM/3TERM/
DUAL
2TERM/3TERM
2TERM
For 3 terminal
application model
Relay address
monitoring
RYIDSV
--
On/Off
On/Off
On
Multi-phase
autoreclosing
Autoreclose
mode
MPAR2/MPAR3
(except for models
1/211/311)
MPAR2/MPAR3
MPAR2/MPAR3
SPAR&TPAR
Open terminal
detection
OTD
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
Off
Through fault
current measure
TFC
On/Off
--
--
Off
Zero-phase
current differential
DIFG
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On
Out-of-step
tripping
OST
Trip/BO/Off
Trip/BO/Off
Trip/BO/Off
Off
Fault locator
FL
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On
Remote
differential trip
RDIF
--
On/Off
On/Off
On
RYIDSV=Off is
required
Terminal application
In A-MODE and B-MODE, anyone of 2TERM, 3TERM or DUAL can be selected. In
GPS-MODE, however, DUAL cannot be selected.
Multi-phase autoreclosing
To apply the multi-phase autoreclosing with MPAR2 or MPAR3, the relay address monitoring
RYIDSV in B-MODE and GPS-MODE must be set to OFF. When the RYIDSV=OFF, CBLS
(CBDS) condition is sent.
If shared with the relay address monitoring, the bits for CBLS condition can be assigned instead
of the bits for DIFG or OST/FL by PLC function when DIFG or OST/FL is not used.
Automatic open terminal detection OTD
In B-MODE and GPS-MODE, the RYIDSV=OFF setting for relay address monitoring is
required to use the open terminal detection function (OTD=On).
If shared with the relay address monitoring, the following methods can be applied:
(1) Only one bit with open terminal condition instead of CBLS condition can be sent by
sub-communication bit.
39
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
(2) If DIFG or OST/FL is not used, the bits for CBLS condition can be assigned instead of the
bits for DIFG or OST/FL by PLC function.
The open terminal detection in B-MODE and GPS-MODE do not automatically change
Master or Slave in SP.SYN. If the master terminal becomes out-of-service, therefore, the
synchronization control of slave terminal follows that of the master terminal by ON/OFF at the
master terminal and the current differential protection is blocked.
When putting a terminal into out-of-service in three-terminal operation, the following setting
change method is recommended:
(Example)
When putting Terminal C into out-of-service to two-terminal operation, the following four
setting are changed.
SP.SYN:
If the terminal C has been Master, change the terminal A or B to Master. If the terminal A or
C has been Master, do not change the setting.
TERM:
Change both the terminal A and B to 2TERM.
CH.CON:
It is defined that CH1 of both terminal relays is connected each other in two-terminal application
and CH1 of local relay is connected to CH2 of remote relay in three-terminal application as
shown in Figure 2.2.13.3. Therefore, the communication cable connection must be changed from
CH2 to CH1.
[CH.CON] is to change CH1 or CH2 signal with CH2 or CH1 signal in the relay inside. If the
[CH.CON] is set to Exchange, CH2 data is dealt with as CH1 data or in reverse. In Figure
2.2.13.3, change the terminal B to Exchange. However, note that the display or output such as
a communication failure, etc. is expressed as CH1 because CH2 data is dealt with as CH1 data at
the terminal B.
RYID1:
The remote terminal 1 seen from terminal B changes from terminal C to terminal A. Therefore,
change the remote terminal 1 relay address setting RYID1 from "2" to "0" at terminal B.
If the relay address monitoring switch [RYIDSV] is "OFF", the setting is invalid and setting
change is not required.
Through fault current measure TFC:
This function is available only for GRL100-503/513 and COMMODE=A-MODE setting.
If the function is used, set the [COMMODE] to "A-MODE" and the [TFC] to "ON".
Remote differential trip RDIF
This function is not available for the A-MODE setting.
When this function is used, set [RDIF] and [TERM] are set to "ON" and "3-TERM" and the
following must be configured by the PLC function.
Assign the remote DIF trip send signals RDIF--S to user configurable data, and the receiving
data from remote terminals to the trip command signals RDIF--R1 and RDIF--R2.
40
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
2.3
OC-A
&
66
OC-B
&
t
0.00 10.00s
OC_TRIP
1650 OC_3PTP
68
&
69
&
464 OCI-C TRIP
[OCBIT]
+
&
115
EF TRIP
116
EFBT (Alarm)
117
EFI TRIP
0.00 10.00s
[EFBT]
+
"ON"
&
&
"ON"
&
72
&
[EFIBT]
+
OCI-C TP
&
t
1634 EF_INST_TP
EFI
OCI_TRIP
&
1591 EF_BLOCK
OCI-B TP
1651 OCI_3PTP
TEF
71
[EFBTAL]
OCI-A TP
114
&
"ON"
1590 OCI_BLOCK
EF
1
463 OCI-B TRIP
70
OCI-C
OC-C TP
&
&
1589 OC_BLOCK
OCI-B
"ON"
OCI-A
OC-B TP
113
[OCBT]
+
1
461 OC-C TRIP
&
1633 OC_INST_TP
OC-A TP
67
OC-C
&
"ON"
1592 EFI_BLOCK
1550 BUT_BLOCK
41
118
BU-TRIP
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
2.3.1
In a system in which the fault current is mostly determined by the fault location, without being
greatly affected by changes in the power source impedance, it is advantageous to use the inverse
definite minimum time (IDMT) overcurrent protection. Reasonably fast tripping should be
obtained even at a terminal close to the power supply by using the inverse time characteristics. In
the IDMT overcurrent protection function, one of the following three IEC-standard-compliant
inverse time characteristics and one long time inverse characteristic is available.
standard inverse
very inverse
extremely inverse
IEC 60255-3
IEC 60255-3
IEC 60255-3
The IDMT element has a reset feature with definite time reset.
If the reset time is set to instantaneous, then no intentional delay is added. As soon as the
energising current falls below the reset threshold, the element returns to its reset condition.
If the reset time is set to some value in seconds, then an intentional delay is added to the reset
period. If the energising current exceeds the setting for a transient period without causing
tripping, then resetting is delayed for a user-definable period. When the energising current falls
below the reset threshold, the integral state (the point towards operation that it has travelled) of
the timing function (IDMT) is held for that period.
This does not apply following a trip operation, in which case resetting is always instantaneous.
Setting
The following table shows the setting elements necessary for the inverse time overcurrent
protection and their setting ranges.
Element
OCI
TOCI
TOCIR
[MOCI]
[OCIBT]
EFI
TEFI
TEFIR
[MEFI]
[EFIBT]
Range
0.5 - 25.0 A
( 0.10 - 5.00 A
0.05 - 1.00
0.0 10.0 s
Long/Std/Very/Ext
ON/OFF
0.5 - 5.0 A
( 0.10 - 1.00 A
0.05 - 1.00
0.0 10.0 s
Long/Std/Very/Ext
ON/OFF
Step
0.1 A
0.01 A
0.01
0.1 s
0.1 A
0.01 A
0.01
0.1 s
Default
10.0 A
2.00 A) (*)
0.50
0.0 s
Std
ON
5.0 A
1.00 A) (*)
0.50
0.0 s
Std
ON
Remarks
(*) Current values shown in the parentheses are in the case of 1 A rating. Other current values are in
the case of 5 A rating.
The scheme switches [MOCI] and [MEFI] are used to select one of the four inverse time
characteristics.
Current setting
In Figure 2.3.1.1, the current setting at terminal A is set lower than the minimum fault current in
the event of a fault at remote end F1. Furthermore, when considering also backup protection of a
fault within the adjacent lines, it is set lower than the minimum fault current in the event of a fault
at remote end F3. For grading of the current settings, the terminal furthest from the power source
is set to the lowest value and the terminals closer to the power source are set to a higher value.
42
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
The minimum setting is restricted so as not to operate on false zero-sequence currents caused by
an unbalance in the load current, errors in the current transformer circuits or zero-sequence
mutual coupling of parallel lines.
A
F1
F2
F3
Time setting
Time setting is performed to provide selectivity in relation with the relays on the adjacent lines.
Suppose a minimum source impedance when the current flowing in the relay becomes the
maximum. In Figure 2.3.1.1, in the event of a fault at near end F2 of the adjacent line, the
operating time is set so that terminal A may operate by time grading Tc behind terminal B. The
current flowing in the relays may sometimes be greater when the remote end of the adjacent line
is open. At this time, time coordination must also be kept.
The reason why the operating time is set when the fault current reaches the maximum is that if
time coordination is obtained for large fault current, then time coordination can also be obtained
for small fault current as long as relays with the same operating characteristic are used for each
terminal.
The grading margin Tc of terminal A and terminal B is given by the following expression for a
fault at point F2 in Figure 2.3.1.1.
Tc = T1 + T2 + M
where, T1: circuit breaker clearance time at B
T2: relay reset time at A
M: margin
When single-phase autoreclose is used, the minimum time of the earth fault overcurrent
protection must be set longer than the time from fault occurrence to reclosing of the circuit
breaker. This is to prevent three-phase final tripping from being executed by the overcurrent
protection during a single-phase autoreclose cycle.
2.3.2
In a system in which fault current does not change greatly with the position of the fault, the
advantages of the IDMT characteristics are not fully realised. In this case, the definite time
overcurrent protection is applied. The operating time can be set irrespective of the magnitude of
the fault current.
The definite time overcurrent protection consists of instantaneous overcurrent elements and
on-delay timers started by them.
Identical current values can be set for terminals, but graded settings are better than identical
settings in order to provide a margin for current sensitivity. The farther from the power source
the terminal is located, the higher sensitivity (i.e. the lower setting) is required.
The operating time of the overcurrent element of each terminal is constant irrespective of the
magnitude of the fault current and selective protection is implemented by graded settings of the
on-delay timer. As a result, the circuit breaker of the terminal most remote from the power source
is tripped in the shortest time.
When setting the on-delay timers, time grading margin Tc is obtained in the same way as
explained in Section 2.3.1.
43
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Setting
The setting elements necessary for the definite time overcurrent protection and their setting
ranges are shown below.
Element
OC
TOC
OCBT
EF
TEF
[EFBT]
[EFBTAL]
Range
0.5 - 100.0 A
( 0.1 - 20.0 A
0.00 - 10.00 s
ON/OFF
0.5 - 5.0 A
( 0.10 - 1.00 A
0.00 - 10.00 s
ON/OFF
ON/OFF
Step
0.1 A
0.1 A
0.01 s
0.1 A
0.01 A
0.01 s
Default
10.0 A
2.0 A) (*)
3.00 s
ON
5.0 A
1.00 A) (*)
3.00 s
ON
ON
Remarks
Phase overcurrent
OC delayed tripping
OC backup protection
Residual overcurrent
EF delayed tripping
EF backup protection
EF backup trip alarm
(*) Current values shown in the parentheses are in the case of 1 A rating. Other current values are in
the case of 5 A rating.
44
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
2.4
419
1688 TR1-A-R1
&
1689 TR1-B-R1
&
&
TR1-A TP
TR1-B TP
420
421
1690 TR1-C-R1
1720 TR1-A-R2
From
Remote
Terminal 2
1
1
TR1-C TP
TR1 TRIP
418
&
1721 TR1-B-R2
1660 TR1_3PTP
423
1722 TR1-C-R2
INTER TRIP1-A
&
424
INTER TRIP1-B
&
425
[TTSW1] "TRIP
"BO"
+
1595 TR1_BLOCK
INTER TRIP1-C
&
1
422
INTER TRIP1
427
1692 TR2-A-R1
&
1693 TR2-B-R1
&
&
TR2-A TP
TR2-B TP
428
429
1694 TR2-C-R1
1724 TR2-A-R2
From
Remote
Terminal 2
1
1
TR2-C TP
TR2 TRIP
426
&
1725 TR2-B-R2
1661 TR2_3PTP
431
1726 TR2-C-R2
INTER TRIP2-A
&
432
INTER TRIP2-B
&
433
[TTSW2] "TRIP
"BO"
+
1596 TR2_BLOCK
INTER TRIP2-C
&
1
430
INTER TRIP2
Figure 2.4.1
The sending signal is configured by PLC function. If the sending signal is assigned on a per
phase basis by PLC, a single-phase tripping is available.
Figure 2.4.2 shows an example of the assigning signal.
45
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
GRL100 (Receive)
GRL100 (Send)
(+) ()
User configurable
command data (send)
BIm command
Transfer trip
(A-phase)
BIm
Transfer trip
(B-phase)
BIn command
BIn
Transfer trip
(C-phase)
User configurable
command data (receive)
1688:TR1-A-R1
Sequence
Sequence
logic
logic
by PLC
by PLC
1689:TR1-B-R1
1690:TR1-C-R1
BIo command
BIo
Configured by PLC
Configured by PLC
46
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
2.5
Out-of-step Protection
The GRL100 out-of-step protection (OST) operates only when the out-of-step loci cross the
protected line and provides optimal power system separation in case of power system step out.
The OST compares the phase of the local and remote positive sequence voltages and detects the
out-of-step when the difference in the phase angle exceeds 180. The OST can detect any of the
out-of-steps with slow or fast slip cycles.
Figure 2.5.1 show the loci of the voltage vectors measured at terminals A and B when an
out-of-step occurs on the power system. P and Q are equivalent power source locations. Loci 1
and 2 are the cases when the locus crosses the protected line, and passes outside the protected
line, respectively.
X
B
VB3
3
VB2
2
VB1
1
Locus 1
VA2
VA1
VA3
R
A
(a) Internal
Q
3'
VB3'
2'
VB2'
B
VA3'
VA2'
1'
VB1'
Locus 2
VA1'
(b) External
Voltage phase angle differs by between terminals A and B. In case of Locus 1, gets larger as
the voltage locus approaches the protected line and becomes 180 when the locus crosses the
line. In case of Locus 2, becomes 0 when the locus crosses the power system impedance
outside the protected line.
47
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
At terminal A, the terminal voltage VA is taken as a reference voltage. Then, the phase angle of
the remote terminal voltage VB changes as shown in Figure 2.5.2. Out-of-step is detected when
VB moves from the second quadrant to the third quadrant or vice versa.
90
180
VB3
VB3'
VB2
VB2'
VB1
VB1'
VA
270
In the case of a three-terminal line, this phase comparison is performed between each pair of
terminals. All the terminals can detect any out-of-step provided its locus crosses the protected
line.
Figure 2.5.3 shows a scheme logic for the out-of-step protection. The output signal of the
out-of-step element OST1 performs three-phase final tripping. The output signal is blocked
when the scheme switch [OST] is set to "OFF" or binary signal OST_BLOCK is input. The
tripping signal of the out-of-step protection can be separated from other protection tripping
signals by the switch [OST]. In this case, the switch [OST] is set to "BO" and the tripping signal
OST-BO is assigned to a desired binary output number (for details, see Section 4.2.6.9). When
the tripping signal of the out-of-step protection is not separated from other protection tripping
signals, the switch [OST] is set to "Trip".
The voltage of the out-of-service terminal is set to zero at the receiving terminal and the OST
does not function with the out-of-service terminal.
87
48
OST1
&
OST2
&
OST-TP
&
[OST]
OSTT
(+)
52
"Trip"
[OST]
Communication failure
&
119
OST-BO
(+)
"BO"
Setting
The OST measuring element has no setting items. Only the scheme switch [OST] setting is
necessary for the out-of-step protection.
Element
Range
Step
[OST]
OFF/Trip/BO
48
Default
OFF
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
2.6
t
I2
1 e 100%
2
I AOL
(1)
where:
= thermal state of the system as a percentage of allowable thermal capacity,
I = applied load current,
IAOL = allowable overload current of the system,
= thermal time constant of the system.
The thermal state 0% represents the cold state and 100% represents the thermal limit, which is
the point at which no further temperature rise can be safely tolerated and the system should be
disconnected. The thermal limit for any given system is fixed by the thermal setting IAOL. The
relay gives a trip output when = 100%.
The thermal overload protection measures the largest of the three phase currents and operates
according to the characteristics defined in IEC60255-8. (Refer to Appendix P for the
implementation of the thermal model for IEC60255-8.)
Time to trip depends not only on the level of overload, but also on the level of load current prior
to the overload - that is, on whether the overload was applied from cold or from hot.
Independent thresholds for trip and alarm are available.
The characteristic of the thermal overload element is defined by equation (2) and equation (3) for
cold and hot. The cold curve is a special case of the hot curve where prior load current Ip is
zero, catering to the situation where a cold system is switched on to an immediate overload.
I2
t =Ln 2 2
I I AOL
(2)
I2 I 2
t =Ln 2 2P
I I AOL
(3)
where:
t = time to trip for constant overload current I (seconds)
I = overload current (largest phase current) (amps)
IAOL = allowable overload current (amps)
IP = previous load current (amps)
= thermal time constant (seconds)
Ln = natural logarithm
Figure 2.6.1 illustrates the IEC60255-8 curves for a range of time constant settings. The
left-hand chart shows the cold condition where an overload has been switched onto a
previously un-loaded system. The right-hand chart shows the hot condition where an overload
49
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
is switched onto a system that has previously been loaded to 90% of its capacity.
Thermal Curves (Cold Curve - no
prior load)
1000
1000
100
10
100
50
20
0.1
100
10
100
0.1
50
20
10
10
5
2
1
0.01
5
2
0.01
10
0.001
1
10
Figure 2.6.1
Thermal Curves
Scheme Logic
Figure 2.6.2 shows the scheme logic of the thermal overload protection.
The thermal overload element THM has independent thresholds for alarm and trip, and outputs
alarm signal THM ALARM and trip signal THM TRIP. The alarming threshold level is set as a
percentage of the tripping threshold.
The alarming and tripping can be disabled by the scheme switches [THMAL] and [THMT]
respectively or binary input signals THMA BLOCK and THM BLOCK.
A
THM
T
367
&
363
&
416
417
THM_ALARM
THM_TRIP
[THMAL]
+
"ON"
[THMT]
"ON"
1593 THMA_BLOCK
1594 THM_BLOCK
Figure 2.6.2
50
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Setting
The table below shows the setting elements necessary for the thermal overload protection and
their setting ranges.
Element
Range
Step
Default
Remarks
THM
2.0 10.0 A
(0.40 2.00 A)(*)
0.1 A
(0.01 A)
5.0 A
(1.00 A)
THMIP
0.0 5.0 A
(0.00 1.00 A)(*)
0.1 A
(0.01 A)
0.0 A
(0.00 A)
TTHM
0.1 min
10.0 min
THMA
50 99 %
1%
80 %
[THMT]
Off / On
Off
Thermal OL enable
[THMAL]
Off / On
Off
(*) Current values shown in the parenthesis are in the case of a 1 A rating. Other current
values are in the case of a 5 A rating.
Note: THMIP sets a minimum level of previous load current to be used by the thermal
element, and is only active when testing ([THMRST] = ON).
51
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
2.7
A
OCBF B
C
55
&
&
56
&
&
&
&
[BF2]
+
50 500ms
TBF1
t
1
t
&
TRIP-C0
&
+
&
1558 EXT_CBFIN-C
&
50 500ms
[BF1]
&
"TOC"
"T"
[BFEXT]
+
"ON"
1588 CBF_BLOCK
52
89
90
&
TRIP-B0
1557 EXT_CBFIN-B
&
1556 EXT_CBFIN-A
&
&
88
1
t
TRIP-A0
&
&
CBF-TRIP
"ON"
&
92
RETRIP-A
RETRIP-B
RETRIP-C
91
CBFDET
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
The backtrip signal to the adjacent breakers CBF-TRIP is output if the overcurrent element
OCBF operates continuously for the setting time of the delayed pick-up timer TBF2 after the
start-up. Tripping of the adjacent breakers can be blocked with the scheme switch [BF2].
There are two kinds of mode of the retrip signal to the original breaker RETRIP: the mode in
which RETRIP is controlled by the overcurrent element OCBF, and the direct trip mode in
which RETRIP is not controlled. The retrip mode together with the trip block can be selected
with the scheme switch [BF1].
Figure 2.7.2 shows a sequence diagram of the BFP when a retrip and backtrip are used. If the
breaker trips normally, the OCBF is reset before timer TBF1 or TBF2 is picked up and the BFP
is reset.
If the OCBF continues operating, a retrip command is given to the original breaker after the
setting time of TBF1. Unless the breaker fails, the OCBF is reset by the retrip. The TBF2 is not
picked up and the BFP is reset. This may happen when the BFP is started by mistake and
unnecessary tripping of the original breaker is unavoidable.
If the original breaker fails, retrip has no effect and the OCBF continues operating and the TBF2
is picked up finally. A trip command CBF-TRIP is issued to the adjacent breakers and the BFP is
completed.
Fault
Start BFP
Trip
Adjacent
breakers Closed
Open
TRIP
Normal trip
Original
breaker Closed
Retrip
Open
Tcb
Open
Tcb
OCBF
Toc
TBF1
Toc
TBF1
RETRIP
TBF2
TBF2
CBFTRIP
Tcb: operating time of the original breaker
Toc: reset time of the overcurrent element OCBF
53
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Setting
The setting elements necessary for the breaker failure protection and its setting ranges are as
follows:
Element
Range
Step
Default
Remarks
OCBF
0.5 10.0A
0.1A
4.0A
Overcurrent setting
(0.1 2.0A
0.1A
0.8A) (*)
TBF1
50 500ms
1ms
150ms
Retrip timer
TBF2
50 500ms
1ms
200ms
[BFEXT]
ON/OFF
OFF
External start
[BF1]
T/TOC/OFF
OFF
Retrip mode
[BF2]
ON/OFF
OFF
(*)
Current values shown in parentheses are in the case of 1A rating. Other current values are in
the case of 5A rating.
The overcurrent element OCBF checks that the breaker has opened and the current has
disappeared. Therefore, since it is allowed to respond to the load current, it can be set from 10 to
200% of the rated current.
The settings of TBF1 and TBF2 are determined by the opening time of the original breaker (Tcb
in Figure 2.7.2) and the reset time of the overcurrent element (Toc in Figure 2.7.2). The timer
setting example when using retrip can be obtained as follows.
Setting of TBF1 = Breaker opening time + OCBF reset time + Margin
= 40ms + 10ms + 20ms
= 70ms
Setting of TBF2 = TBF1 + Output relay operating time + Breaker opening time +
OCBF reset time + Margin
= 70ms + 10ms + 40ms + 10ms + 10ms
= 140ms
If retrip is not used, the setting of TBF2 can be the same as that of TBF1.
54
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
2.8
Tripping Output
Figure 2.8.1 shows the tripping logic. Segregated-phase differential protection outputs
per-phase-based tripping signals such as DIF.FS-A_TP, DIF.FS-B_TP and DIF.FS-C_TP, etc.
Zero-phase differential protection, thermal overload protection, earth fault backup protection
and out-of-step protection output three-phase tripping signals DIFG.FS_TRIP, THM-T,
BU-TRIP and OSTT.
+
+
[TPMODE]
1
"1PH"
[ARC-M]
"EXT1P"
&
&
&
TRIP-A0
TRIP-B0
TRIP-C0
&
DIF.FS-A_TP
RD.FS-A_TP
OC-A_TP
OCI-A_TP
TR1-A_TP
TR2-A_TP
DIF.FS-B_TP
RD.FS-B_TP
OC-B_TP
OCI-B_TP
TR1-B_TP
TR2-B TP
DIF.FS-C_TP
RD.FS-C_TP
OC-C_TP
OCI-C_TP
TR1-C_TP
TR2-C TP
1
435
0 t
1620
99
Tripping output
relay
A-phase
trip
TP-A1
1
1
B-phase
100
436
0 t
1621
trip
TP-B1
1
437
C-phase
101
0 t
1622
trip
TP-C1
A-phase
102
trip
TP-A2
B-phase
103
[TPMODE]
+
"3PH"
()
trip
1
TP-B2
&
C-phase
104
[ARC-M]
trip
+
Three-phase trip
"EXT3P"
permission
1663 3P_TRIP
command (BI14)
By PLC. (See Section 3.2.1.)
DIFG.FS_TRIP
TP-C2
TRIP-A
TRIP-B
TRIP-C
BU-TRIP
OSTT
THM-T
STUB ON
&
STUB
M-TRIPA
RETRIP-A
RETRIP-B
RETRIP-C
Figure 2.8.1
55
Tripping Logic
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
In the following cases, per-phase-based tripping is converted to three-phase tripping.
When autoreclose is prohibited by a binary input signal (ARCBLK = 1)
When the tripping mode selection switch [TPMODE] is set to "3PH"
(This applies to the GRL100 model 100s which does not have autoreclose.)
When the autoreclose mode selection switch [ARC-M] is set to "EXT3P"
When the measure for stub fault is enabled (STUB ON = 1)
(This applies to the one-and-a-half busbar system.)
PLC command 3P_TRIP is established.
In the following cases, two-phase tripping is converted to three-phase tripping.
When the switch [TPMODE] is set to "1PH"
When the switch [ARC-M] is set to "EXT1P"
For the following trips, the logic level of M-TRIPA becomes 1, and per-phase-based tripping is
converted to three-phase tripping. M-TRIPA is a logic signal in the autoreclose circuit (see
Figure 2.10.2.1).
Tripping within the reclaim time
Tripping when reclosing and the mode selection switch [ARC-M] is set to "Disable" or
"TPAR"
Signals RETRIP-A, RETRIP-B and RETRIP-C are the retripping signals of the breaker failure
protection.
Tripping signals drive the high-speed tripping output relays. Two sets of output relays are
provided for each phase and each relay has one normally open contact.
The tripping output relays reset 60ms(*) after the tripping signal disappears by clearing the fault.
The tripping circuit must be opened with the auxiliary contact of the breaker prior to reset of the
tripping relay to prevent the tripping relay from directly interrupting the tripping current of the
breaker.
(*) Reset time is adjustable by PLC function. Default setting is 60ms.
A tripping output relay is user configurable for the adjacent breakers tripping signal CBF-TRIP
in the breaker failure protection. For the default setting, see Appendix D. The relay is assigned to
the signal number 92 with signal name CBF-TRIP.
The signals TRIP-A, TRIP-B and TRIP-C are used to start the autoreclose.
The signal TRIP-A0, TRIP-B0 and TRIP-C0 are used to start the breaker failure protection.
Setting
The setting element necessary for the tripping output circuit and its setting range is as follows:
Element
Range
[TPMODE]
1PH/3PH/MPH
Step
Default
3PH : Model 100s
1PH : Other models
The switch [TPMODE] is used to enable the use of external autoreclose equipment with the
GRL100. So it is valid in model 100s which is not provided with autoreclose.
56
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
When the external autoreclose is set to the single-phase or single- or three-phase mode, set the
switch to "1PH". The GRL100 outputs a single-phase tripping command for a single-phase fault
and three-phase trip command for a multi-phase fault.
When the external autoreclose is set in the three-phase mode, set the switch to "3PH". The
GRL100 outputs a three-phase tripping command for a single- and multi-phase fault.
When the external autoreclose is set in the multi-phase mode, set the switch "MPH". The
GRL100 outputs a tripping command on a per faulted phase basis.
When the external autoreclose is not applied, set the scheme switch [TPMODE] to "3PH" to
enable three-phase final tripping.
57
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
2.9
Fault Detector
GRL100 model 400s and 500s are provided with a fault detector (FD) which functions as a check
relay and enhances security, or prevents false tripping due to a single failure in the protection
system.
The FD is an independent module and incorporates the following six fault detection elements.
The FD output signal is an ORing of the elements output signals shown in Figure 2.9.1.
Current change detection element (OCDF)
Multi-level overcurrent element (OCMF)
Earth fault overcurrent element (EFF)
Undervoltage element for earth fault detection (UVGF)
Undervoltage element for phase fault detection (UVSF)
Undervoltage change detection element (UVDF)
OCDF
UVDF
UVGF
UVSF
FD1
0.06s
EFF
OCMF
0
&
&
FD2
1
0.06s
&
J2:3-4
+
The FD output signal drives two sets of high-speed checking output relays. The checking output
relay resets 60ms(*) after the fault detection elements are reset by clearing the fault.
(*) Reset time is adjustable by PLC function. Default setting is 60ms.
The OCDF operates in response to load current if it is a steeply fluctuating one. When the relay
is used for a line with such a load current, the OCDF can be disabled by short-circuiting
dedicated paired pins on the module with a receptacle.
All the FD elements have fixed operating threshold levels. But if the earth fault current due to
unbalance in the network is significant, the EFF can be desensitized in the same way as described
above.
Note: To give high independency to the module, the human machine interface on the front panel or
PC has no access to the FD module except for the user configurable binary output relays
mounted on it.
When it is desirable to disable the OCMF, disable the OCDF or desensitize the EFF, take the
following steps:
Pull out the FD module. For a description of how the module is removed, refer to Section
6.7.3.
Four pairs of pins J1 and J2 are arranged lengthwise on the front at the top of the module
as shown in Figure 2.9.2.
58
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Lever
J1
2
1
8
7
2
1
Connector
plug
8
7
Front
J2
Rear
Ribbon cable
receptacle
Short-circuit the pins 1-2 (located topmost) for the J1 to disable the OCMF.
Short-circuit the pins 3-4 (located second from the top) for the J1 to disable the OCDF.
Short-circuit the pins 3-4 for the J2 to energize the output auxiliary relay FD2 only by
the OCMF.
Short-circuit the pins 5-6 (located second from the bottom) and open-circuit the pins 7-8
(located bottom) to change the EFF operating threshold level to 15% of the rated current.
Short-circuit pins 7-8 and open-circuit pins 5-6 to change the EFF operating threshold
level to 20% of rated current.
In other cases, the nominal operating threshold level (10% of the rated current) is kept.
Short-circuit both of the pins 5 - 6 and 7 - 8 to disable the EFF.
The pins 1-2 for the J2 is used to set the rated frequency. It is fixed before shipping.
Caution: Do not change the pins 1-2 for the J2.
Element
Setting
OCMF
Enabled
Disabled
OCDF
Enabled
Disabled
EFF
Disabled
10% of rated current
5-6
7-8
Short
Open
Short
Open
Short
Open
Open
Short
FD
50Hz rating
60Hz rating
FD2
Normal
Only OCMF
3-4
3-4
Open
Short
Open
Short
Open
Short
Open
Short
All the FD elements retain the nominal operating threshold when none of the paired pins are
short-circuited.
59
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Figure 2.9.3 shows the tripping output circuit when the FD is in service. The checking output
contact is connected with A- to C-phase tripping output contacts in series. They are connected
outside the relay as shown by the broken line.
Checking output relay
0
FD
(+)
FD1
60ms
0
TP-A1
A-phase trip
TP-B1
B-phase trip
TP-C1
C-phase trip
60ms by PLC
Tripping
logic
60ms by PLC
0
60ms by PLC
Setting
All the fault detection elements have fixed settings as follows:
Element
Setting
Remarks
OCMF
OCDF
0.1In
EFF
UVGF
46V
UVSF
80V
0.8 100V/ 3
0.8 100V
UVDF
0.93Vr
60
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
2.10 Autoreclose
2.10.1 Application
Most faults that occur on high-voltage or extra-high-voltage overhead lines are transient faults
caused by lightning. If a transient fault occurs, the circuit breaker is tripped to isolate the fault,
and then reclosed following a time delay to ensure that the hot gases caused by the fault arc have
de-ionized. This makes it possible to recover power transmission.
The time between clearing the fault and reclosing the circuit breaker, that is, the dead time,
should be made as short as possible to keep the power system stable. From the viewpoint of
de-ionization of the fault arc, the fault arc is de-ionized more thoroughly as the period of this
dead time is extended. The de-ionization commences when the circuit breakers for all terminals
of the line are tripped. Therefore, the dead time can be set at its minimum level if all terminals of
the line are tripped at the same time.
Autoreclose of the GRL100 is started by the current differential protection that ensures
high-speed protection of all terminals.
The GRL100 provides two autoreclose systems, single-shot autoreclose and multi-shot
autoreclose.
Single-shot autoreclose
Four types of single-shot autoreclose mode are provided: single-phase autoreclose, three-phase
autoreclose, single- and three-phase autoreclose, and multi-phase autoreclose. An optimal mode
is selected by the autoreclose mode selection switch [ARC-M]. In any case, autoreclose is
performed only once. If the fault state still continues after reclosing, three-phase final tripping is
activated.
Single-phase autoreclose:
In this mode, only the faulty phase is tripped, and then reclosed if a single-phase earth fault
occurs. In the case of a multi-phase fault, three phases are tripped, but reclosing is not made.
Since power can be transmitted through healthy phases even during the dead time, this mode
is convenient for maintaining power system stability. On the other hand, the capacitive
coupling effect between the healthy phase and faulty phase may cause a longer
de-ionization time when compared to a three-phase autoreclose. As a result, a longer dead
time is required.
It is essential to correctly determine the faulty phase. The GRL100 provides
phase-segregated current differential protection to correctly determine the faulty phase(s).
For single-phase autoreclose, each phase of the circuit breaker must be segregated.
This reclosing mode is simply expressed as "SPAR" in the following descriptions.
Three-phase autoreclose:
In this autoreclose mode, three phases are tripped, and then reclosed regardless of the fault
mode, whether single-phase fault or multi-phase fault. A shorter dead time can be set in this
mode when compared to the single-phase autoreclose. For the three-phase autoreclose,
synchronism check and voltage check between the busbar and the line are required.
This reclosing mode is simply expressed as "TPAR" in the following descriptions.
Single- and three-phase autoreclose:
In this autoreclose mode, single-phase tripping and reclosing are performed if a
single-phase fault occurs, while three-phase tripping and reclosing are performed if a
multi-phase fault occurs.
61
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
This reclosing mode is simply expressed as "SPAR & TPAR" in the following descriptions.
Multi-phase autoreclose:
This autoreclose mode can be applied to double-circuit lines. In this mode, only the faulted
phases are tripped and reclosed when the terminals of double-circuit lines are
interconnected during the dead time through at least two or three different phases.
This mode realizes high-speed reclosing for multi-phase faults without synchronism and
voltage check and minimizes the possibility of outages in the case of double faults on
double-circuit lines.
If the interlinking condition is not satisfied, all the phases are tripped and reclosing is not
started.
This reclosing mode is simply expressed as "MPAR2" for two-phase interconnection and
"MPAR3" for three-phase interconnection in the following descriptions.
For the detailed performance of the multi-phase autoreclose, see Appendix M.
In B-mode and GPS-mode, the multi-phase autoreclose can be applied if the RYIDSV
function is not applied.
Single-shot autoreclose can be applied to one-breaker reclosing and two-breaker reclosing in the
one-and-a-half breaker busbar system.
Multi-shot autoreclose
In the multi-shot autoreclose, any of two- to four-shot reclosing can be selected. In any case, the
first shot is selected from four types of autoreclose mode as described in the above single-shot
autoreclose. All successive shots (up to three times), which are applied if the first shot fails, are
three-phase tripping and reclosing.
Multi-shot autoreclose cannot be applied to two-breaker reclosing in the one-and-a-half breaker
busbar system.
The autoreclose can also be activated from an external line protection. At this time, all
autoreclose modes described above are effective.
If a fault occurs under the following conditions, three-phase final tripping is performed and
autoreclose is blocked:
Reclosing block signal is received from an external unit locally or remotely.
Throughout the reclaim time.
For evolving faults that occur during the dead time between single-phase tripping and reclosing,
"SPAR & TPAR" functions are as follows.
For evolving faults that occur within the period of time set from the first fault, the reclosing
mode enters the three-phase autoreclose mode. At this time, the total dead time becomes the dead
time for three-phase autoreclose added to the dead time for single-phase autoreclose which has
expired up to the point at which the evolving fault occurs.
For evolving faults that occurred after the set time, three-phase final tripping is performed, and
reclosing is not performed.
If an evolving fault occurs when "SPAR" is selected, three-phase final tripping is performed, and
reclosing is not performed.
If an evolving fault occurs when "MPAR2" or "MPAR3" is selected, the dead time is recounted
provided the network conditions defined for linked circuits are satisfied.
62
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
2.10.2 Scheme Logic
2.10.2.1 One-breaker Autoreclose
Figure 2.10.2.1 shows the simplified scheme logic for the single-shot autoreclose. Autoreclose
for a further fault incident is available when the circuit breaker is closed and ready for
autoreclose (CB-RDY=1), the reclosing mode selection switch [ARC-M] is set to "SPAR",
"TPAR", "SPAR & TPAR", "MPAR2" or "MPAR3" and the on-delay timer TRDY1 is picked
up. TRDY1 is used to determine the reclaim time.
If the autoreclose is ready, the internal tripping signal TRIP-A, B, C or external tripping signal
EXT_TRIP-A, B, C for each phase of the breaker activates the autoreclose. Whether or not the
external trip signals are used to activate the reclosing is selected by the scheme switch
[ARC-EXT].
Once this autoreclose is activated, it is kept by the flip-flop circuit until one reclosing cycle is
completed.
Autoreclose is not activated in the following conditions and all the phases are tripped
(M-TRIPA=1).
When tripping is performed by the high-impedance earth fault protection (DIFGT=1) and
the autoreclose selection switch [ARC-DIFG] is set to "OFF".
When tripping is performed by the backup protection (BU-TRIP=1) and the autoreclose
selection switch [ARC-BU] is set to "OFF".
When tripping is performed by the out-of-step protection (OSTT=1), breaker failure
protection (RETRIP=1) or stub fault protection (STUB=1).
When an autoreclose prohibiting binary input signal is applied at either the local or
remote terminal (ARC_BLOCK=1).
If autoreclosing is not ready, a three-phase tripping command M-TRIPA is output for all tripping
modes. At this time, autoreclose is not activated.
If all three phases of CB are closed, autoreclose is reset though it is initiated.
Autoreclose for single-phase fault
If the switch [ARC-M] is set to "SPAR", "SPAR & TPAR" or "MPAR2", single-phase tripping
is performed. If it is set to "MPAR3", single-phase tripping is performed only when the adjacent
parallel line is healthy.
The dead time counter TSPR or TMPR for single-phase reclosing is started by any of the tripping
signals TRIP-A to C. After the dead time has elapsed, reclosing command ARC is output. The
voltage check condition can be configured by the PLC function, if the voltage check and others
are required for the reclosing condition.
If [ARC-M] is set to "TPAR", three-phase tripping is performed and the dead time counter
TTPR1 for three-phase reclosing is started. After the dead time has elapsed, reclosing command
ARC is output based on the operating conditions of the voltage and synchronism check elements
output signal SYN-OP. (The SYN-OP is assigned by the PLC as a default setting.)
If [ARC-M] is set to "Disable", three-phase tripping is performed and autoreclose is not started.
63
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
[ARC-M]
+
"SPAR", "TPAR", "SPAR & TPAR",
&
"MPAR2", "MPAR3"
1571 CB1_READY
ARC1 READY
TRDY1
t
0
&
TSPR1
t
0
F/F
Single-phase trip
5-300s
&
52C
TW1
&
0.01-10s
[ARC-M]
+
"SPAR", "SPAR & TPAR"
52A
52B
&
&
[ARC-M]
MSARC
+
"MPAR2", "MPAR3"
TTPR1
t
0
&
Multi-phase trip
1
TRIP-B
1
TP
( To Figure
2.10.2.8. )
ARC
(For Leader CB)
0.1 - 10s
ARC(*)
1824 SPR.L-REQ
TRIP-A
&
&
0.01-100s
[ARC-M]
+
"TPAR", "SPAR & TPAR"
1
1825 TPR.L-REQ
&
0.1s
M-TRIPA
(For Leader CB)
"Default =SYN-OP"
[ARC-M]
+
"MPAR2", "MPAR3"
TRIP-C
TMPR1
t
0
1
&
LINK
[ARC-EXT]
+
1552 EXT_TRIP-A
&
&
0.01-10s
[ARC-M]
1826 MPR.L-REQ
"MPAR2", "MPAR3"
"ON"
DIFG.FS-TRIP
[ARC-DIFG]
1553 EXT_TRIP-B
1554 EXT_TRIP-C
&
1
"OFF"
OSTT
STUB
RETRIP
"ON"
&
1574 ARC_BLOCK
0.2s
FT
(For Leader CB)
1578 ARC_BLOCK1
FT
(For Leader CB)
BU-TRIP
1
&
[ARC-BU]
"OFF"
(*)ARC
(For Leader CB)
Single-phase trip
TEVLV
t
0
&
0.01-10s
Multi-phase trip
[ARC-M]
+
"SPAR & TPAR"
ARC FAIL
TRR
t
0
&
0.01-100s
[ARC-SUC]
"ON"
64
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
is assigned by the PLC as a default setting.)
If [ARC-M] is set to "SPAR" or "Disable", autoreclose is not activated.
In "SPAR & TPAR" or "TPAR", if the operating conditions of the voltage and synchronism
check elements assigned by the PLC as default are not satisfied during three-phase reclosing, the
TRR is then picked up and reclosing is reset. In "MPAR2" or "MPAR3", if the operating
condition of interlinking is not satisfied, autoreclosing is not activated and three-phase final
tripping is performed in case of setting [MA-NOLK] to FT. In case of setting [MA-NOLK] to
"S" or "S+T", it is shifted to other reclose modes and three-phase final tripping is not performed.
Autoreclose for an evolving fault
Figure 2.10.2.2 shows the sequence diagram of autoreclose for an evolving fault when "SPAR &
TPAR" is selected. If single-phase tripping (1trip) is performed, the evolving fault detection
timer TEVLV is started at the same as the TSPR is started. If no evolving faults occur,
single-phase reclosing is performed when the TSPR is picked up.
First fault
Evolving fault
Fault
1 trip
Trip
3 trip
1 reclosing
3 reclosing
TSPR
TSPR
TEVLV
TEVLV
TTPR1
TTPR1
As shown in the figure, if an evolving fault occurs before the TEVLV is picked up, three-phase
tripping (3trip) is performed. If this occurs, the TSPR and TEVLV are reset, and the TTPR1 is
now started.
After the TTPR1 is picked up, three-phase reclosing is performed based on the status of the
voltage and synchronism check elements output signal SYN-OP. If an evolving fault occurs after
the TEVLV has picked up, autoreclose is reset and reclosing is not performed.
In "MPAR2" or "MPAR3", an evolving fault only resets and restarts the dead time counter TSPR
provided the network conditions defined for linked circuits are satisfied, though not shown in
Figure 2.10.2.1.
65
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Voltage and synchronism check
There are four voltage modes as shown below when all three phases of the circuit breaker are
open. The voltage and synchronism check is applicable to voltage modes 1 to 3 and controls the
energizing process of the lines and busbars in the three-phase autoreclose mode.
Voltage Mode
live
live
dead
dead
live
dead
live
dead
The synchronism check is performed for voltage mode 1 while the voltage check is performed
for voltage modes 2 and 3.
[VCHK]
+
"OFF"
"LB"
"DB"
"SYN"
OVB
UVB
57
TLBD1
58
0.01 - 1s
TDBL1
LBDL
&
60
OVL1
&
1
DBLL
159
SYN-OP
&
0.01 - 1s
T3PLL
498
61
0.01 - 1s
3PLL
(Three phase live line)
UVL1
TSYN1
SYN1
59
0.01 - 10s
Figure 2.10.2.3 shows the energizing control scheme. The voltage and synchronism check
output signal SYN-OP is generated when the following conditions have been established:
Synchronism check element SYN1 operates and on-delay timer TSYN1 is picked up.
Busbar overvoltage detector OVB and line undervoltage detector UVL1 operate, and
on-delay timer TLBD1 is picked up. (This detects the live bus and dead line condition.)
Busbar undervoltage detector UVB and line overvoltage detector OVL1 operate, and
on-delay timer TDBL1 is picked up. (This detects the dead bus and live line condition.)
Using the scheme switch [VCHK], the energizing direction can be selected.
Setting of [VCHK]
Energizing control
LB
Reclosed under the "live bus and dead line" condition or with synchronism check.
DB
Reclosed under the "dead bus and live line" condition or with synchronism check.
SYN
OFF
66
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
When [VCHK] is set to "LB", the line is energized in the direction from the busbar to line under
the "live bus and dead line" condition. When [VCHK] is set to "DB", the lines are energized in
the direction from the line to busbar under the "dead bus and live line" condition.
When the synchronism check output exists, autoreclose is executed regardless of the position of
the scheme switch.
When [VCHK] is set to "SYN", three-phase autoreclose is performed only with the synchronism
check.
When [VCHK] is set to "OFF", three-phase autoreclose is performed without the voltage and
synchronism check.
The voltage and synchronism check requires a single-phase reference voltage from the busbar or
line. If three-phase voltages used by the current differential protection are supplied from the line
voltage transformer, the reference voltage will need to be supplied from the busbar voltage
transformer. On the contrary, if three-phase voltages used by the current differential protection
are supplied from the busbar voltage transformer, the reference voltage will need to be supplied
from the line voltage transformer.
Additionally, it is not necessary to fix the phase of the reference voltage.
To match the busbar voltage and line voltage for the voltage and synchronism check option
described above, the GRL100 has the following three switches as shown in Figure 2.10.2.4:
[VTPSEL]:
This switch is used to match the voltage phases. If the A-phase voltage or
A-phase to B-phase voltage is used as a reference voltage, "A" is selected.
[VT-RATE]:
This switch is used to match the magnitude and phase angle. "PH/G" is
selected when the reference voltage is a single-phase voltage while
"PH/PH" is selected when it is a phase-to-phase voltage.
[3PH-VT]:
"Bus" is selected when the three-phase voltages are busbar voltages while
"Line" is selected when they are line voltages.
Busbar or line
voltages
Va
Vb
Voltage check
&
Synchronism check
Vc
Line or busbar
reference voltage
Vref
[VTPSEL]
+
"A"
+
+
"B"
"C"
[VT - RATE]
+
+
"PH/PH"
"PH/G"
[3PH - VT]
+
+
"Bus"
"Line"
The signal 3PLL shown in Figure 2.10.2.3 is output when all three phase voltages are live, and it
is available by the [3PH-VT] = LINE setting.
67
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Autoreclosing requirement
Using PLC function, various reclose requirements can be designed. In Figure 2.10.2.1, a reclose
requirement for "SPAR", "TPAR", "SPAR&TPAR" or "MPAR" can be respectively assigned to
the following signals by PLC:
"SPAR":
[SPR.L-REQ]
"TPAR":
[TPR.L-REQ]
"SPAR&TPAR":
[SPR.L-REQ], [TPR.L-REQ]
"MPAR":
[MPR.L-REQ]
Default setting
Remarks
"SPAR"
[SPR.L-REQ] = CONSTANT_1
No condition
"TPAR"
[TPR.L-REQ] = SYP-ON
"MPAR"
[MPR.L-REQ] = CONSTANT_1
No condition
When the interconnection with either of the two remote terminals is confirmed employing the
interconnection signals from the line and the parallel line, multi-phase autoreclose can be
performed.
68
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
In case the interconnection condition LINK is not satisfied, the following operations can be
selected by the scheme switch [MA-NOLK] setting.
Setting of [MA-NOLK]
Operation
FT
Final Trip
Three-phase autoreclose
S+T
If FT is selected and the LINK is not satisfied, the final trip FT is performed. If T selected,
the three-phase autoreclose is performed. If S+T selected, the single-phase or three-phase
autoreclose is performed depending on the faulted phase(s).
External CB close signal
ARC
DS
To Remote Terminal
CB1 A
&
443
CB1 B
&
444
CB1 C
&
445
CB2 A
&
&
CB2 B
&
&
CB2 C
&
&
I.LINK-A
I.LINK-B
I.LINK-C
[ARC-CCB]
"MPAR"
To Parallel Line
146
&
I.LINK-A
I.LINK-B
I.LINK-C
&
147
&
148
LINK-A
LINK-B
LINK-C
LINK-A
&
LINK-B
&
LINK-C
&
&
&
&
[ARC-M]
+
"M2"
"M3"
69
152
LINK
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Permanent fault
When reclose-onto-a-fault is activated when a permanent fault exists, three-phase final
tripping is performed. However, this operation is performed only in the single-shot
autoreclose mode. In the multi-shot autoreclose mode, reclosing is retried as shown below,
for multi-shot autoreclosing.
Multi-shot autoreclose
In a multi-shot autoreclose, low-speed autoreclose is executed up to three times after
high-speed autoreclose fails. The first shot is high-speed autoreclose that functions in the
same manner as described for single-shot autoreclose. Figure 2.10.2.6 shows the simplified
scheme logic for the low-speed autoreclose of the second to fourth shot.
STEP COUNTER
[ARC-SM]
FT
MSARC
ARC1
F/F
CLOCK
TS2
t
0
&
TP
F/F
MSARC1
FT
SP1
SP2
SP1
SP2
SP3
CLR
1
F/F
5 - 300s
&
0 TS2R
MSARC1
ARC1
ARC2
ARC3
FT
SP1
MSARC2
FT
&
1
F/F
MSARC
TS3
0
5 - 300s
0.1s
5 - 300s
&
0 TS3R
MSARC2
5 - 300s
SP2
MSARC3
FT
&
1
F/F
TS4
0
5 - 300s
t
&
0 TS4R
MSARC3
5 - 300s
SYN-OP
[ARC-SM]
"S2"
&
SP1
"S3"
FT1
FT2 1
FT
0.5s
&
SP2
"S4"
&
SP3
FT3
The multi-shot mode, two shots to four shots, is set with the scheme switch [ARC-SM].
In low-speed autoreclose, the dead time counter TS2 for the second shot is activated if
high-speed autoreclose is performed (ARC = 1), but tripping occurs again (TP = 1). Second shot
autoreclose is performed only when the voltage and synchronism check element operates
(SYN-OP = 1) after the period of time set on TS2 has elapsed. At this time, outputs of the step
counter are: SP1 = 1, SP2 = 0, and SP3 = 0.
Autoreclose is completed at this step if the two-shot mode is selected for the multi-shot mode.
Therefore, the tripping following the "reclose-onto-a-fault" becomes the final tripping (FT = 1).
If the voltage and synchronism check element does not operate within the period of time set on
the timer TS2R which is started at the same time as TS2 is started, the multi-shot autoreclose is
cancelled (FT = 1).
70
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
When the three-shot mode is selected for the multi-shot mode, autoreclose is retried again after
the above tripping occurs. At this time, the TS3 and TS3R are started. The third shot autoreclose
is performed only when the voltage and synchronism check element operates after the period of
time set on the TS3 has elapsed. At this time, outputs of the step counter are: SP1 = 0, SP2 = 1,
and SP3 = 0.
The three-shot mode of autoreclose is then completed. Therefore, the tripping following the
reclose-onto-a-fault becomes the final tripping (FT = 1).
If the voltage and synchronism check element does not function within the period of time set on
the TS3R, the multi-shot autoreclose is cancelled.
When the four-shot autoreclose is selected, low-speed autoreclose is retried once again for
tripping that occurs after the "reclose-onto-a-fault". This functions in the same manner as the
three-shot autoreclose.
Use of external automatic reclosing equipment
To use external automatic reclosing equipment instead of the built-in autoreclose function of the
GRL100, the autoreclose mode switch [ARC-M] is set to "EXT1P", "EXT3P" or "EXTMP".
When "EXT1P" is selected, the GRL100 performs single-phase tripping for a single-phase fault
and three-phase tripping for a multi-phase fault. When "EXT3P" is selected, three-phase tripping
is performed for all faults. When "EXTMP" is selected, fault phase tripping is performed for all
faults.
One binary signal for each individual phase is output as an autoreclose start signal.
2.10.2.2 Two-breaker autoreclose
As shown in Figure 2.10.2.7, in the one-and-a-half breaker busbar arrangement, two circuit
breakers, the busbar breaker and the center breaker, must be reclosed. The GRL100 series 300s
and 500s are provided with the two-breaker autoreclose scheme.
Protected line
Busbar
breaker
VB
Center
breaker
VL1
VL2
Adjacent line
71
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Autoreclose is not activated when an autoreclose prohibiting binary input signal is applied at the
local or remote terminal.
ARC_BLOCK signal common for leader and follower CB
ARC_BLOCK1 signal for leader CB
ARC_BLOCK2 signal for follower CB
The autoreclose scheme is different depending on the reclosing mode.
Single-phase autoreclose and single- and three-phase autoreclose
The breaker(s) to be reclosed and the reclosing order can be set by the scheme switch [ARC-CB]
as follows:
Setting of [ARC-CB]
ONE
Autoreclose mode
(Set when applied to a one-breaker system)
O1
Only the busbar breaker is reclosed and the center breaker is subjected to final tripping.
O2
Only the center breaker is reclosed and the busbar breaker is subjected to final tripping.
L1
L2
Note : "ONE" is set only when the relay is applied to a one-breaker system. Trip and reclose
commands are output only for CB1(bus CB).
(1): Sequential autoreclose can be applied by changing of the dead timer setting or the PLC
setting.
(2): When [ARC-M] MPAR is selected, the autoreclose mode depends on the [ARC-CCB]
setting and the [ARC-CB] is not applied.
The autoreclose scheme logic for the two circuit breakers is independent of each other and are
almost the same. The autoreclose scheme logic of the circuit breaker to be reclosed first (lead
breaker) is the same as that shown in Figure 2.10.2.1. The scheme logic of the circuit breaker to
be reclosed later (follower breaker) is shown in Figure 2.10.2.8.
The start of the dead time counter can be configured by the PLC. In the default setting, the
single-phase autoreclose is started instantaneously after tripping, and the three-phase autoreclose
is started after the ARC-SET condition is satisfied.
The ARC-SET is a scheme signal whose logical level becomes 1 when a leader breakers
autoreclose command is output.
In default setting, therefore, the dead time of the follower breaker is as follows:
Three-phase autoreclose: equal to the sum of the dead time setting of the two breakers.
(TTPR1 + TTPR2)
Single-phase autoreclose: TSPR2
However, the dead time can be set that of the leader breaker by the PLC setting RF.ST-REQ.
The shortening of the dead time can be also applied when the leader breaker is final-tripped
because it is no ready.
72
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Autoreclose start requirement
Using PLC function, various autoreclose start requirements can be designed. In Figure 2.10.2.8,
a reclose start requirement for "SPAR", "TPAR", "SPAR&TPAR" or "MPAR" can be
respectively assigned to the following signals by PLC:
"SPAR":
[SPR.F-ST.REQ]
"TPAR":
[TPR.F-ST.REQ]
"SPAR&TPAR":
[SPR.F-ST.REQ], [TPR.F-ST.REQ]
"MPAR":
[MPR.F-ST.REQ]
The default setting for the follower CB autoreclose start requirement is as follows:
Reclose start
requirement
Default setting
Remarks
"SPAR"
[SPR.F-ST.REQ] = CONSTANT_1
No condition
"TPAR"
"MPAR"
[MPR.F-ST.REQ] = CONSTANT_1
No condition
Autoreclose requirement
The autoreclose requirement can be designed by assigning a reclose requirement to the signals
[SPR.F- REQ], [TPR.F-REQ] and [MPR.F- REQ] same as above.
The default setting for the follower CB autoreclose requirement is as follows:
Reclose requirement
Default setting
Remarks
"SPAR"
[SPR.F-REQ] = CONSTANT_1
No condition
"TPAR"
[TPR.F-REQ] = SYP-ON
"MPAR"
[MPR.F-REQ] = CONSTANT_1
No condition
Others
If the autoreclose start requirement is designed such as starting the follower CB in no-ready
condition of the leader CB, it is assigned to the signal [R.F-ST.REQ].
By assigning the autoreclose start requirement to the signal [R.F-ST.REQ], both the leader CB
and the follower CB are set the same dead time. The reclose requirement is assigned to the
signals [SPR.F2-ST.REQ], [TPR.F2-ST.REQ] and [MPR.F2-ST.REQ].
The default setting for the follower CB is as follows:
Requirement
Default setting
Reclose requirement
[R.F-ST.REQ] = CONSTANT_0
(No used)
"SPAR"
[SPR.F2-ST.REQ] = CONSTANT_0
(No used)
"TPAR"
[TPR.F2-ST.REQ] = CONSTANT_0
(No used)
"MPAR"
[MPR.F2-ST.REQ] = CONSTANT_0
(No used)
73
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
[ARC-M]
+
"SPAR", "TPAR", "SPAR & TPAR",
&
"MPAR2", "MPAR3"
1572 CB2_READY
ARC2 READY
TRDY2
t
0
&
TSPR2
t
0
F/F
&
&
52C
1827 SPR.F-REQ
&
TSPR1
t
0
+
"MPAR2", "MPAR3"
&
1830 SPR.F-ST.REQ
ARC
(For Follower CB)
ARC(*)
&
1837 SPR.F2-ST.REQ
"Default =CONSTANT 0"
t
&
Multi-phase trip
&
TTPR2
0
&
&
0.01-10s
[ARC-M]
+
"MPAR2", "MPAR3"
1828 TPR.F-REQ
&
[ARC-M]
+
"MPAR2", "MPAR3"
&
0.1s
M-TRIPA
(For Follower CB)
&
0.01-100s
1831 TPR.F-ST.REQ
"Default ="ARC-SET" or "CCB-SET"
LINK
&
&
1838 TPR.F2-ST.REQ
"Default =CONSTANT 0"
TMPR2
t
0
&
&
0.01-10s
[ARC-M]
1829 MPR.F-REQ
"MPAR2", "MPAR3"
[ARC-CCB]
&
+
"TPAR"
[ARC-M]
+
"MPAR2", "MPAR3"
1
1832 MPR.F-ST.REQ
(*)ARC
(For Follower CB)
&
1839 MPR.F2-ST.REQ
1836 R.F-ST.REQ
DIFG.FS-TRIP
+
[ARC-DIFG]
&
"OFF"
OSTT
STUB
RETRIP
1574 ARC_BLOCK
1579 ARC_BLOCK2
BU-TRIP
&
[ARC-BU]
"OFF"
LINK condition for MPAR is not satisfied.
Trip when ARC2 READY not operated.
Multi phase trip in SPAR.
Single-phase trip
TEVLV
t
0
&
Multi-phase trip
0.01-10s
[ARC-M]
+
"SPAR & TPAR"
ARC FAIL
TRR
t
0
&
0.01-100s
0.1 - 10s
0.01-10s
FT
(For Follower CB)
0.01-10s
[ARC-M]
&
[ARC-M]
+
"SPAR", "SPAR & TPAR"
52A
52B
&
Single-phase trip
5-300s
TW2
&
[ARC-SUC]
"ON"
74
0.2s
FT
(For Follower CB)
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Figure 2.10.2.9 shows the energizing control scheme of the two circuit breakers in the
three-phase autoreclose. OVB and UVB are the overvoltage and undervoltage detectors of
busbar voltage VB in Figure 2.10.2.7. OVL1 and UVL1 are likewise the overvoltage and
undervoltage detectors of line voltage VL1.
OVL2 and UVL2 are likewise the overvoltage and undervoltage detectors of line voltage VL2.
VL2 in the center breaker is equivalent to the busbar voltage VB in the busbar breaker.
SYN1 and SYN2 are the synchronism check elements to check synchronization between the two
sides of the busbar and center breakers, respectively. SYN-OP is a voltage and synchronism
check output.
[VCHK]
"OFF"
"LB1"
"LB2"
"DB"
OVB
UVB
"SYN"
TLBD1
57
&
0.01 - 1s
TDBL1
58
&
0.01 - 1s
&
1
1
&
60
&
T3PLL
OVL1
498
0.01 - 1s
UVL1
159
SYN
-OP
&
&
59
0.01 - 10s
&
1
&
TSYN1
SYN1
&
61
3PLL
(Three phase live line)
TLBD2
OVL2
62
UVL2
63
SYN2
64
&
0.01 - 1s
TDBL2
&
0.01 - 1s
&
&
TSYN2
0.01 - 10s
&
[ARC-CB]
+
"ONE"
"01"
1
ARC-SET
"02"
"L1"
"L2"
Note : [ARC-CB] is set to "ONE" only when the relay is applied to one-breaker system. Trip and reclose
commands are output only for CB1(bus CB).
75
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
The voltage and synchronism check is performed as shown below according to the [ARC-CB]
settings:
Setting of [ARC-CB]
ONE or O1
O2
A voltage and synchronism check is performed using voltages VL1 and VL2.
L1
L2
A voltage and synchronism check is performed for the center breaker using voltages
VL1 and VL2. Then, the logical level of ARC-SET becomes 1 and a voltage and
synchronism check is performed for the busbar breaker using voltages VB and VL1.
Note : "ONE" is set only when the relay is applied to one-breaker system. Trip and reclose
commands are output only for CB1(bus CB).
The energizing control for the two circuit breakers can be set by the scheme switch [VCHK] as
follows:
Setting of [VCHK]
Energizing control
LB1
The lead breaker is reclosed under the "live bus and dead line" condition or with
synchronism check, and the follower breaker is reclosed with synchronism check only.
LB2
The leader breaker is reclosed under the "live bus and dead line" condition or with
synchronism check, and the follower breaker is reclosed under the "dead bus and live
line" condition or with synchronism check.
DB
Both breakers are reclosed under the "dead bus and live line" condition or with
synchronism check.
SYN
OFF
Multi-phase autoreclose
The scheme switch [ARC-M] is set to "MPAR2" or "MPAR3", then the busbar breaker is always
reclosed in the multi-phase autoreclose mode.
The center breaker can select three-phase autoreclose, multi-phase autoreclose or three-phase
final tripping by setting the scheme switch [ARC-CCB] shown in Figure 2.10.2.5.
When [ARC-CCB] is set to "TPAR", the logic level of CCB-SET signal becomes 1 and the
center breaker is reclosed in the three-phase autoreclose mode only after the busbar breaker is
successfully reclosed. If the voltage check condition is configured by the PLC, the energizing
control for the center breaker is dependent on the setting of the scheme switch [VCHK] as
follows.
Setting of [VCHK]
Energizing control
LB
Reclosed under the "live bus and dead line" condition or with synchronism check.
DB
Reclosed under the "dead bus and live line" condition or with synchronism check.
SYN
OFF
76
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Note: As this three-phase autoreclose is applied only to the center breaker, the settings of the
[VCHK] is the same as that of one-breaker autoreclose.
When [ARC-CCB] is set to "MPAR", the center breaker is also reclosed in the multi-phase
autoreclose mode at the time of the TMPR2 setting.
When [ARC-CCB] is set to "OFF", autoreclose does not start for the center breaker.
The scheme switch [ARC-CCB] used in single-phase autoreclose and single- and three-phase
autoreclose is invalid when multi-phase autoreclose is selected as a reclose mode.
The interlinking check scheme for two-breaker autoreclose is shown in Figure 2.10.2.5. Local
interlink check signals CBDS-A, -B and C are originated by ORing the busbar and center
breaker conditions.
The scheme switch [ARC-SUC] is used to check the autoreclose succeeds. If all three phase CB
contacts have been closed within TSUC time after ARC shot output, it is judged that the
autoreclose has succeeded (AS). If not, it is judged that the autoreclose has failed (AF), and
becomes the final tripping (FT).
The relay provides the user configurable switch [UARCSW] with three-positions (P1, P2, P3) to
be programmed by using PLC function. Any position can be selected. If this switch is not used
for the PLC setting, it is invalid. The setting example is shown in Appendix S.
2.10.2.3 Setting
The setting elements necessary for the autoreclose and their setting ranges are shown in the table
below.
Element
Range
Step
Default
Remarks
VT
1 - 20000
2000
VTs1
1 - 20000
2000
TSPR1
0.01 10.00s
0.01s
0.80s
TTPR1
0.01 100.00s
0.01s
0.60s
TMPR1
0.01 100.00s
0.01s
0.80s
TRR
0.01 100.00s
0.01s
2.00s
TEVLV
0.01 10.00s
0.01s
0.30s
TRDY1
5 300s
1s
60s
Reclaim time
SYN1
Synchronism check
SY1
5 75
30
SY1UV
10 150V
1V
83V
SY1OV
10 150V
1V
51V
OVB
10 150V
1V
51V
UVB
10 150V
1V
13 V
OVL1
10 150V
1V
51V
UVL1
10 150V
1V
13V
TSYN1
0.01 10.00s
0.01s
1.00s
TLBD1
0.01 1.00s
0.01s
0.05s
TDBL1
0.01 1.00s
0.01s
0.05s
77
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
T3PLL
0.01 1.00s
0.01s
0.05s
TW1
0.1 10.0s
0.1s
0.2s
TS2
5.0 300.0s
0.1s
20.0s
TS3
5.0 300.0s
0.1s
20.0s
TS4
5.0 300.0s
0.1s
20.0s
TS2R
5.0 300.0s
0.1s
30.0s
TS3R
5.0 300.0s
0.1s
30.0s
TS4R
5.0 300.0s
0.1s
30.0s
TSUC
0.1 10.0s
0.1s
3.0s
[ARC M]
Disabled/SPAR/TPAR/
SPAR & TPAR/MPAR2/MPAR3/
EXT1P/EXT3P/EXTMP
Autoreclose mode
[ARCDIFG]
OFF/ON
OFF
[ARC-BU]
OFF/ON
OFF
[ARC-EXT]
OFF/ON
OFF
External start
[ARC SM]
OFF/S2/S3/S4
OFF
[ARC-SUC]
OFF/ON
OFF
[MA-NOLK]
FT/T/S+T
FT
[VCHK]
OFF/LB/DB/SYN
LB
Energizing direction
[VTPHSEL]
A/B/C
[VT RATE]
PH/G / PH/PH
PH/G
VT rating
[3PH VT]
BUS/LINE
LINE
[UARCSW]
P1/P2/P3
(P1)()
()
Line
GRL100
VT setting
Line VT
VL
VTs1 setting
Reference voltage
VB
for voltage and
synchronism check
Busbar VT
Figure 2.10.2.10 VT and VTs1 Ratio Setting for Busbar or Line Voltage
78
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
To determine the dead time, it is essential to find an optimal value while taking into
consideration the de-ionization time and power system stability factors, which normally
contradict each other.
Normally, a longer de-ionization time is required for a higher line voltage or larger fault current.
For three-phase autoreclose, the dead time is generally 15 to 30 cycles. In single-phase
autoreclose, the secondary arc current induced from the healthy phases may affect the
de-ionization time. Therefore, it is necessary to set a longer dead time for single-phase
autoreclose compared to that for three-phase autoreclose.
In three-phase autoreclose, if the voltage and synchronism check does not operate within the
period of time set on the on-delay timer TRR, which is started at the same time as the dead time
counter TTPR1 is started, reclosing is not performed and three-phase autoreclose is reset to its
initial state. Therefore, for example, the TRR is set to the time setting of the TTPR1 plus 100ms.
The TEVLV determines the possibility of three-phase reclosing for an evolving fault.
When the TEVLV is set to the same setting as the TSPR, three-phase reclosing is performed for
all evolving faults. As the setting for the TEVLV is made shorter, the possibility of three-phase
reclosing for an evolving fault becomes smaller and that of three-phase final tripping becomes
larger.
For the two-breaker autoreclose, the following additional settings are required.
Element
Range
Step
Default
Remarks
VTs2
1 - 20000
2000
TSPR2
0.1 10.0s
0.1s
0.1s
TTPR2
0.1 10.0s
0.1s
0.1s
TMPR2
0.1 10.0s
0.1s
0.1s
TRDY2
5 300s
1s
60s
SYN2
Synchronism check
SY2
5 75
30
SY2UV
10 150V
1V
83V
SY2OV
10 150V
1V
51V
OVL2
10 150V
1V
51V
UVL2
10 150V
1V
13V
TSYN2
0.01 10.00s
0.01s
1.00s
TLBD2
0.01 1.00s
0.01s
0.05s
TDBL2
0.01 1.00s
0.01s
0.05s
TW2
0.1 10.0s
0.1s
0.2s
[ARC-CB]
ONE/O1/O2/L1/L2
L1
[ARC-CCB]
TPAR/MPAR/OFF
MPAR
[VCHK]
OFF/LB1/LB2/DB/SYN
LB1
Energizing direction
Note : [ARC-CB] is set to "ONE" only when the relay is applied to one-breaker system. Trip and
reclose commands are output only for CB1(bus CB).
79
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
2.10.3 Autoreclose Output Signals
The autoreclose scheme logic has two output reclosing signals: ARC1 and ARC2. ARC1 is a
reclosing signal for single breaker autoreclose or a reclosing signal for the busbar breaker in a
two-breaker autoreclose scheme.
ARC2 is the reclosing signal for the center breaker of the two-breaker autoreclose scheme.
The assignment of these reclosing signals to the output relays can be configured, which is done
using the setting menu. For details, see Section 3.2.2. For the default setting, see Appendix D.
80
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
5/6 DIFI1
A
Small current region
2 DIFI2
81
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Iout
Iout = Iin
DIFI2
B
A
Operating
Zone
DIFI1
Iin
Operating
Zone
5/6 DIFGI
Ir
The characteristic of the DIFG element is the same as that of the DIF element in the small current
region and is expressed by the following equation:
82
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Id (1/6)Ir + (5/6)DIFGI
where DIFGI is a setting and defines the minimum residual fault current.
2.11.3 Inverse Definite Minimum Time (IDMT) Overcurrent Element OCI and EFI
As shown in Figure 2.11.3.1, the IDMT element has one long time inverse characteristic and
three inverse time characteristics in conformity with IEC 60255-3. One of these characteristics
can be selected.
TD=1
(s)
200
100
50
20
Operating
time t
10
Long-time Inverse
5
Standard Inverse
1
Very Inverse
0.5
0.2
Extremely Invease
0.1
1
10
20
30
83
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Standard Inverse
0.14
t=T
(I/Is)0.02 1
Very Inverse
t=T
13.5
(I/Is) 1
Extremely Inverse
80
t=T
(I/Is)2 1
where,
t = operating time
I = fault current
Is = current setting
T = time multiplier setting
-zone
1V
VA
-zone
VB is further required to stay at each quadrant for a set time (1.5 cycles) to avoid the influence of
any VT transient.
Positive phase voltages are used and valid for VA and VB when their amplitudes are larger than
1V.
84
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
2.11.6 Voltage and Synchronism Check Elements OVL, UVL, OVB, UVB and SYN
The voltage check and synchronism check elements are used for autoreclose.
The output of the voltage check element is used to check whether the line and busbar are dead or
live. The voltage check element has undervoltage detectors UVL and UVB, and overvoltage
detectors OVL and OVB for the line voltage and busbar voltage check. The undervoltage
detector checks that the line or busbar is dead while the overvoltage detector checks that it is live.
Figure 2.11.6.1 shows the characteristics of the synchronism check element used for the
autoreclose if the line and busbar are live.
The synchronism check element operates if both the voltage difference and phase angle
difference are within their setting values.
VL
SY1
VB
SY1OV
SY1UV
85
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Note: When the phase difference setting and the synchronism check time setting are given,
a detected maximum slip cycle is determined by the following equation:
f=
SY1
180TSYN1
where,
f = slip cycle
SY1 = phase difference setting (degree)
TSYN1 = setting of synchronism check timer (second)
Is
IM
86
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Multi-level overcurrent element OCMF
The OCMF is used as a fault detector for the out-of-step protection.
The current fluctuates in an out-of-step situation. To detect this current securely, the OCMF has
seven current level detectors. Each current level detector LD1 to LD7 operates when the current
exceeds each setting L1 to L7 and resets when the current falls below 80% of the setting. The
settings are fixed as shown in Table 2.11.9.1 as a ratio to the rated current In.
Figure 2.11.9.1 shows the characteristics of the OCMF element.
Table 2.11.9.1 Level Detector Settings
Detector
Operate
Reset
LD1
0.10In
0.08In
LD2
0.16
0.13
LD3
0.26
0.21
LD4
0.41
0.33
LD5
0.66
0.53
LD6
1.05
0.84
LD7
1.68
1.34
L1
L2 L3 L4 L5 L6
L7
D.O./P.U.=0.8
Figure 2.11.9.2 shows the OCMF output logic. The OCMF operates and keeps operating for five
seconds when any of the level detectors operate and reset without time delay when all of the level
detectors reset.
The level detection is performed for phase-to-phase current on A- and B-phase.
87
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Single Shot
LD1
&
5s
1
LD2
&
5s
OCMF
Output
LD1
&
5s
88
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Terminal B
GRL100
GRL100
Terminal A
GRL100
GRL100
GRL100
Terminal C
Terminal B
GRL100
GRL100
The variation of the channel delay time due to switching the route of the channel is automatically
corrected in the relay and does not influence the synchronized sampling provided the sending
and receiving channels take the same route. If the routes are separate, the transmission delay
difference time must be set (see Section 2.2.7).
When the route is switched in A- or B-mode application, the synchronized sampling recovers
within 4s in case of a two- terminal line and 6s in case of a three-terminal line after the switching.
The differential element is blocked until the sampling synchronization is established.
In GPS-mode application (GPS-based synchronization), the sampling synchronization is not
influenced by the route switch. The differential element is only blocked for the duration of the
path switching.
89
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
2.12.2 Linking to Communication Circuit
The GRL100 can be provided with one of the following interfaces by order type and linked to a
dedicated optical fiber communication circuit or multiplexed communication circuit.
Optical interface (1310nm, SM, 30km class)
Optical interface (1550nm, DSF(Dispersion Shifted Fibre), 80km class) (*)
Optical interface (820nm, GI, 2km class)
Electrical interface in accordance with CCITT-G703-1.2.1
Electrical interface in accordance with CCITT-G703-1.2.2 and 1.2.3
Electrical interface in accordance with CCITT X.21
Electrical interface in accordance with RS422, RS530
Note (*): When using the 80km class optical interface, it is necessary to ensure that the received
optical power does not exceed 10dB, in order to avoid communication failure due to
overloading of the receive.
When testing in loop-back mode, for instance, the sending terminal should be connected
to the receiving terminal via an optical attenuator with 10 dB or more attenuation.
Even if the sending terminal is directly connected to the receiving terminal, the optical
transceiver will not be damaged, but communication failures may occur.
- Fibre Coupled Power: 5 to 0dBm
- Input Power Range: 34 to 10dBm
- Optical Damage Input Level: 3dBm
Alternative links to the telecommunication circuit are shown in Figure 2.12.2.1 (a) to (c).
Direct link
When connected to single-mode (SM) 10/125m type of dedicated optical fiber communication
circuits and using Duplex LC type connector for 30km class, the optical transmitter is an LD
with output power of more than 13dBm and the optical receiver is a PIN diode with a sensitivity
of less than 30dBm. For 80km class, the optical transmitter is an LD with output power of more
than 5dBm and the optical receiver is a PIN diode with a sensitivity of less than 34dBm.
When connected to graded-index (GI) multi-mode 50/125m type or 62.5/125m type of
dedicated optical fiber telecommunication circuit and using an ST type connector, the optical
transmitter is an LED with output power of more than 19dBm or 16dBm and the optical
receiver is a PIN diode with a sensitivity of less than 24dBm.
For details, refer to Appendix K.
Link via multiplexer
The GRL100 can be linked to a multiplexed communication circuit with an electrical or optical
interface. The electrical interface supports CCITT G703-1.2.1, G703-1.2.2 and -1.2.3,
X.21(RS530,RS422). Twisted pair cable with shield (<60m) is used for connecting the relay and
multiplexer for the electrical interface.
A D-sub connector (DB-25) or an ST connector is used for electrical linking and optical linking,
respectively.
Optical/electrical converter is provided at the end of the multiplexer. The electrical interface
between the converter and the multiplexer supports CCITT G703-1.2.1, G703-1.2.2 and -1.2.3,
X.21(RS530,RS422).
Optical fiber circuit
GRL100
90
Optical interface
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Multiplexed circuit
MUX
Electrical interface
Optical
fibers
O/E
GRL100
MUX
Optical interface
91
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Terminal B
Terminal A
GRL100
GRL100
TX1
TX1
RX1
RX1
CH1
CH1
Terminal B
GRL100
GRL100
TX1
TX1
CH1
O/E
RX1
M
U
X
M
U
X
O/E
CH1
RX1
MUX: Multiplexer
O/E: Optical interface unit
Terminal A
GRL100
GRL100
12
25
TX1
11
24
10
23
CH1
RX1
9
22
8
21
CK1
Shield
ground
7
20
12
P
N
25
11
M
U
X
M
U
X
TX1
24
10
23
22
13
CH1
RX1
8
21
7
20
CK1
13
Shield
ground
Terminal A
GRL100
GRL100
12
25
TX1
10
23
RX1
9
22
8
21
CK1
7
20
Shield
ground
11
24
CH1
P
N
M
U
X
M
U
X
P
N
13
19
17
RX2
3
16
2
15
CK2
1
14
TX1
24
10
23
9
RX1
CH1
22
8
21
7
CK1
Shield
ground
19
18
CH2
11
13
5
18
25
20
TX2
12
P
N
M
U
X
M
U
X
P
N
TX2
4
17
3
RX2
CH2
16
2
15
1
CK2
14
92
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Terminal B
Terminal A
GRL100
Signal ground
TX1
GRL100
7
2
14
CH1
RX1
3
16
CK1
15
12
Shield
14
16
P
N
M
U
X
M
U
X
15
TX1
RX1
CH1
CK1
12
1
Signal ground
Shield
Terminal A
GRL100
Signal ground
TX1
GRL100
7
2
14
CH1
RX1
3
16
CK1
15
12
Shield
Signal ground
TX2
RX2
7
2
3
16
CK2
15
12
Shield
14
P
N
M
U
X
M
U
X
16
14
CH2
15
Signal ground
14
16
15
TX2
RX2
CH2
CK2
12
1
CH1
CK1
Shield
M
U
X
RX1
M
U
X
TX1
12
Signal ground
Shield
In case of three-terminal applications, signal terminals CH1-TX1, -RX1 and -CK1 which have
the same function as CH2-TX2, -RX2 and -CK2 are added.
Figure 2.12.3.2 shows the communication circuit arrangement for three-terminal applications.
Note that the CH1 signal terminals TX1, RX1 and CK1 of one terminal are interlinked with the
CH2 signal terminals TX2, RX2 and CK2 of another terminal and that the scheme switch
[TERM] is set to "3-TERM". If the same channel is interlinked between both terminals such as
the CH1 signal terminals of one terminal are interlinked with the CH1 signal terminals of another
terminal, the scheme switch setting [CH. CON] should be set to Exchange.
The three-terminal line application models can be applied to a two-terminal line. In this case,
same channels TX, RX and CK of both terminals are interlinked and scheme switch [TERM] is
set to "2-TERM".
The three-terminal models also have dual communication mode as shown in Figure 2.12.3.3.
93
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Terminal A
Terminal B
GRL100
CH1
CH2
GRL100
TX1
TX2
RX1
RX2
CK1
CK2
TX2
TX1
RX2
RX1
CK2
CK1
TX1
TX2
RX1
RX2
CK1
CK2
CH1
CH2
CH1
Terminal C
CH2
GRL100
Terminal A
GRL100
CH1
CH2
GRL100
TX1
TX1
RX1
RX1
CK1
CK1
TX2
TX2
RX2
RX2
CK2
CK2
CH1
CH2
94
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
95
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
2.13.2 Calculation of Distance to Fault
Calculation Principle
In the case of a two-terminal line as shown in Figure 2.13.2.1, the relationship between the
voltages at the local and remote terminals and the voltage at the fault point are expressed by
Equations (1) and (2).
Terminal A
Fault
VA
IA
Terminal B
Vf
VB
IB
VA - Z IA = Vf
(1)
VB - (1 - )Z IB = Vf
(2)
(4)
The distance calculation principle mentioned above can be applied to three-terminal lines. But in
case of three-terminal application, the distance measurement equation varies according to which
zone the fault is in, this side or beyond the junction. Terminal A measures the distance using
Equations (5), (6) or (7).
96
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Terminal A
Junction
Terminal B
VA
IA
VB
IC
ZA
ZB
ZC
VC, IC
Terminal C
97
(8)
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
IB1, IB2 and IB0 = positive, negative and zero sequence current at terminal B
Id1,Id2 and Id0 = positive, negative and zero sequence differential current
Z11, Z12 and Z10 are expressed by the following equations assuming that Zab = Zba, Zbc = Zcb
and Zca = Zac:
Z11 = (Zaa + Zbb + Zcc - Zab - Zbc - Zca)/3
Z12 = (Zaa + a2 Zbb + aZcc + 2(aZab + Zbc + a2Zca))/3
(9)
2.13.5 Setting
The setting items necessary for the fault location and their setting ranges are shown in the table
below.
When setting the line impedance, one of the following methods can be selected.
Inputting phase impedances:
The self-impedances Zaa, Zbb and Zcc and mutual impedances Zab, Zbc and Zca are input
individually using the expression of the resistive components R and reactive components
X.
98
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Inputting positive-sequence impedances:
This can be done provided that Zaa Zbb Zcc and Zab Zbc Zca. The
positive-sequence impedance is input using the expression of the resistive component R1
and reactive component X1.
The resistive and reactive components are input with the secondary values for the line.
Two-terminal application
Item
Range
Fault locator
ON/OFF
Step
Default
Remarks
OFF
Line data
1R1
0.00 - 199.99
(0.0 - 999.9
0.10
0.1
0.20
1.0 )
1X1
0.00 - 199.99
(0.0 - 999.9
0.10
0.1
2.00
10.0 )
1Line
0.0 - 399.9 km
0.1 km
50.0 km
1Raa
0.00 - 199.99
0.10
0.21
1Rbb
(0.0 - 999.9
0.1 )
(1.1 )
(*)
(*)
Line length
or
1Rcc
1Rab
0.01
1Rbc
(0.1 )
1Rca
1Xaa
2.10
1Xbb
(10.5 )
1Xcc
1Xab
0.10
1Xbc
(0.5 )
1Xca
1Line
0.0 - 399.9 km
0.1 km
50.0 km
Line length
(*) Ohmic values shown in the parentheseis are is in the case of 1A rating.
Three-terminal application
When setting the line impedance, the three-terminal line is divided into three sections. The first
section is from the local terminal to the junction, the second is from the junction to remote
terminal 1 and the third is from the junction to remote terminal 2. The line constants are input for
each section in the same way as the two-terminal application.
Note that remote terminals 1 and 2 are automatically set according to the communication system
setup. Remote terminal 1 is a terminal to which local communication port 1 is linked and remote
terminal 2 is a terminal to which local communication port 2 is linked.
99
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Item
Range
Fault locator
Line data
Section 1
1R1
Step
ON/OFF
Default
OFF
1Line
0.00 - 199.99
(0.0 - 999.9
0.00 - 199.99
(0.0 - 999.9
0.0 - 399.9 km
0.10
0.1
0.10
0.1
0.1 km
0.20
1.0 )
2.00
10.0 )
50.0 km
1Raa
0.00 - 199.99
0.10
0.21
1Xaa
1Rbb
(0.0 - 999.9
0.1 )
(1.1 )
1X1
Remarks
(*)
(*)
Line length from local terminal to junction
or
0.01
1Xbb
1Rcc
(0.1 )
1Xcc
1Rab
2.10
1Xab
1Rbc
(10.5 )
1Xbc
1Rca
0.10
1Xca
1Line
Section 2
2R1
(0.5 )
0.0 - 399.9 km
0.1 km
50.0 km
0.00 - 199.99
(0.0 - 999.9
0.10
0.1
0.20
1.0 )
2Line
0.00 - 199.99
(0.0 - 999.9
0.0 - 399.9 km
0.10
0.1
0.1 km
2.00
10.0 )
50.0 km
2Raa
0.00 - 199.99
0.10
0.21
2Xaa
2Rbb
(0.0 - 999.9
0.1 )
(1.1 )
2X1
(*)
(*)
Line length from local terminal to junction
or
0.01
2Xbb
2Rcc
(0.1 )
2Xcc
2Rab
2.10
2Xab
2Rbc
(10.5 )
2Xbc
2Rca
0.10
2Xca
2Line
(0.5 )
0.0 - 399.9 km
0.1 km
50.0 km
100
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Section 3
3R1
0.00 - 199.99
(0.0 - 999.9
0.00 - 199.99
(0.0 - 999.9
0.10
0.1
0.10
0.1
0.20
1.0 )
2.00
10.0 )
3Line
0.0 - 399.9 km
0.1 km
50.0 km
3Raa
0.00 - 199.99
0.10
0.21
3Xaa
3Rbb
(0.0 - 999.9
0.1 )
(1.1 )
3X1
(*)
(*)
Line length from junction to remote terminal 2
or
3Xbb
3Rcc
0.01
(0.1 )
3Xcc
3Rab
3Xab
2.10
(10.5 )
3Rbc
3Xbc
3Rca
3Xca
3Line
0.10
(0.5 )
0.0 - 399.9 km
0.1 km
50.0 km
101
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
3. Technical Description
3.1
Hardware Description
3.1.1
102
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Front view without front panel
VCT
103
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Figure 3.1.1.3 Hardware Structure (Model: 201, 211, 204, 214, 301, 311)
IO#2 SPM
IO#4
IO5
IO5
IO4
IO4
VCT
IO#1
IO#3
Note: IO#1 is IO1 module for models 202, 212, 302 and
311, and is IO8 module for models 206 and 216.
IO#2, IO#3 and IO#4 are IO2, IO5 and IO4 module
respectively.
Figure 3.1.1.4 Hardware Structure (Model: 202, 212, 206, 216, 302, 312)
104
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
5
5
VCT
IO#2 SPM
IO#4
IO#1
IO#3
Note: IO#1, IO#2, IO#3 and IO#4 are IO1, IO2, IO5 and FD
module respectively.
Figure 3.1.1.5 Hardware Structure (Model: 401, 411, 501, 511, 503, 513)
Model
101
102
201
202
204
206
301
302
401
501
503
111
112
211
212
214
216
311
312
411
511
513
VCT
SPM
IO1
IO2
Module
IO3
IO4
IO5
IO6
IO8
HMI
FD
Note: The VCT and SPM modules are not interchangeable among different models.
The hardware block diagrams of the GRL100 using these modules are shown in Figure 3.1.1.6 to
Figure 3.1.1.8.
105
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Telecommunication
system
Binary I/O Module (IO#1)
DC/DC
Converter
Transformer
Module (VCT)
AC input
Photocoupler
MPU2
CT4
Analog
filter
A/D
P/S
E/O
S/P
O/E
15
Auxiliary relay
(High speed)
Converter
MPU1
O/E
External
clock
Fibre opt.
I/F or
Ethernet
LAN I/F
IRIG-B
port
Binary input
Binary output
Trip
command
Binary output
Photocoupler
3
RS485
Transceiver
GPS
LEDs
RS232C
I/F
Binary input
Remote PC
Remote PC
Binary I/O Module (IO#3)(*1)
40characters4lines
Local PC
DC
supply
Operation keys
Auxiliary relay
10
Monitoring jacks
106
Binary output
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Telecommunication
system
Binary I/O Module (IO#1)(*3)
DC/DC
Converter
Transformer
Module (VCT)
Photocoupler
MPU2
CT4
Analog
filter
DC
supply
A/D
P/S
E/O
S/P
O/E
Converter
MPU1
15 or 12(IO8)
Binary input
Auxiliary relay
(High speed)
Binary output
Trip
command
6 or 3(IO8)
AC input
V
VT4
(or VT5)
External
clock
O/E
Fibre opt.
I/F or
Ethernet
LAN I/F
IRIG-B
port
Auxiliary relay
14
Binary output
Photocoupler
3
RS485
Transceiver
Binary input
Remote PC
GPS
Remote PC
Human Machine Interface(HMI)
Binary I/O Module (IO#4) (*1)
Liquid crystal display
40characters4lines
LEDs
RS232C
I/F
Local PC
Operation keys
Photocoupler
3
Binary input
Auxiliary relay
14
Binary output
Monitoring jacks
Binary I/O Module (IO#3) (*1)
Photocoupler
10
Binary input
Auxiliary relay
10
Binary output
(*1) :
(*2) :
Photocoupler
7
Binary input
Auxiliary relay
6
Binary output
107
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Telecommunication
system
Binary I/O Module (IO#1)
DC/DC
Converter
Transformer
Module(VCT)
Photocoupler
15
MPU2
CT4
Analog
(or CT8)
filter
A/D
converter
DC
supply
P/S
S/P
E/O
O/E
Auxiliary relay
(High speed)
Binary input
Binary output
Trip
command
6
MPU1
AC input
Auxiliary relay
(or VT5)
14
O/E
Binary output
Photocoupler
External
clock
Fibre opt.
I/F or
Ethernet
LAN I/F
IRIG-B
port
Binary input
RS485
Transceiver
Remote PC
GPS
Remote PC
40characters4lines
LEDs
Local PC
Auxiliary relay
10
Photocoupler
10
Operation keys
RS232C
I/F
Monitoring jacks
Binary output
Binary input
Filter
A/D
CPU
Auxiliary relay
(High speed)
2
Auxiliary relay
8
108
Binary output
Trip
command
Binary output
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
3.1.2
Transformer Module
The transformer module (VCT module) provides isolation between the internal and external AC
circuits through an auxiliary transformer and transforms the magnitude of AC input signals to
suit the electronic circuits. The AC input signals are as follows:
three-phase currents (Ia, Ib and Ic)
residual current (3Io)
three-phase voltages (Va, Vb and Vc)
autoreclose reference voltage (Vref1)
autoreclose reference voltage (Vref2)
Figure 3.1.2.1 shows a block diagram of the transformer module. There are 4 or 8 auxiliary CTs
mounted in the transformer module, and an additional 4 or 5 auxiliary VTs depending on the
relay model. (The reference between the relay model and number of AC input signals is given in
Table 3.2.1.1.)
Vref1 and Vref2 are the busbar or line voltages necessary for the voltage and synchronism check
for the autoreclose.
The transformer module is also provided with an IRIG-B port. This port collects the serial
IRIG-B format data from the external clock for synchronization of the relay calendar clock. The
IRIG-B port is insulated from the external circuit by a photo-coupler. A BNC connector is used
as the input connector.
Transformer module
Ia
Ib
Ic
3Io
Signal
processing
module
Va
Vb
Vc
Vref1
Vref2
IRIG-B port
External
clock
BNC connector
Figure 3.1.2.1 Transformer Module (e.g. Models 300s, 501 and 511)
109
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
3.1.3
RAM
ROM
MPU2
P/S
E/O
Telecommuni-
S/P
O/E
cation system
Analog filter
Fibre optic or
Ethernet LAN,
etc.
(Option)
Analog
input
Analog filter Multiplexer
A/D
converter
Analog filter
O/E
GPS
MPU1
Other
modules
RAM
ROM
110
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
3.1.4
IO1 and IO8 provide a DC/DC converter, binary inputs and binary outputs for tripping.
As shown in Figure 3.1.4.1, the IO1 module incorporates a DC/DC converter, 15 photo-coupler
circuits (BI) for binary input signals and 6 auxiliary relays (TP-A1 to TP-C2) dedicated to the
circuit breaker tripping command.
As shown in Figure 3.1.4.2, the IO8 module incorporates a DC/DC converter, 12 photo-coupler
circuits (BI) for binary input signals and 3 auxiliary relays (TP) dedicated to the circuit breaker
tripping command. The 12 binary inputs have dedicated positive and negative inputs suitable for
double-pole switching.
The input voltage rating of the DC/DC converter is 24V, 48V, 110V/125V or 220V/250V. The
normal range of input voltage is 20% to +20%.
The six or three tripping command auxiliary relays are the high-speed operation type and have
one normally open output contact.
DC
supply
(+)
()
Line filter
DC/DC
converter
FG
Photo-coupler
Binary
input
signals
( 15)
BI
Auxiliary relay
(high speed)
BI
TP-A1
-
BI
TP-B1
TP-C1
TP-A2
BI
TP-B2
BI
TP-C2
111
Tripping
command
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
IO8 module
DC
supply
(+)
()
Line filter
DC/DC
converter
FG
Photo-coupler
BI
Binary
input
signals
( 12)
Auxiliary relay
(high speed)
BI
-TP
BI
TP
TP
BI
BI
112
Tripping
command
( 3)
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
3.1.4.2
IO2 Module
As shown in Figure 3.1.4.3, the IO2 module incorporates 3 photo-coupler circuits (BI) for binary
input signals, 14 auxiliary relays (13 BOs and FAIL) for binary output signals and an RS485
transceiver.
The auxiliary relay FAIL has one normally closed contact, and operates when a relay failure or
abnormality in the DC circuit is detected. Each BO has one normally open contact. BO13 is a
high-speed operation type.
The RS485 is used for the link with communication system such as RSM (Relay Setting and
Monitoring) or IEC60870-5-103 etc. The external signal is isolated from the relay internal
signal.
Auxiliary relay
IO2 module
BO
Photo-coupler
Binary
input
signals
( 3)
BI
BO
BI
BI
FAIL
BO13
RS-485
113
Binary
output
signals
(BO 13,
FAIL 1)
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
3.1.4.3
The IO3 and IO4 modules are used to increase the number of binary outputs.
The IO3 module incorporates 10 auxiliary relays (BO) for binary outputs. The IO4 module
incorporates 14 auxiliary relays (BO) for binary outputs and 3 photo-coupler circuits (BI). All
auxiliary relays each have one normally open contact.
Auxiliary relay
BO
BO
BO
Binary
output
signals
( 10)
BO
Auxiliary relay
Photo-coupler
BO
BI
Binary
input
signals
( 3)
BO
BI
Binary
output
signals
( 14)
BI
BO
BO
114
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
3.1.4.4
The IO5 and IO6 modules are used to increase the number of binary inputs and outputs.
The IO5 module incorporates 10 photo-coupler circuits (BI) for binary inputs and 10 auxiliary
relays (BO) for binary outputs. The IO6 module incorporates 7 photo-coupler circuits (BI) for
binary inputs and 6 auxiliary relays (BO) for binary outputs. All auxiliary relays each have one
normally open contact.
Auxiliary relay
Photo-coupler
BO
BI
Binary
input
signals
( 10)
BO
BI
BO
Binary
output
signals
( 10)
BI
BO
BI
Auxiliary relay
Photo-coupler
BO
BI
BO
Binary
output
signals
( 6)
BI
Binary
input
signals
( 7)
BO
BI
BO
BI
115
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
3.1.5
Color
Remarks
IN SERVICE
Green
TRIP
Red
ALARM
Red
TESTING
Red
(LED1)
Red
(LED2)
Red
(LED3)
Red
(LED4)
Red
LED1 to LED4 are user-configurable. Each is driven via a logic gate which can be programmed
for OR gate or AND gate operation. Further, each LED has a programmable reset characteristic,
settable for instantaneous drop-off, or for latching operation. For the setting, see Section
4.2.6.10. For the operation, see Section 4.2.1.
The model 100, 200 and 300 series provide the scheme switch [AOLED] which controls whether
the TRIP LED is lit or not by an output of alarm element such as THM_ALARM, etc.
The VIEW key starts the LCD indication and switches between windows. The reset key clears
the LCD indication and turns off the LCD backlight.
The operation keys are used to display the record, status and setting data on the LCD, input the
settings or change the settings.
The monitoring jacks and two pairs of LEDs, A and B, on top of the jacks can be used while the
test mode is selected in the LCD window. Signals can be displayed on LED A or LED B by
selecting the signal to be observed from the "Signal List" or "Variable Timer List" and setting it
in the window and the signals can be output to an oscilloscope via the monitoring jacks. (For the
"Signal List" or "Variable Timer List", see Appendix B or C.)
The RS232C connector is a 9-way D-type connector for serial RS232C connection. This
connector is used for connection with a local personal computer.
116
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Liquid
crystal
display
Light
emitting
diode
GRL100
201B-31-10
100/110/115/120V
Operation
keys
Monitoring
jack
RS232C connector
117
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
3.1.6
Auxiliary relay
(high speed)
Analog filter
FD1
Analog filter
Analog
input
A/D
Multiplexer
Tripping
command
MPU
converter
FD2
Auxiliary relay
Analog filter
BO1
Binary
output
signals
BO8
118
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
3.2
Input Signals
AC input signals
Table 3.2.1.1 shows the AC input signals necessary for each of the GRL100 models and their
respective input terminal numbers. The AC input signals are input via terminal block TB1 for all
models. See Appendix G for external connections.
The basic 100 series models require 4 current inputs. The 200 to 500 series models, which have
charging current compensation, require a further 3 voltage inputs.
The 200 to 500 series models with the autoreclose function also require an additional voltage
signal for voltage and synchronism checks. For single or double busbar applications, one voltage
signal is required, while for one-and-a-half circuit breaker arrangements, two voltage signals are
required.
In the latter case, the busbar or line voltage of the protected line and the line voltage of the
adjacent line should be input to terminals 15 and 16 and terminals 17 and 18 for models 301, 311,
302, 312, 501 and 511, and Terminal 25-26 and 27-28 for models 503 and 513 respectively. (For
the busbar and line voltages, see Figure 2.10.2.7.)
Table 3.2.1.1 AC Input Signals
Terminal
No.
1-2
3-4
5-6
7-8
9-10
11-14
12-14
13-14
15-16
17-18
20
21-24
22-24
23-24
25-26
27-28
30
GRL100-101, 102,
111,112
GRL100-503, 513
A-phase Current
B-phase Current
C-phase Current
Residual Current
A-phase Current
B-phase Current
C-phase Current
Residual Current
A-phase Current
B-phase Current
C-phase Current
Residual Current
A-phase Current
B-phase Current
C-phase Current
Residual Current
A-phase Voltage
B-phase Voltage
C-phase Voltage
Voltage for Autoreclose
A-phase Voltage
B-phase Voltage
C-phase Voltage
Voltage for Autoreclose
Voltage for Autoreclose
(earth)
A-phase Current
B-phase Current
C-phase Current
Residual Current
(earth)
(earth)
A-phase Voltage
B-phase Voltage
C-phase Voltage
Voltage for Autoreclose
Voltage for Autoreclose
(earth)
119
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Binary input signals
Table 3.2.1.2 shows the binary input signals necessary for the GRL100, their driving contact
conditions and functions enabled.
Input signals are configurable and depend on the GRL100 models. See Appendix G for the
default settings and external connections.
Note: For the three-phase binary input signals of Interlink A, B and C, interlink signals of the
parallel line are applied.
The interlink signals are assigned to the binary output relays as LINK-A1, -B1 and -C1 in
two-terminal line application and as LINK-A1, -B1 and -C1 and LINK-A2, -B2 and -C2 in
the three-terminal line application. For the default setting, see Appendix D.
Two-terminal line application: Apply the LINK-A1, -B1 and -C1 contacts of the parallel line
to the binary input signals of Interlink A, B and C (Terminal 1).
Three-terminal line application: Apply the LINK-A1, -B1 and -C1 contacts of the parallel
line to Interlink A, B and C (Terminal 1) and LINK-A2, -B2 and -C2 contacts to Interlink A,
B and C (Terminal 2) respectively.
The binary input circuit of the GRL100 is provided with a logic level inversion function as
shown in Figure 3.2.1.1. Each input circuit has a binary switch BISW which can be used to select
either normal or inverted operation. This allows the inputs to be driven either by normally open
or normally closed contact.
If a signal is not input, the function concerned is disabled.
Further, all binary input functions are programmable by PLC (Programmable Logic Controller)
function.
The default setting of the binary input is shown in Table 3.2.1.2.
Table 3.2.1.2 Binary Input Signals for Models 11, 21, 22, 31, 32, 41, 51 and 53
Module
Name
BI No.
Contents
IO#1
BI1
BI2
BI3
BI4
BI5
BI6
BI7
BI8
BI9
BI10
BI11
BI12
BI13
BI14
BI15
IO#2
BI16
EXTERNAL TRIP - A Ph
BI17
EXTERNAL TRIP - B Ph
BI18
EXTERNAL TRIP - C Ph
BI19
BI20
BI21
BI22
BI23
BI24
BI25
BI26
BI27
BI28
BI34
BI35
BI36
INTERLINK A (TERMINAL 1)
INTERLINK B (TERMINAL 1)
INTERLINK C (TERMINAL 1)
CB1 AUTORECLISNG READY
CB2 AUTORECLISNG READY
AUTORECLOSING BLOCK COMMAND
Spare
INTERLINK A (TERMINAL 2)
INTERLINK B (TERMINAL 2)
INTERLINK C (TERMINAL 2)
Spare
Spare
Spare
IO#3
IO#4
Setting
Signal No. & Signal Name
Norm or Inv
1536
CB1_CONT-A
1537
CB1_CONT-B
1538
CB1_CONT-C
1539
CB2_CONT-A
1540
CB2_CONT-B
1541
CB2_CONT-C
1542
DS_N/O_CONT
1543
DS_N/C_CONT
1544
CRT_BLOCK
1545
CB_CLOSE
1546
DC_SUPPLY
1547
85S1
1548
85S2
1549
IND.RESET
1550
BUT_BLOCK
1552
EXT_TRIP-A
1556
EXT_CBFIN-A
See the BISW setting
1553
EXT_TRIP-B
in Relay setting sheet
1557
EXT_CBFIN-B
1554
EXT_TRIP-C
1558
EXT_CBFIN-C
1568
INT.LINK1-A
1569
INT.LINK1-B
1570
INT.LINK1-C
1571
CB1_READY
1572
CB2_READY
1573
ARC_RESET
1575
1576
1577
INT.LINK2-A
INT.LINK2-B
INT.LINK2-C
Note (): If the binary input of DC power supply is OFF, the ready signal of relay is OFF and the
message Term rdy off is displayed. See Section 3.3.6.
120
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Table 3.2.1.3 Binary Input Signals for Models 24 and 26
Module
Name
Setting
Contents
BI No.
IO#1
BI1
BI2
BI3
BI4
BI5
BI6
BI7
BI8
BI9
BI10
BI11
BI12
IO#2
BI16
EXTERNAL TRIP - A Ph
BI17
EXTERNAL TRIP - B Ph
BI18
EXTERNAL TRIP - C Ph
BI19
BI20
BI21
BI22
BI23
BI24
BI25
BI26
BI27
BI28
BI34
BI35
BI36
Spare
Spare
Spare
CB1 AUTORECLISNG READY
CB2 AUTORECLISNG READY
AUTORECLOSING BLOCK COMMAND
Spare
Spare
Spare
Spare
Spare
Spare
Spare
IO#3
IO#4
1571
1572
1573
Norm or Inv
CB1_READY
CB2_READY
ARC_RESET
Note (): If the binary input of DC power supply is OFF, the ready signal of relay is OFF and the
message Term rdy off is displayed. See Section 3.3.6.
(+) ()
Signal No.
[BISW1]
BI1
BI1
BI1 command
"Inv"
[BISW2]
BI2
BI2
BI2 command
"Norm"
1
"Inv"
BIn command
[BISWn]
BIn
BIn
PLC logic
"Norm"
"Norm"
"Inv"
0V
121
Protection
schemes
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
3.2.2
Signal List
"ON"
&
Appendix B
6 GATES
OR
t
0.2s
Auxiliary relay
&
1
6 GATES
3.2.3
122
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
3.3
Automatic Supervision
3.3.1
3.3.2
When a failure occurs, it should be able to easily identify the location of the failure.
Relay Monitoring
The following items are supervised:
AC input imbalance monitoring
The AC voltage and current inputs are monitored to check that the following equations are
satisfied and the health of the AC input circuits is checked.
Zero sequence voltage monitoring
|Va + Vb + Vc| / 3 6.35(V)
Negative sequence voltage monitoring
|Va + a2Vb + aVc| / 3 6.35(V)
where,
a = Phase shifter of 120
Zero sequence current monitoring
|Ia + Ib + Ic 3Io| / 3 0.1 Max(|Ia|, |Ib|, |Ic|) + k0
where,
3Io = Residual current
Max(|Ia|, |Ib|, |Ic|) = Maximum amplitude among Ia, Ib and Ic
k0 = 5% of rated current
These zero sequence monitoring and negative sequence monitoring allow high-sensitivity
detection of failures that have occurred in the AC input circuits.
The negative sequence voltage monitoring allows high sensitivity detection of failures in the
voltage input circuit, and it is effective for detection particularly when cables have been
connected with the incorrect phase sequence.
The zero sequence current monitoring allows high-sensitivity detection of failures irrespective
of the presence of the zero sequence current on the power system by introduction of the residual
circuit current.
Only zero sequence monitoring is carried out for the current input circuit, because zero sequence
123
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
monitoring with the introduction of the residual circuit current can be performed with higher
sensitivity than negative sequence monitoring.
A/D accuracy checking
An analog reference voltage is input to a prescribed channel in the analog-to-digital (A/D)
converter, and the system checks that the data after A/D conversion is within the prescribed
range and that the A/D conversion characteristics are correct.
Memory monitoring
The memories are monitored as follows depending on the type of memory, and the health of the
memory circuits is checked:
Random access memory monitoring:
Writes/reads prescribed data and checks the storage
function.
Program memory monitoring: Checks the checksum value of the written data.
Setting value monitoring:
Watchdog Timer
A hardware timer, which is cleared periodically by software, is provided and the system checks
that the software is running normally.
DC Supply monitoring
The secondary voltage level of the built-in DC/DC converter is monitored and the system checks
that the DC voltage is within the prescribed range. If a failure is detected, the relay trip is blocked
and the alarm is issued.
Furthermore, DC supply is monitored by using the binary input signal in the current differential
protection. If the binary input signal is OFF (= DC supply OFF or Failure), the ready
condition of the differential protection is OFF and both local and remote relays are blocked.
(Refer to Table 3.2.1.2.) This monitoring is provided to surely block the unwanted operation of
remote terminal relays caused by sending the remote terminals an uncertain data even for short
time at DC supply off or failure, though the former monitoring is enough at DC supply off or
failure in general.
Tripping output monitoring
The system monitors the tripping output contacts and checks that they do not maintain the
"make" state exceeding the prescribed time, to ensure that there is no false operation failure in
the tripping output circuit. This item is implemented for models 400s and 500s which have a
fault detector (FD).
3.3.3
124
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
k0 = 20% of rated current
The CT circuit current monitoring allows high sensitivity detection of failures that have occurred
in the AC input circuit. This monitoring can be disabled by the scheme switch [CTSV].
3.3.4
Off: Disabled.
On: Enabled. If once CTF is detected, the CTF function cannot be reset until ID is
reset.
OPT-On: Enabled. After CTF is detected, the CTF function is reset if CTFUV,
CTFDV or CTFOVG operates.
Detection logic
Figure 3.3.4.1 shows the CTF detection logic.
CTFID
CTFUV
CTFUVD
CTFOVG
381:CTFID-A
382:CTFID-B
383:CTFID-C
&
388:CTFUV-A
389:CTFUV-B
390:CTFUV-C
392:CTFUVD-A
393:CTFUVD-B
394:CTFUVD-C
1
1
&
391:CTFOVG
CTF detection
CTF detection
Setting
The setting elements necessary for the CTF and their setting ranges are as follows:
Element
CFID
CFUV
CFDV
CFOVG
[CTFEN]
[CTFCNT]
Range
0.25 - 5.00 A
( 0.05 - 1.00 A
20 - 60 V
1 - 10 %
0.1 - 10.0 V
Off/On/OPT-On
NA / BLK
Step
0.1 A
0.01 A
1V
1%
0.1 V
Default
0.25 A
0.05 A) (*)
20 V
7%
1.0 V
Off
NA
Remarks
Id current level
% of rated voltage
Zero-sequence voltage
CTF enabled or not
Control by CTF detection
(*) Current values shown in the parentheses are in the case of 1 A rating. Other current values are in
the case of 5 A rating.
125
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
3.3.5
3.3.6
3.3.7
3.3.8
3.3.9
Disconnector Monitoring
The disconnector is monitored because the disconnector contact signal is used for the
out-of-service terminal detection and for the stub fault protection in the one-and-a-half busbar
system.
126
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
To monitor the disconnector, one pair of normally open contacts 89A and normally closed
contacts 89B are introduced. Disconnector failure is detected when both 89A and 89B are
simultaneously in the open or closed state for the prescribed period.
The monitoring is blocked by setting the scheme switch [LSSV] to OFF. The default setting of
[LSSV] is OFF to prevent a false failure detection when the disconnector contacts are not
introduced.
The alarms can be disabled collectively by setting the scheme switch [AMF] to OFF. This setting
is used to block unnecessary alarms during commissioning tests or maintenance.
When the Watch Dog Timer detects that the software is not running normally, LCD display and
event recording of the failure may not function normally.
A DC supply failure disables the LCD display and event recording of the failure as well.
For details of discrimination of the two failures mentioned above, see Section 6.7.2.
Table 3.3.10.1 Supervision Items and Alarms
Supervision Item
LCD
message
LED
"IN SERVICE"
LED
"ALARM"
(1)
on/off (2)
on
(4)
(1)
on/off (7)
on
(4)
CT err
(1)
off
on
(4)
Relay fail
off
off
on
on
on
on
on
on
on
on
on
on
on/off (6)
on
on
on
(3)
on
on
off
on
off
off
off
on
on
on
on
on
on
(4)
(4)
(4)
(5)
(5)
(4)
(5)
(5)
(5)
(5)
(5)
(4)
(4)
(5)
(5)
External
alarm
Event
record message
V0 err / V2 err /
I0 err
DC supply
Relay fail
Com. fail
Com. fail-R (*)
Sync. fail (*)
TX level err (*)
RX level err (*)
CLK. fail (*)
Term. rdy off (*)
GPS 1PPS off
DS fail
Relay fail
RYID err
CTF
(*)
takes 1 or 2 according to the channel linking, either with remote terminal 1 or 2.
(1) There are various messages such as " err" and " fail" as shown in the table in Section 6.7.2.
127
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
(2) The LED is on when the scheme switch [SVCNT] is set to "ALM", and off when "ALM &
BLK" (refer to Section 3.3.11).
(3) Whether the LED is lit or not depends on the degree of voltage drop.
(4) The binary output relay "FAIL" operates.
(5) The user-configurable binary output relays operate if the signal assigned.
(6) The LED is on when the scheme switch [IDSV] is set to "ALM", and off when "ALM & BLK".
(7) The LED is on when the scheme switch [CTSV] is set to "ALM", and off when "ALM & BLK".
3.3.12 Setting
The setting elements necessary for the automatic supervision and their setting ranges are shown
in the table below.
Element
Range
Step
Default
Remarks
DIFSV
0.25 10.00A
0.01A
0.50A
(0.05 2.00A
0.01A
0.10A) ()
TIDSV
0 60s
1s
10s
RYID
0-63
RYID1
0-63
RYID2
0-63
[IDSV]
OFF/ALM&BLK/ALM
OFF
[RYIDSV]
OFF/ON
ON
[LSSV]
ON/OFF
OFF
Disconnector monitoring
[SVCNT]
ALM&BLK/ALM
ALM&BLK
[CTSV]
OFF/ALM&BLK/ALM
OFF
CT circuit monitoring
() Current values shown in parentheses are in the case of 1A rating. Other current values are in the
case of 5A rating.
128
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
3.4
Recording Function
The GRL100 is provided with the following recording functions:
Fault recording
Event recording
Disturbance recording
These records are displayed on the LCD of the relay front panel or on the local or remote PC.
3.4.1
Fault Recording
Fault recording is started by a tripping command of the GRL100, a tripping command of the
external main protection or PLC command by user-setting (max. 4) and the following items are
recorded for one fault:
Date and time of fault occurrence
Faulted phase
Tripping phase
Tripping mode
Fault location
Relevant events
Power system quantities
Up to 8 most-recent faults are stored as fault records. If a new fault occurs when 8 faults have
been stored, the record of the oldest fault is deleted and the record of the latest fault is then
stored.
Date and time of fault occurrence
This shows the protection scheme that outputted the tripping command.
Fault location
The distance to the fault point calculated by the fault locator is recorded.
The distance is expressed in km and as a percentage (%) of the line length in two-terminal
application. In case of three-terminal application, the distance in km and the section on the fault
point are displayed.
For the fault locator, see Section 2.13.
Relevant events
Such events as autoreclose, re-tripping following the reclose-on-to-a fault or autoreclose and
tripping for evolving faults are recorded with time-tags.
129
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Power system quantities
The following power system quantities in pre-faults and post-faults are recorded. The power
system quantities are not recorded for evolving faults.
-
Magnitude and phase angle of phase current at the local terminal (Ia, Ib, Ic)
Magnitude and phase angle of phase voltage for autoreclose (Vs1, Vs2)
Magnitude and phase angle of symmetrical component voltage (V1, V2, V0)
Magnitude and phase angle of symmetrical component current at the local terminal (I1, I2,
I0)
Magnitude and phase angle of positive sequence voltage at the remote terminal 1 and 2 (V11,
V12)
Magnitude and phase angle of phase current and residual current at the remote terminal 1
(Ia1, Ib1, Ic1, I01)
Magnitude and phase angle of phase current and residual current at the remote terminal 2
(Ia2, Ib2, Ic2, I02)
Phase angles above are expressed taking that of positive sequence voltage or positive sequence
current when the voltage is small or no voltage is input) as a reference phase angle.
3.4.2
Event Recording
The events shown are recorded with a 1 ms resolution time-tag when the status changes. The user
can set the maximum 128 recording items and their status change mode. The event recording is
initiated by a binary input signal. The event items can be assigned to a signal number in the
signal list. The status change mode is set to On (only recording when On.) or
On/Off(recording when both On and Off.) mode by setting. The items of On/Off mode are
specified by Bi-trigger events setting. If the Bi-trigger events is set to 100, No.1 to 100
events are On/Off mode and No.101 to 128 events are On mode.
The name of event can be set by RSM100. Maximum 22 characters can be set, but LCD displays
up to 11 characters of them. Therefore, it is recommended the maximum characters are set. The
set name can be viewed on the Setting(view) screen.
The elements necessary for event recording and their setting ranges are shown in the table below.
The default setting of event record is shown in Appendix H.
Element
Range
Step
Default
Remarks
BITRN
0 - 128
100
EV1 EV128
0 - 3071
Up to 480 records can be stored. If an additional event occurs when 480 records have been
stored, the oldest event record is deleted and the latest event record is then stored.
130
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
3.4.3
Disturbance Recording
Disturbance recording is started when overcurrent or undervoltage starter elements operate or a
tripping command is output, or PLC command by user-setting (max. 4: Signal No. 2632 to 2635)
is outputted. The records include 19 analog signals (local terminal: Va, Vb, Vc, Ia, Ib, Ic, 3I0,
Ida, Idb, Idc, Id0, remote terminal 1: Ia1, Ib1, Ic1, 3I01 remote terminal 2: Ia2, Ib2, Ic2, 3I02), 32
binary signals and the dates and times at which recording started. Any binary signal shown in
Appendix B can be assigned by signal setting of disturbance record. The default setting of binary
signal is shown in Appendix H.
The name of binary signal can be set by RSM100. Maximum 22 characters can be set, but LCD
displays up to 11 characters of them. Therefore, it is recommended the maximum characters are
set. The set name can be viewed on the Setting(view) screen.
The LCD display only shows the dates and times of disturbance records stored. Details can be
displayed on the PC. For how to obtain disturbance records on the PC, see the PC software
instruction manual.
The pre-fault recording time is fixed at 0.3s and the post-fault recording time can be set between
0.1 and 3.0s and the default setting is 1.0s.
The number of records stored depends on the post-fault recording time and the relay model. The
typical number of records stored in 50Hz and 60Hz power system is shown in Table 3.4.3.1.
Note: If the recording time setting is changed, the records stored so far are deleted.
Table 3.4.3.1 Post Fault Recording Time and Number of Disturbance Records Stored
Recording time
0.1s
0.5s
1.0s
1.5s
2.0s
2.5s
3.0s
50Hz
36
18
11
60Hz
30
15
Setting
The elements necessary for starting disturbance recording and their setting ranges are shown in
the table below. The model 100 series does not provide UVP-S and UVP-G elements.
Element
Range
Step
Default
Remarks
Timer
0.1-3.0 s
0.1 s
1.0 s
OCP-S
0.5-250.0 A
0.1 A
10.0 A
(0.1-50.0 A
0.1 A
2.0 A) (*)
0.5-250.0 A
0.1 A
5.0 A
(0.1-50.0 A
0.1 A
1.0 A)
UVP-S
0-132 V
1V
88 V
UVP-G
0-76 V
1V
51 V
OCP-G
(*) Current values shown in the parentheses are in the case of 1A rating. Other current values are in
the case of 5A rating.
Starting the disturbance recording by a tripping command or the starter elements listed above is
enabled or disabled by setting the following scheme switches with identical names with the
starter elements except the switch [TRIP].
131
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Element
Range
[TRIP]
Step
Default
Remarks
ON/OFF
ON
[OCP-S]
ON/OFF
ON
[OCP-G]
ON/OFF
ON
[UVP-S]
ON/OFF
ON
[UVP-G]
ON/OFF
ON
132
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
3.5
Metering Function
The GRL100 performs continuous measurement of the analog input quantities. The
measurement data shown below is updated every second and displayed on the LCD of the relay
front panel or on the local or remote PC. The model 100 series measures current quantities only.
-
Magnitude and phase angle of phase current at the local terminal (Ia, Ib, Ic)
Magnitude and phase angle of phase voltage for autoreclose (Vs1, Vs2)
Magnitude and phase angle of symmetrical component voltage (V1, V2, V0)
Magnitude and phase angle of symmetrical component current at the local terminal (I1, I2,
I0)
Magnitude and phase angle of positive sequence voltage at the remote terminal 1 and 2 (V11,
V12)
Magnitude and phase angle of phase current and residual current at the remote terminal 1
(Ia1, Ib1, Ic1, I01)
Magnitude and phase angle of phase current and residual current at the remote terminal 2
(Ia2, Ib2, Ic2, I02)
Frequency
Phase angles above are expressed taking that of positive sequence voltage or positive sequence
current when the voltage is small or no voltage is input) as a reference phase angle, where
leading phase angles are expressed as positive, (+).
The above system quantities are displayed in values on the primary side or on the secondary side
determined by the setting. To display accurate values, it is necessary to set the CT ratio and VT
ratio as well. For the setting method, see "Setting the line parameters" in 4.2.6.7.
The signing of active and reactive power flow direction can be set positive for either power
sending or power receiving. The signing of reactive power can be also set positive for either
lagging phase or leading phase. For the setting method, see Section 4.2.6.6.
133
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
4. User Interface
4.1
4.1.1
Front Panel
As shown in Figure 3.1.5.1, the front panel is provided with a liquid crystal display (LCD), light
emitting diode (LED), operation keys, VIEW and RESET keys, monitoring jack and
RS232C connector.
LCD
The LCD screen, provided with a 4-line, 40-character back-light, displays detailed information
of the relay interior such as records, status and settings. The LCD screen is normally unlit, but
pressing the VIEW key will display the digest screen and pressing any key other than VIEW
and RESET will display the menu screen.
These screens are turned off by pressing the RESET key or END key. If any display is left for
5 minutes or longer without operation, the back-light will go off.
LED
There are 8 LED displays. The signal labels and LED colors are defined as follows:
Label
Color
Remarks
IN SERVICE
TRIP
ALARM
TESTING
Green
Red
Red
Red
(LED1)
Red
(LED2)
Red
(LED3)
Red
(LED4)
Red
The TRIP LED lights up once the relay is operating and remains lit even after the trip command
goes off. For the operation, see Section 4.2.1.
Operation keys
The operation keys are used to display records, status, and set values on the LCD, as well as to
134
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
input or change set values. The function of each key is as follows:
c 0-9, :
d
Used to end entry operation, return to the upper screen or turn off the
display.
g ENTER :
Pressing the VIEW key displays digest screens such as "Metering", "Latest fault" and
"Auto-supervision".
Pressing the RESET key turns off the display.
Monitoring jacks
The two monitoring jacks A and B and their respective LEDs can be used when the test mode is
selected on the LCD screen. By selecting the signal to be observed from the "Signal List" and
setting it on the screen, the signal can be displayed on LED A or LED B, or output to an
oscilloscope via a monitoring jack.
RS232C connector
The RS232C connector is a 9-way D-type connector for serial RS232C connection with a local
personal computer.
135
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
4.1.2
Communication Ports
The following interfaces are provided as communication ports:
RS232C port
RS485, Fibre optic or Ethernet LAN port for serial communication
IRIG-B port
Interface port for telecommunication link
RS232C port
This connector is a standard 9-way D-type connector for serial port RS232C transmission and is
mounted on the front panel. By connecting a personal computer to this connector, setting and
display functions can be performed from the personal computer.
RS485, Fibre optic or Ethernet LAN port
One or two serial communication ports can be provided. In the single-port type, it is connected to
the RSM (Relay Setting and Monitoring system) via the protocol converter G1PR2 or
IEC60870-5-103 communication via BCU/RTU (Bay Control Unit / Remote Terminal Unit) to
connect between relays and to construct a network communication system. (See Figure 4.4.1 in
Section 4.4.)
In the case of the two-port type, one port (COM1 or OP1) can be used for the relay setting and
monitoring (RSM) system or IEC60870-5-103 communication, while the other port (COM2 or
OP2) is used for IEC60870-5-103 communication only.
Screw terminal for RS485, ST connector for fibre optic or RJ45 connector for Ethernet LAN
(10Base-T) is provided on the back of the relay as shown in Figure 4.1.2.1. RS232, 10BASE-FL
and 100BASE-FX can be provided.
IRIG-B port
The IRIG-B port is mounted on the transformer module, and collects serial IRIG-B format data
from the external clock to synchronize the relay calendar clock. The IRIG-B port is isolated from
the external circuit by a photo-coupler. A BNC connector is used as the input connector.
This port is on the back of the relay, as shown in Figure 4.1.2.1.
Interface port for telecommunication link
The optical or electrical interface port for telecommunication link is provided on the back of the
relay as shown in Figure 4.1.2.1. The connector using for the optical interface port is the ST type
(for 2 km class), LC type (for 30 km class) or Duplex LC type (for 80 km class) connector and
the connector for the electrical interface port is the D-sub connector.
136
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
IRIG BNC
connector
CH1
TX1
RX1
CH2
TX2
RX2
RS485
connection
terminal
RJ45 connector
(option)
Relay rear view (Case Type A)
OP1 T
CH1
TX1
OP1 R
RX1
CH2
TX2
IRIG BNC
connector
OP2 T
OP2 R
RX2
RJ45 connector
(option)
137
RS485
connection
terminal
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
4.2
4.2.1
n
7
7
7
g1
.0kV
.0kV
.0kV
Ia
Ib
Ic
1
2
2
2
6/
.1
.1
.1
Oct/1997
0kA
0kA
0kA
18:13
n
.
.
.
g2
00kA
00kA
00kA
Ia1
Ib1
Ic1
1
1
1
1
6/
.0
.0
.0
Oct/1997
Ia2
5kA
Ib2
5kA
Ic2
5kA
18:13
1.05kA
1.05kA
1.05kA
Note: I1 and I2 are phase currents of remote terminal 1 and remote terminal 2.
Metering3
+ 400.11MW
16/Oct/1997
18:13
25.51Mvar
60.1Hz
When the GRL100 is operating normally, the green "IN SERVICE" LED is lit and the LCD is
off.
Press the VIEW key when the LCD is off to display the digest screens "Metering1",
"Metering2", "Metering3", "Latest fault" and "Auto-supervision" in turn. The last two screens
are displayed only when there is some data. The following are the digest screens and can be
displayed without entering the menu screens.
Press the RESET key to turn off the LCD.
For any display, the back-light is automatically turned off after five minutes.
Displays in tripping
Latest
Phase
DIF
47.3km
fault
ABN
16/Oct/1997
18:13:45.160
Trip
ABC
(57.1%)
Note: In the case of model 100s, the fault location is not displayed.
If a fault occurs and a tripping command is initiated when the LCD is off, the "Latest fault"
screen is displayed on the LCD automatically and the red "TRIP" LED and, if signals assigned to
trigger by tripping, other configurable LEDs light.
Press the VIEW key to display the digest screens in turn including the "Metering" and
138
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
"Auto-supervision" screens.
Press the RESET key to turn off the LEDs and LCD display.
Notes:
1) When configurable LEDs (LED1 through LED4) are assigned to latch signals by trigger of
tripping, press the RESET key more than 3s until the LCD screens relight. Confirm turning
off the configurable LEDs. Refer to Table 4.2.1 Step 1.
2) Then, press the RESET key again on the "Latest fault" screen in short period, confirm
turning off the "TRIP" LED. Refer to Table 4.2.1 Step 2.
3) When only the "TRIP" LED goes off by pressing the RESET key in short period, press the
RESET key again to reset remained LEDs in the manner 1) on the "Latest fault" screen or
other digest screens. LED1 through LED4 will remain lit in case the assigned signals are still
active state.
Table 4.2.1 Turning off latch LED operation
LED lighting status
Operation
Step 1
"TRIP" LED
Step 2
Configurable LED
(LED1 - LED4)
turn off
If the tripping command is initiated when any of the screens is displayed, the current screen
remains displayed and the red "TRIP" LED lights.
When any of the menu screens is displayed, the VIEW and RESET keys do not function. To
return to the digest screen, do the following:
Return to the top screen of the menu by repeatedly pressing the END key.
Press the END key to turn off the LCD.
Press the VIEW key to display the "Latest fault" screen.
Press the RESET key to turn off the "TRIP" LED and LCD.
Displays in automatic supervision operation
Auto-supervision
DIO
08/Dec/1997
22:56
err,
If the automatic supervision function detects a failure while the LCD is off, the
139
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
"Auto-supervision" screen is displayed automatically, showing the location of the failure and the
"ALARM" LED lights.
Press the VIEW key to display other digest screens in turn including the "Metering" and
"Latest fault" screens.
Press the RESET key to turn off the LCD display. However, if the failure continues, the
"ALARM" LED remains lit.
After recovery from a failure, the "ALARM" LED and "Auto-supervision" display turn off
automatically.
If a failure is detected while any of the screens is displayed, the current screen remains displayed
and the "ALARM" LED lights.
Notes:
1) When configurable LEDs (LED1 through LED4) are assigned to latch signals by issuing an
alarm, press the RESET key more than 3s until all LEDs reset except "IN SERVICE" LED.
2) When configurable LED is still lit by pressing RESET key in short period, press RESET
key again to reset remained LED in the above manner.
3) LED1 through LED4 will remain lit in case the assigned signals are still active state.
While any of the menu screens is displayed, the VIEW and RESET keys do not function.
To return from menu screen to the digest "Auto-supervision" screen, do the following:
Return to the top screen of the menu by repeatedly pressing the END key.
Press the END key to turn off the LCD.
Press the VIEW key to display the digest "Auto-supervision" screen.
140
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
4.2.2
Relay Menu
Figure 4.2.2.1 shows the menu hierarchy in the GRL100. The menu has five sub-menus,
"Record", "Status", "Setting (view)", "Setting (change)", and "Test". For details of the menu
hierarchy, see Appendix E.
Menu
Record
Fault record
Event record
Disturbance record
Autoreclose count
Status
Metering
Binary I/O
Relay element
Time sync source
Clock adjustment
Terminal condition
Setting (view)
Version
Description
Communication
Record
Status
Protection
Binary input
Binary output
LED
Setting (change)
Password
Description
Communication
Record
Status
Protection
Binary input
Binary output
LED
Test
Switch
Binary output
Timer
Logic circuit
Sim. fault
Figure 4.2.2.1 Relay Menu
141
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Record
In the "Record" menu, the fault records, event records and disturbance records can be displayed
or erased. Furthermore, autoreclose function can be displayed in counter form or reset.
Status
The "Status" menu displays the power system quantities, binary input and output status, relay
measuring element status, signal source for time synchronization (IRIG-B, RSM, IEC or GPS),
terminal condition (In- or out-of-service) and adjusts the clock.
Setting (view)
The "Setting (view)" menu displays the relay version, plant name and the current settings of
relay address, IP address and RS232C baud rate in communication, record, status, protection,
configurable binary inputs, configurable binary outputs and configurable LEDs.
Setting (change)
The "Setting (change)" menu is used to set or change the settings of password, plant name, relay
address, IP address and RS232C baud rate in communication, record, status, protection,
configurable binary inputs, configurable binary outputs and configurable LEDs.
Since this is an important menu and is used to set or change settings related to relay tripping, it
has password security protection.
Test
The "Test" menu is used to set testing switches, to test the trip circuit, to forcibly operate binary
output relays, to measure variable timer time, to observe the binary signals in the logic circuit,
and to set the synchronized trigger signal for end-to-end dynamic test.
The "Test" menu also has password security protection.
When the LCD is off, press any key other than the VIEW and RESET keys to display the top
"MENU" screen and then proceed to the relay menus.
M
1=Re
3=Se
5=Te
ENU
cord
tting(view)
st
2=Status
4=Setting(change)
To display the "MENU" screen when the digest screen is displayed, press the RESET key to
turn off the LCD, then press any key other than the VIEW and RESET keys.
Press the END key when the top screen is displayed to turn off the LCD.
An example of the sub-menu screen is shown below. The top line shows the hierarchical layer of
the screen, screen title and total number of lines of the screen. The last item is not displayed for
all the screens. "/6" displayed on the far left means that the screen is in the sixth hierarchical
layer, while "1/8" displayed on the far right means that the screen has eight lines excluding the
top line and that the cursor is on the first line.
To move the cursor downward or upward for setting or viewing other lines not displayed on the
and
keys.
window, use the
142
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
/
A
A
A
6 Sc
RC-E
RC-B
RCDI
V
A
V
V
C
R
T
T
H
C
P
-
heme s
XT 0 =O
U
0 =O
FG 0 =O
K
-SM
HSEL
RATE
3PH-VT
0
0
1
1
=
=
=
=
w
f
f
f
itch
f
1 =On
f
1 =On
f
1 =On
Off
Off
A
PH/G
1 =LB
2 =DB
1 =S2
2 =S3
2 =B
3 =C
2 =PH/PH
1 /
1
1
1
3 =SY
3 =S4
1
1
1
1
2 =Line
1 =BUS
To move to the lower screen or move from the left-side screen to the right-side screen in
Appendix E, select the appropriate number on the screen. To return to the higher screen or move
from the right-side screen to the left-side screen, press the END key.
The CANCEL key can also be used to return to the higher screen but it must be used carefully
because it may cancel entries made so far.
To move between screens of the same hierarchical depth, first return to the higher screen and
then move to the lower screen.
4.2.3
Displaying Records
The sub-menu of "Record" is used to display fault records, event records, disturbance records
and autoreclose counts.
4.2.3.1
Select 1 (= Display) to display the dates and times of fault records stored in the relay from the
top in new-to-old sequence.
/3
#1
#2
#3
Fau
16
20
04
l
/
/
/
t
Oc
Se
Ju
re
t/
p/
l/
co
19
19
19
rd
97
97
97
1/ 8
18:13:57.031
15:29 :22 .463
11:54:53.977
Move the cursor to the fault record line to be displayed using the
the ENTER key to display the details of the fault record.
143
and
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Date and Time
Fault phase
Tripping mode
Fault location
Power system
quantities
Relevant events
.
.
Tripping
phase
Note: I1 and I2 are phase currents of remote terminal 1 and remote terminal 2. V11 and V12
are symmetrical component voltages of remote terminal 1 and remote terminal 2.
The lines which are not displayed in the window can be displayed by pressing the
keys.
To clear all the fault records, do the following:
Open the "Record" sub-menu.
Select 1 (= Fault record) to display the "Fault record" screen.
Select 2 (= Clear) to display the following confirmation screen.
144
and
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
/2 Fault record
Clear all fault records?
ENTER=Yes
CANCEL=No
Press the ENTER (= Yes) key to clear all the fault records stored in non-volatile memory.
If all fault records have been cleared, the "Latest fault" screen of the digest screens is not
displayed.
4.2.3.2
Select 1 (= Display) to display the events with date and time from the top in new-to-old
sequence.
/3 E
23/O
23/O
16/A
ve
ct
ct
ug
n
/
/
/
t
19
19
19
record
97 18:18:58.255
97 18:13:58.0 28
97
6:13:57.773
3/21
DS On
DS Off
Com.1 fail
Off
The lines which are not displayed in the window can be displayed by pressing the
keys.
and
Press the ENTER (= Yes) key to clear all the event records stored in non-volatile memory.
145
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
4.2.3.3
Details of disturbance records can be displayed on the PC screen only (*); the LCD displays only
the recorded date and time for all disturbances stored in the relay. To display them, do the
following:
(*) For the display on the PC screen, refer to RSM100 manual.
Open the top "MENU" screen by pressing any keys other than the VIEW and RESET
keys.
Select 1 (= Record) to display the "Record" sub-menu.
Select 3 (= Disturbance record) to display the "Disturbance record" screen.
/ 2 Distu rban c e reco rd
2=Clear
1=Disply
Select 1 (= Display) to display the date and time of the disturbance records from the top in
new-to-old sequence.
/3
#1
#2
#3
Dis
16
20
04
t
/
/
/
ur
Oc
Se
Ju
ba
t/
p/
l/
nc
19
19
19
e reco
97 18:
97 15:
97 11:
rd
13:57.031
29 :22 .463
54:53.977
3 /12
The lines which are not displayed in the window can be displayed by pressing the
keys.
and
Press the ENTER (= Yes) key to clear all the disturbance records stored in non-volatile
memory.
4.2.3.4
The autoreclose output counts can be displayed or can be reset to zero as follows.
To display the autoreclose output counts on the LCD, do the following (for 200 series to 500
series models):
Select 1 (= Record) on the top "MENU" screen to display the "Record" sub-menu.
Select 4 (= Autoreclose count) to display the "Autoreclose count" screen.
146
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
/2 Autoreclos e coun t
2=Reset
1=Disply
Autoreclose count
SPAR
TPAR
[
46]
[
22]
CB1
[
46]
[
22]
CB2
[
[
MPAR
12]
12]
In the case of two breaker autoreclose (model 300s and 500s), CB1 and CB2 mean busbar
breaker and center breaker, respectively. SPAR, TPAR and MPAR mean single-phase,
three-phase and multi-phase autoreclose, respectively.
To reset the autoreclose output count, do the following:
Select 2 (= Reset) on the "Autoreclose count" screen to display the "Reset autoreclose count"
screen.
/3 Reset
1=CB1
2=CB2
aut o r eclo s e
count
Select 1 (= CB1) or 2 (= CB2 for model 300s and 500s) to display the confirmation screen.
/ 3 Rese t aut o r eclo s e coun t
Reset counts?
ENTER=Yes
CANCEL=No
Press the ENTER key to reset the count to zero and return to the previous screen.
4.2.4
147
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
/1 Sta
1=Mete
3=Rela
5=Cloc
tus
ring
y element
k a d j u s t m ent
2=Binary I/O
4=Time sync source
6=Term inal condition
Note: I1 and I2 are phase currents of remote terminal 1 and remote terminal 2. V11 and
V12 are symmetrical component voltages of remote terminal 1 and remote terminal 2.
In the case of two terminal line application, I2 and V12 are not displayed.
Id, Ir and Ipu are differential current,
restraining current and pickup current respectively.
Ipu = DIFI1 when Id = Ir.
When input electrical quantities at the local
terminal are "0", electrical quantities at the
remote terminal are displayed as "".
Lines 6 and 7 from bottom are displayed
in COMMODE=GPS setting only.
Id
DIFI1
Ipu
Ir
Metering data is expressed as primary values or secondary values depending on the setting. For
details of the setting, see Section 4.2.6.6.
4.2.4.2
148
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
/2 Bin
Input
Input
Output
a
(
(
(
Output(IO# 2)
Output(IO# 3 )
[000
[000
000
000
3/ 5
000]
]
]
000
000
000
000
000
0
00
]
]
Input (IO#1)
BI1
BI2
BI3
BI4
BI5
BI6
BI7
BI8
BI9
Input (IO#2)
Input (IO#3:IO5)
BI19 BI20 BI21 BI22 BI23 BI24 BI25 BI26 BI27 BI28
Input (IO#3:IO6)
Input (IO#4:IO4)
BO1 BO2 BO3 BO4 BO5 BO6 BO7 BO8 BO9 BO10 BO11 BO12 FAIL BO13
Output (IO#3:IO3) BO1 BO2 BO3 BO4 BO5 BO6 BO7 BO8 BO9 BO10
Output (IO#3:IO5) BO1 BO2 BO3 BO4 BO5 BO6 BO7 BO8 BO9 BO10
Output (IO#4:IO4) BO1 BO2 BO3 BO4 BO5 BO6 BO7 BO8 BO9 BO10 BO11 BO12 BO13 BO14
Output (IO#4:FD) BO1 BO2 BO3 BO4 BO5 BO6 BO7 BO8 FD1 FD2
(*) Input and Output shown in the parentheses are not provided in the case of IO8 module.
Lines 1 and 2 show the binary input status. BI1 to BI18 correspond to each binary input signal.
For details of the binary input signals, see Appendix G. The status is expressed with logical level
"1" or "0" at the photo-coupler output circuit. The module names of IO#1 to IO#4 in the table
depend on the model. (Refer to Appendix G.)
Lines 5 to 12 show the binary output status. TPA1 to TPC2 of line 5 correspond to the tripping
command outputs. FAIL of line 6 corresponds to the relay failure output. FD1 and FD2 of line 12
correspond to the fault detector output. Other outputs expressed with BO1 to BO14 are
configurable. The status of these outputs is expressed with logical level "1" or "0" at the input
circuit of the output relay driver. That is, the output relay is energized when the status is "1".
To display all the lines, press the
4.2.4.3
and
keys.
element
3/
[00 0
[00 0
[00 0
OC,EF
THM
Autoreclose
0
000
[00 0 00 0
[00
[00 0 00 0
149
000
00
00
6
]
]
]
]
]
]
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
DIF, DIFG
OST
OCBF
OC, EF
B
DIF
DIFG
EF
EFI
OST
OST1
B
OC
OST
OST2
B
OCI
THM
THM-A THM-T
Autoreclose
B
OC1
Line 1 shows the operation status of current differential elements for phase faults and earth
faults, respectively.
Line 2 shows the status of the out-of-step protection. and is "1" when the remote terminal
voltage is at -zone and -zone respectively. OST shows the operation status of out-of-step
element. OST1 and OST2 correspond to the out-of-step detection with remote terminal 1 and 2
respectively.
Line 3 shows the status of the overcurrent element for breaker failure protection.
Line 4 shows the status of the overcurrent elements and fail-safe elements.
Line 5 shows the status of the thermal overload element.
Line 6 shows the status of elements used for autoreclose.
The status of each element is expressed with logical level "1" or "0". Status "1" means the
element is in operation.
To display all the lines on the LCD, press the
4.2.4.4
and
keys.
The internal clock of the GRL100 can be synchronized with external clocks such as the IRIG-B
time standard signal clock or RSM (relay setting and monitoring system) clock or by an
IEC60870-5-103 control system or GPS. To display on the LCD whether these clocks are active
or inactive and which clock the relay is synchronized with, do the following:
Select 2 (= Status) on the top "MENU" screen to display the "Status" screen.
Select 4 (= Time sync source) to display the status of time synchronization sources.
/ 2 T i m e s y n c h r o ni z a ti o n s o u r c e
Active
*IRIG:
RSM:
I na ct i v e
IEC:
I na c t iv e
GPS:
3/
I na c t i v e
The asterisk on the far left shows that the inner clock is synchronized with the marked source
clock. If the marked source clock is inactive, the inner clock runs locally.
For the setting time synchronization, see Section 4.2.6.6.
150
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
4.2.4.5
To adjust the clock when the internal clock is running locally, do the following:
Select 2 (= Status) on the top "MENU" screen to display the "Status" screen.
Select 5 (= Clock adjustment) to display the setting screen.
/2
1
Minute
Hour
Day
2/Feb
(
(
(
Month
Year
(
(
/1998 22:56:19
[Local]
059):
41
023):
22
131):
12
11990-
12):
2089):
1/
2
1998
Line 1 shows the current date, time and time synchronization source with which the internal
clock is synchronized. The time can be adjusted only when [Local] is indicated on the top line,
showing that the clock is running locally. When [IRIG] or [RSM] or [IEC] or [GPS] is indicated,
the following adjustment is invalid.
Enter a numerical value within the specified range for each item and press the ENTER key.
Press the END key to adjust the internal clock to the set hours without fractions and return
to the previous screen.
If a date which does not exist in the calendar is set and END key is pressed, "Error: Incorrect
date" is displayed on the top line and the adjustment is discarded. Adjust again.
4.2.4.6 Displaying the Terminal Condition
Terminal condition is displayed when the scheme switch [OTD] is "ON" and the out-of-service
logic is used.
To display the terminal condition on the LCD, do the following:
Select 2 (= Status) on the top "MENU" screen to display the "Status" screen.
Select 6 (= Terminal condition) to display the status of the terminal conditions.
/2 T er mi nal co nd iti on
Te rm inal 1: In se rvi ce
Terminal2:
Out
of
2/
service
Note: Out of service is displayed when the switch [OTD] ="ON" setting.
Bottom line (Terminal 2: ) is displayed only for three-terminal line application ("3TERM"
setting).
4.2.5
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Status setting
Protection setting
Binary input setting
Binary output setting
LED setting
Enter a number on the LCD to display each item as described in the previous sections.
4.2.5.1
Relay version
Press 1 (= Version) on the "Setting (view)" screen to display the "Relay version" screen.
/2
Relay
Rela y ty
Serial N
Main sof
version
3/
pe:
o.:
tware:
COM software:
FD software:
PLC data:
IEC103 data :
4.2.5.2
Settings
The "Description", " Comm.", "Record", "Status", "Protection", "Binary input", "Binary output"
and "LED" screens display the current settings input using the "Setting (change)" sub-menu.
4.2.6
Setting Method
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
- To enter a selected number
- To enter numerical values
- To enter a text string
To enter a selected number
switch
3 PH
2 =1 P H
Off
1=On
Off
1=On
3 = M PH
0=Off
1=Trip
2=BO
0=Off
1=On
0=Off
1=On
1=Long 2=Std 3=Very 4=Ex t
0=Off
1=On
0=Off
1=On
0=Off
1=On
1=Long 2=Std 3=Very 4=Ex t
0=Off
1=T
2=TOC
0=Off
1=On
0=Off
1=On
0=Off
1=On
0=Off
1=On
0=Off
1=Trip
2=BO
0=Off
1=Trip
2=BO
0=Off
1=On
0=Off
1=On
0=Off
1=On
2=OCD
3=Bo t h
0=Off
1=On
0=Off
1=On
O = A LM & B L K 1 =A L M
0=Off 1=ALM& BLK 3=A LM
0=Off 1=ALM& BLK 3=A LM
0=Off
1=On
1 / 27
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
1
(*) TPMODE is not displayed in the case of the model provided with autoreclose function.
153
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
If it is after pressing the ENTER key, move the cursor to the correcting line by pressing the
and
keys and enter the new number.
Note: If the CANCEL key is pressed after any of the entry is confirmed by pressing the ENTER
key, all the entries performed so far on the screen concerned are canceled and screen returns
to the upper one.
When the screen shown below is displayed, perform the setting as follows.
The number to the right of "Current No. = " shows the current setting.
/6 A
1 =D i
5=MP
Cu
ut
sa
AR
rr
oreclose mode
ble
2 =SP AR
3=TPAR
4 =SP AR&TPAR
2 6=MPAR3 7=EXT1P 8=EXT3P 9=EXTMP
ent No.= 4
Select No. =
Enter a number to the right of "Select No. = ". (Numbers other than those displayed cannot be
entered.)
Press the ENTER key to confirm the entry and the entered number blinks.
After completing the setting on the screen, press the END key to return to the upper screen.
When the screen shown below is displayed, perform the setting as follows:
The number to the left of the cursor shows the current setting or default setting set at shipment.
and
The cursor can be moved to upper or lower lines within the screen by pressing the
keys. If setting (change) is not required, skip the line with the
and
keys.
154
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Text strings are entered in the bracket under "Plant name" or "Description" screen.
To select a character, use keys 2, 4, 6 and 8 to move the blinking cursor down, left, up and right.
"" and "" on each of lines 2 to 4 indicate a space and backspace, respectively. A maximum
of 22 characters can be entered within the brackets.
155
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
/3 Plant name
[
_
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
()[]@_
abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 ! # $ % & ^ `
{ } * / + - < = >
Set the cursor position in the bracket by selecting "" or "" and pressing the ENTER
key.
Move the blinking cursor to select a character.
Press the ENTER to enter the blinking character at the cursor position in the brackets.
Press the END key to confirm the entry and return to the upper screen.
Enter after making entries on each setting screen by pressing the ENTER key, the new settings
are not yet used for operation, though stored in the memory. To validate the new settings, take
the following steps.
Press the END key to return to the upper screen. Repeat this until the confirmation screen
shown below is displayed. The confirmation screen is displayed just before returning to the
"Setting (change)" sub-menu.
/2 **************
Change settings?
ENTER=Yes
CANCEL=No
When the screen is displayed, press the ENTER key to start operation using the new
settings, or press the CANCEL key to correct or cancel entries. In the latter case, the screen
turns back to the setting screen to enable reentries. Press the CANCEL key to cancel entries
made so far and to turn to the "Setting (change)" sub-menu.
4.2.6.2
Password
For the sake of security of changing the settings, password protection can be set as follows:
Press 4 (= Setting (change)) on the main "MENU" screen to display the "Setting (change)"
screen.
/1 Setting(change )
1=Password
2=Description
3=Comm.
6=Protection
4=Record
5=Status
9=LED
7=Binary input
8=Binary output
156
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
/2 Password
1=Setting
2=Test
Setting
Input
Retype
new
new
password
password
[
[
]
]
Enter a 4-digit number within the brackets after "Input new password" and press the
ENTER key.
For confirmation, enter the same 4-digit number in the brackets after "Retype new password"
and press the ENTER key.
Press the END key to display the confirmation screen. If the retyped number is different
from that first entered, the following message is displayed on the bottom of the "Password"
screen before returning to the upper screen.
"Mismatch-password unchanged"
Reentry is then requested.
Press 2 (= Test) on the "Password" screen to set the password for the test.
/2
Test
Input
Retype
new
new
password
password
[
[
]
]
Set the password the same manner as that of the "Setting" above.
Password trap
After the password has been set, the password must be entered in order to enter the setting
change or test screen.
If 4 (= Setting (change)) or 5 (=Test) is entered on the top "MENU" screen, the password trap
screen "Password" is displayed. If the password is not entered correctly, it is not possible to
move to the "Setting (change)" sub-menu screens.
Password
Input
password
To cancel the password protection, enter "0000" in the two brackets on the "Password" screen.
The "Setting (change)" screen is then displayed without having to enter a password.
The password can be changed by entering a new 4-digit number on the "Password" screen in the
same way as the first password setting.
157
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
If you forget the password
Press CANCEL and RESET together for one second on the top "MENU" screen. The screen
disappears, and the password protection of the GRL100 is canceled. Set the password again.
4.2.6.3
Description
To enter the plant name and other data, do the following. These data are attached to records.
Press 4 (= Setting (change)) on the main "MENU" screen to display the "Setting (change)"
screen.
Press 2 (= Description) to display the "Description" screen.
/2 Description
1 =P lant na me
To enter the plant name, select 1 (= Plant name) on the "Description" screen.
/3 Plant name
[
_
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
()[]@_
abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 ! # $ % & ^ `
{ } * / + - < = >
()[]@
abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 ! # $ % & ^ `
{ } * / + - < = >
The plant name and special items entered are viewed with the "Setting (view)" sub-menu and
attached to disturbance records when they are displayed on a local or a remote PC.
4.2.6.4
Communication
If the relay is linked with RSM (relay setting and monitoring system), IEC60870-5-103 or
Ethernet LAN, the relay address must be set. Do this as follows:
Press 4 (= Setting (change)) on the main "MENU" screen to display the "Setting (change)"
screen.
Press 3 (= Comm.) to display the "Communication" screen.
/2 Communicat i on
1 =A ddress /Paramete r
2 =S witch
158
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Enter the address number on "HDLC" column for RSM and/or "IEC" column for
IEC60870-5-103 and the compensation value on "SYADJ" column for adjustment of time
synchronization of protocol used. (: lags the time , +: leads the time) And enter IP address
for IP1-1 to IP1-4, Subnet mask for SM1-1 to SM4, and Default gateway for GW1-1 to
GW1-4.
IP address: , , ,
IP1-1 IP1-2 IP1-3 IP1-4
Subnet mask SM1-1 to SM4 and Default gateway GW1-1 to GW1-4: same as
above.
Press the ENTER key.
1=Normal
4=57.6
2=Blocked
1 /4
2
4
2
1
Select the number corresponding to the system and press the ENTER key.
<PRTCL1>
PRTCL1 is used to select the protocol for channel 1 (COM1 or OP1) of the serial communication
port RS485 or FO (fibre optic).
When the remote RSM system applied, select 1 (=HDLC). When the IEC60870-5-103
applied, select 2 (=IEC103).
<232C>
This line is to select the RS232C baud rate when the RSM system applied.
Note: The default setting of the 232C is 9.6kbps. The 57.6kbps setting, if possible, is recommended
to serve user for comfortable operation. The setting of RSM100 is also set to the same baud
rate.
159
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
<IECBR>
This line is to select the baud rate when the IEC60870-5-103 system applied.
<IECBLK>
2=Event
record
0=Off
1=On
1/ 1
1 _
record
0128):
03071):
1 / 12 9
128
0
EV2
0-
3071):
E V3
E V4
(
(
00-
3 07 1 ) :
3 07 1 ) :
1
1
EV128
0-
3071):
3071
<BITRN>
Enter the number of event to record the status change both to "On" and "Off". If enter 20,
both status change is recorded for EV1 to EV20 events and only the status change to "On" is
recorded for EV21 to EV128 events.
<EV>
Enter the signal number to record as the event in Appendix B. It is recommended that this
setting can be performed by RSM100 because the signal name cannot be entered by LCD
screen. (Refer to Section 3.4.2.)
160
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Setting the disturbance recording
Press 3 (= Disturbance record) to display the "Disturbance record" screen.
/3 D
1=Re
2=Sc
3=Bi
i s t u r bance r e c o rd
cor time & starter
he me switch
nar y signal
Press 1 (= Record time & starter) to display the "Record time & starter" screen.
/ Record time & starter
1/5
Time (
OCP-S(
OCP-G(
0.10.50.5-
3.0):
250.0):
250.0):
2.0
10.0
10.0
UVP-S(
UVP-G(
00-
132):
76):
100
57
A
A
A
V
V
0 =Off
0 =Off
ch
1=O n
1=On
1=On
1/ 5
1
1
1
1=On
1=On
1
1
1/32
SIG1
SIG2
SIG3
(
(
(
000-
3071):
3071):
3071):
1
2
3
SIG4
0-
3071):
SIG32(
0-
3071):
Enter the signal number to record binary signals in Appendix B. It is recommended that this
setting can be performed by RSM100 because the signal name cannot be entered by LCD
screen. (Refer to Section 3.4.3.)
4.2.6.6
Status
161
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
/2
Status
1=Metering
2=Time synchronization
3=Time zone
1=Primary
2=Secondary
Power (P/Q)
Current
1=Send
1=Lag
2=Receive
2=Lead
3/ 3
1
1
1 _
Enter the selected number and press the ENTER key. Repeat this for all items.
Note: Power and Current setting
Active Power Display
Power setting=1(Send)
Power setting=2(Receive)
V
I
Current setting=2(Lead)
V
I
The calendar clock can run locally or be synchronized with external IRIG-B time standard
signal, RSM clock, IEC60870-5-103 or GPS. This is selected by setting as follows:
Press 2 (= Time synchronization) to display the "Time synchronization" screen.
/3 Time synchronization
Sync
0=Off
1=IRIG
2=RSM
1/1
3=IEC
4=GPS
When the calendar clock is synchronized with the IRIG-B time standard signal or GPS signal, it
is possible to transfer GMT to the local time.
162
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Press 3 (= Time zone) to display the "Time zone" screen.
/3
Time
GMT
zone
1/1
-12-
+12):
+9
hrs
Enter the difference between GMT and local time and press the ENTER key.
4.2.6.7
Protection
The GRL100 can have 8 setting groups for protection according to the change of power system
operation, one of which is assigned to be active. To set protection, do the following:
Press 6 (= Protection) on the "Setting (change)" screen to display the "Protection" screen.
/2 Protec
1=Change
2=Change
3=Copy gr
ti
ac
se
ou
on
tive group
tting
p
ha
ou
ou
rr
nge
p1
p5
ent
a
2
6
N
ct
=G
=G
o.
iv
ro
ro
=
e group(Act
up2
3=Grou
up6
7=Grou
*
S
ive gr
p3
4=
p7
8=
elect
ou
Gr
Gr
No
p= *)
oup4
oup8
. =
Almost all the setting items have default values that are set when the GRL100 was shipped. For
the default values, see Appendix D and H. To change the settings, do the following:
Press 2 (= Change setting) to display the "Change setting" screen.
/3 Change
1 =Group1
5 =Group5
setting
2 =Group2
6 =Group6
(Active
3 =Group3
7 =Group7
group= *)
4 =Group4
8 =Group8
Press the group number to change the settings and display the "Protection" screen. (In 100
series models, 4 = Autoreclose is not displayed.)
/4 Protection
1=Line parameter
2=Telecommunication
4=Autoreclose
(Group
*)
3=Trip
Enter the line name, VT&CT ratio and settings for the fault locator as follows:
Press 1 (= Line parameter) on the "Protection" screen to display the "Line parameter" screen.
163
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
/5 Line parameter
1=Line name
2=VT & CT ratio
3=Fault locator
(Group
*)
& CT ratio
(
120000):
(
120000):
(
120000):
CT
1-
1/4
2200
2200
2200
20000):
400
Enter the VT ratio for protection function and press the ENTER key.
Enter the VTs1 ratio and/or VTs2 ratio for autoreclose function and press the ENTER key.
VTs1 is used for the VT ratio setting for voltage and synchronism check of autoreclose
function. VTs2 is used for the VT ratio setting for the other voltage and synchronism check at
the time of two-breaker autoreclose.
Enter the CT ratio and press the ENTER key.
Press the END key to return the display to the "Line parameter" screen.
Press 3 (= Fault locator) to display the "Fault locator" screen.
/6 Fault locator
1=Setting impedance
2=Line data
(Group
*)
mode
Press 1 (= Setting impedance mode) to display the "Setting impedance mode" screen.
/ 7 S e t t i n g i m pe d a n c e m o d e
(Group *)
1 = P o s i t i v e s e qu e n c e i m p e d a n c e
2 = P h a s e i m pe d a n c e s
Current No.= 1
Select No. =
data
0.00
0.00
0.0
- 199.99)
- 199.99)
399.9)
2X1
(
(
2R1
2Line(
3X1
(
3R1
(
3L ine(
0
0
0
0
0
0
.0
.0
.0
.0
.0
.0
0
0
0
0
1/
199.
199.
399
199.
199.
399
99)
99)
.9)
99)
99)
.9)
164
:
:
:
24.5
2.8
80.0
km
:
:
:
:
:
:
12.5
1.5
41.3
6.0
0.8
20.3
km
km
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
In case of two-terminal lines, enter the reactive and resistive component of the positive sequence
line impedance to the items 1X1 and 1R1 and line length to 1 Line. Press the enter key for each
entry.
Note: The line impedance is input with the secondary value.
In case of three-terminal lines, enter the data on the first section from the local terminal to the
junction to the items expressed as 1, the data on the second section from the junction to the
remote terminal 1 to 2 and the data on the third section from the junction to the remote
terminal 2 to 3.
Select 2 (= Phase impedances), then the following "Line data" screen is displayed.
In case of two-terminal lines, enter the reactive and resistive component of the self-impedances
and mutual-impedances of the line to the items expressed as 1X and 1R and line length to 1
Line. Press the ENTER key for each entry.
In case of three-terminal lines, enter the data on the first section from the local terminal to the
junction to 1, the data on the second section from the junction to the remote terminal 1 to
2 and the data on the third section from the junction to the remote terminal 2 to 3.
Press the END key after completing the settings to return the display to the "Line
parameter" screen
165
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
/7 Line data
1Xaa ( 0.00 - 199.99) : 34.80
1Xbb ( 0.00 - 199.99) : 33.40
1Xcc ( 0.00 - 199.99) : 30.90
1Xab
1Xbc
1Xca
1Raa
1Rbb
1Rcc
1Rab
1Rbc
1Rca
1Line
2Xaa
2Xbb
2Xcc
2Xab
2Xbc
2Xca
2Raa
2Rbb
2Rcc
2Rab
2Rbc
2Rca
2Line
3Xaa
3Xbb
3Xcc
3Xab
3Xbc
3Xca
3Raa
3Rbb
3Rcc
3Rab
3Rbc
3Rca
3Line
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.0
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.0
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.0
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
399.9)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
399.9)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
199.99)
399.9)
1/39
km
km
km
: 13.60
: 11.90
:
9.30
:
3.36
:
3.39
:
3.52
:
2.48
:
2.56
:
2.48
:
80.0
: 17.40
: 16.70
: 15.50
:
6.80
:
6.01
:
4.70
:
1.68
:
1.70
:
1.76
:
1.24
:
1.28
:
1.24
:
40.3
:
8.70
:
8.35
:
7.75
:
3.40
:
3.01
:
2.35
:
0.84
:
0.85
:
0.88
:
0.62
:
0.64
:
0.62
:
20.5
(Group
*)
Press 1 (= Scheme switch) to display the "Scheme switch" screen. Set the communication
mode "A", "B" or "GPS", and the "Master" or "Slave", and "2 terminal line (=2TERM)" or "3
terminal line (=3TERM)" or "Dual communication for 2 terminal line (=Dual)". Refer to
166
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Section 2 and 2.2.2.
However "TERM", "CH.CON", "T.SFT2" and "B.SYN2" items are not displayed in the case
of 2 terminal models.
For the "CH.CON" setting, refer to Sections 2.2.6 and 2.11.3.
In "B.SYN", set to "On" when synchronizing the sending signal of GRL100 with the
external clock signal or the receiving signal from multiplexer.
For "GPSBAK", "AUTO2B" and "SRC", refer to Section 2.2.7.
/6 Schem
COMMODE
SP.SYN.
TE R M
e switch
2=B
1=A
1=Master
1=2TERM
3=GPS
2=Slave
2 = 3T E R M
CH.CON
RYIDSV
T.SFT1
T.SFT2
B.SYN1
B.SYN2
GPSBAK
AUTO2B
SRC
1=Normal
0=Off
0=Off
0=Off
0=Off
0=Off
0=Off
0=Off
0=Disable
2=Exchange
1=On
1=On
1=On
1=On
1=On
1=On
1=On
1=I
3 = Du a l
1/12
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
ID2
SV
DT1
DT2
0 (
(
100 (-10000(-10000-
on element
00) :
1000
63) :
0
63) :
0
63)
16000)
10000)
10000)
:
:
:
:
0
6000
0
0
1/
s
s
us
us
Enter the time delay setting values and the relay identity numbers (address numbers) and
press the ENTER key for each setting.
To set the scheme switches and protection elements, do the following. Protection elements are
measuring elements and timers.
Press 3 (= Trip) on the "Protection" screen to display the "TRIP" screen.
167
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
/5 Trip
1=Scheme switch
2=Protection element
(Group
*)
Note: Depending on the scheme switch setting, some of the scheme switches and protection
elements are not used and so do not need to be set. The trip function setting menu of the
GRL100 may not display unnecessary setting items. Therefore, start by setting the scheme
switch, and set the protection elements.
As a result of the above, note that some of the setting items described below may not appear
in the actual setting.
switch
3 PH
2 =1 P H
Off
1=On
Off
1=On
3 = M PH
0=Off
1=Trip
2=BO
0=Off
1=On
0=Off
1=On
1=Long 2=Std 3=Very 4=Ex t
0=Off
1=On
0=Off
1=On
0=Off
1=On
1=Long 2=Std 3=Very 4=Ex t
0=Off
1=T
2=TO C
0=Off
1=On
0=Off
1=On
0=Off
1=On
0=Off
1=On
0=Off
1=Trip
2=BO
0=Off
1=Trip
2=BO
0=Off
1=On
0=Off
1=On
0=Off
1=On
2=OCD
3=Bo t h
0=Off
1=On
0=Off
1=On
O = A LM & B L K 1 =A L M
0=Off 1=ALM& BLK 3=A LM
0=Off 1=ALM& BLK 3=A LM
0=Off
1=On
1 / 27
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
1
Note: The setting elements on the screen depend on the relay model.
Enter the number corresponding to the switch status to be set and press the ENTER key for
each switch.
After setting all switches, press the END key to return to the "Trip" screen.
Setting the protection elements
Press 2 (= Protection element) to display the "Protection element" screen.
168
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Note: The setting elements on the screen depend on the relay model.
Enter the numerical value and press the ENTER key for each element.
After setting all elements, press the END key to return to the "Trip" screen.
Setting the autoreclose function
To set the autoreclose mode, scheme switches and autoreclose elements, do the following:
Note: Depending on the autoreclose mode and scheme switch setting, some of the scheme switches
and autoreclose elements are not used and so do not need to be set. The autoreclose function
setting menu of the GRL100 does not display unnecessary setting items. Therefore, start by
setting the autoreclose mode, and proceed to set the scheme switch, then the autoreclose
elements.
As a result of the above, note that some of the setting items described below may not appear
in the actual setting.
orec
recl
me s
recl
lose
ose mode
witch
ose element
(Group
169
*)
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
/6 A
1 =D i
5=MP
Cu
ut
sa
AR
rr
oreclose mode
ble
2 =SP AR
3=TPAR
4 =SP AR&TPAR
2 6=MPAR3 7=EXT1P 8=EXT3P 9=EXTMP
ent No.= 4
Select No. = _
Note: The setting elements on the screen depend on the relay model.
Select the autoreclose mode to be used by entering the number corresponding to the
autoreclose mode and press the ENTER key.
Press the END key to return to the "Autoreclose" screen.
Setting the scheme switches
Press 2 (= Scheme switch) to display the "Scheme switch" screen.
/
A
A
A
6 Sc
RC-E
RC-B
RCDI
heme s
XT 0 =O
U
0 =O
FG 0 =O
V
A
A
M
V
V
3
U
C
R
R
A
T
T
P
A
M
U
L
E
T
T
W
H
C
C
P
H
R
K
N
H
R
C
S
S
O
S
A
V
S
C
K
L
E
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
O
O
O
F
A
P
B
P
w
f
f
f
itch
f
1 =On
f
1 =On
f
1 =On
ff
ff
ff
T
1
1
1
1 =
2
=
=
=
T
=
LB
S2
On
1 /11
1
1
1
2 =DB
2 =S3
3 =SY
3 =S4
2 =S+T
B
3 =C
H/G
2 =PH/PH
US
2 =Line
2 =P2
3 =P3
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
Note: The setting elements on the screen depend on the relay model.
Enter the number corresponding to the switch status to be set and press the ENTER key for
each switch.
After setting all switches, press the END key to return to the "Autoreclose" screen.
Setting the autoreclose elements
Press 3 (= Autoreclose element) to display the "Autoreclose element" screen.
/6 Autoreclose element
1=Autoreclose timer
2=Synchrocheck
(Group
*)
Press 1 to display the "Autoreclose timer" screen or 2 to display the "Synchrocheck" screen for
voltage check and synchronism check elements.
Set these elements in the same way as protection elements.
Setting group copy
To copy the settings of one group and overwrite them to another group, do the following:
Press 3 (= Copy group) on the "Protection" screen to display the "Copy group A to B" screen.
/3
A
B
Copy
(
(
group
11-
to
B
(Active
8)
8)
170
group=
*)
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Enter the group number to be copied in line A and press the ENTER key.
Enter the group number to be overwritten by the copy in line B and press the ENTER key.
4.2.6.8
Binary Input
The logic level of binary input signals can be inverted by setting before entering the scheme
logic. Inversion is used when the input contact cannot meet the requirement described in Table
3.2.2.
Press 7 (= Binary input) on the "Setting (change)" sub-menu to display the "Binary input"
screen.
/2 Binary input
BISW 1 1=Norm 2=Inv
BISW 2 1=Norm 2=Inv
BISW 3 1=Norm 2=Inv
BISW 4
BISW 5
BISW 6
BISW 7
BISW 8
BISW 9
BISW10
BISW11
BISW12
BISW13
BISW14
BISW15
BISW16
BISW17
BISW18
BISW19
BISW20
BISW21
BISW22
BISW23
BISW24
BISW26
BISW27
BISW28
BISW34
BISW35
BISW36
1=Norm
1=Norm
1=Norm
1=Norm
1=Norm
1=Norm
1=Norm
1=Norm
1=Norm
1=Norm
1=Norm
1=Norm
1=Norm
1=Norm
1=Norm
1=Norm
1=Norm
1=Norm
1=Norm
1=Norm
1=Norm
1=Norm
1=Norm
1=Norm
1=Norm
1=Norm
1=Norm
2=Inv
2=Inv
2=Inv
2=Inv
2=Inv
2=Inv
2=Inv
2=Inv
2=Inv
2=Inv
2=Inv
2=Inv
2=Inv
2=Inv
2=Inv
2=Inv
2=Inv
2=Inv
2=Inv
2=Inv
2=Inv
2=Inv
2=Inv
2=Inv
2=Inv
2=Inv
2=Inv
1/ 31
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Note: The setting elements on the screen depend on the relay model.
Enter 1 (= Normal) or 2 (= Inverted) and press the ENTER key for each binary input.
4.2.6.9
Binary Output
All the binary outputs of the GRL100 except the tripping command, and relay failure signal are
user-configurable. It is possible to assign one signal or up to six ANDing or ORing signals to one
output relay. Available signals are listed in Appendix B.
It is also possible to attach a drop-off delay time of 0.2 second to these signals. The drop-off
delay time is disabled by the scheme switch [BOTD].
171
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Appendix D shows the factory default settings.
To configure the binary output signals, do the following:
Selection of output module
Press 8 (= Binary output) on the "Setting (change)" screen to display the "Binary output"
screen. The available output module(s) will be shown. (This differs depending on the relay
model; the following is for models 202 and 302.)
/2 Binary
1 =IO# 2
output
2 =IO#3
3 =IO#4
Press the number corresponding to the selected output module to display the "Binary output"
screen.
/3 Binary
Select BO
output
(*****)
(
1-
**)
Select
No.=
Note: The setting is required for all the binary outputs. If any of the binary outputs are not to be
used, enter 0 for logic gates #1 to #6 when assigning signals.
type &
2=AND
1=On
delay
timer
1/
1
1
Enter 1 or 2 to use an OR gate or AND gate and press the ENTER key.
Enter 0 or 1 to add 0.2s off-delay time to the output relay or not and press the ENTER key.
Press the END key to return to the "Setting" screen.
Assigning signals
Press 2 on the "Setting" screen to display the "Input to logic gate" screen.
172
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
/5
In
In
In
Input
#1 (
#2 (
#3 (
In
In
In
#4 (
#5 (
#6 (
to
log
000-
ic
307
307
307
g
1
1
1
a
)
)
)
te
1/
21
4
67
000-
3071 )
3071 )
3071 )
0
0
0
Assign signals to gates (In #1 to #6) by entering the number corresponding to each signal
referring to Appendix B.
Note: If signals are not assigned to all the gates #1 to #6, enter 0 for the unassigned gate(s).
Four LEDs of the GRL100 are user-configurable. Each is driven via a logic gate which can be
programmed for OR gate or AND gate operation. Further, each LED has a programmable reset
characteristic, settable for instantaneous drop-off, or for latching operation. The signals listed in
Appendix B can be assigned to each LED as follows.
Selection of LED
Press 9 (= LED) on the "Setting (change)" screen to display the "LED" screen.
/2 LED
Select
LED
1-
4)
Select
No.=
Enter the LED number and press the ENTER key to display the "Setting" screen.
/3 Setting
(LED1)
1=Logic gate type & reset
2=Input to logic gate
1/
1
1
Enter 1 or 2 to use an OR gate or AND gate and press the ENTER key.
Enter 0 or 1 to select Instantaneous reset or Latch reset and press the ENTER key.
Assigning signals
Press 2 on the "Setting" screen to display the "Input to logic gate" screen.
173
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
/4
In
In
In
Input
#1 (
#2 (
#3 (
In
#4 (
to
logic
307
00307
0307
0-
g
1
1
1
a
)
)
)
te
1/
21
4
67
3071)
Assign signals to gates (In #1- #4) by entering the number corresponding to each signal
referring to Appendix B.
Note: If signals are not assigned to all the gates #1-#4, enter 0 to the unassigned gate(s).
4.2.7
Testing
The sub-menu "Test" provides such functions as setting of testing switches, forced operation of
binary outputs, time measurement of the variable setting timer, logic signal observation and
synchronized end-to-end tests. The password must be entered in order to enter the test screens
because the "Test" menu has password security protection. (See the section 4.2.6.2.)
4.2.7.1
Testing switches
Press 5 (= Test) on the top "MENU" screen to display the "Test" screen.
/1 Test
1=Switch
3=Timer
5=Sim. fault
2=Binary output
4=Logic circuit
6=Init. 2B
1=On
1=On
1=On
1 /
1
0
0
Open
T.te
D.te
IECT
THMR
COM4
COM5
SCOM
SCOM
S2CO
S2CO
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
=On
=On
=On
=On
=On
=On
=On
=On
=On
=On
=On
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1=On
2
st
st
ST
ST
1
2
M1
M2
S2COM12
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
=O
=O
=O
=O
=O
=O
=O
=O
=O
=O
=O
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
0=Off
The fourth line (Open2) is displayed only for three-terminal line application ("3TERM" setting).
174
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
The automatic monitor function (A.M.F.) can be disabled by setting the switch [A.M.F] to
"OFF".
A.M.F.
Disabling the A.M.F. prevents tripping from being blocked even in the event of a failure in the
items being monitored by this function. It also prevents failures from being displayed on the
"ALARM" LED and LCD described in Section 4.2.1. No events related to A.M.F. are recorded,
either.
Disabling A.M.F. is useful for blocking the output of unnecessary alarms during testing.
Note: If the simulated fault inputs are applied under a failure condition and the A.M.F. is switched
"OFF", the relay will issue a trip command but the operation of the relay cannot be displayed
correctly.
L.TEST
Open1, Open2
The switch [Open 1] and [Open 2] are used to maintain two terminal operation in three-terminal
line application, when one terminal is out-of-service (i.e., breaker and/or disconnector are
opened) due to relay failures or communication failures and fault investigations.
When the remote terminal 1 or 2 is out-of-service, set the switch [Open 1] or [Open 2] to "1"
(=On) at the in-service terminals to remove the out-of-service remote terminal from protection.
The remote terminal 1 is a terminal to which the local communication port 1 is linked and the
remote terminal 2 is a terminal to that the local communication port 2 is linked.
T.TEST
The switch [T. test] is used for local testing of the current differential elements. When the [T.
test] is set to "1" (=On), the local current data is looped into the receiving circuit interrupting the
current data from the remote terminal as well as transmitted to the remote terminal.
Note: The switch [T. test] must be used only when all the terminals are out-of-service. If not, the
local test current may cause a disturbance at the in-service remote terminal because this
switching is not recognized at the remote terminal.
In case of electrical interface, the electrical cable must be removed to prevent signal
interfering between sending and the receiving data. The remote terminal will detect the
communication failure.
D.TEST
The switch [D. test] is used to test the relay models with an optical interface (Short wavelength
light, GI, 2km class) and with an electrical interface in accordance with CCITT-G703-1.2.1,
1.2.2 and 1.2.3. Setting the [D. test] to "1" (= On) enables loop-back tests as well as end-to-end
tests of the relays under the direct connection of the communication circuit. For the loop-back
test or end-to-end test setup, see Section 6.5.1.1.
175
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Note: Be sure to restore these switches after the tests are completed or three-terminal normal
operation resumes. In normal operation, the switch [A.M.F] is set to "1" (=On) and other
switches to "0" (=Off). In other situation, the red "TESTING" LED is lit for alarming.
IECTST
Enter 1(=On) for [IECTST] to transmit test mode to the control system by IEC60870-5-103
communication when testing the local relay, and press the ENTER key.
The switch [THMRST] is used to set the reset delay time to instantaneous reset or not and to test
the hot curve characteristic of THM. The function is active when the [THMRST] is ON.
Enter 1(=On) for testing the thermal overload element, and press the ENTER key.
It is possible to forcibly operate all binary output relays for checking connections with the
external devices. Forced operation can be performed on one or more binary outputs at a time for
each module.
Press 2 (= Binary output) on the "Test" screen to display the "Binary output" screen.
/2 Binary
1 =IO# 1
output
2 =IO#2
3 =IO#3
The LCD displays the output modules installed depending on the model.
Enter the selected number corresponding to each module to be operated. Then the LCD
displays the name of the module, the name of the output relay, the name of the terminal block
and the terminal number to which the relay contact is connected.
/3
IO#
IO#
IO#
BO
1
(0 =Disable
1
1
T P-A1
T P-B1
T P-C1
1/
1
1
1
IO# 1
IO# 1
IO# 1
T P-A2
T P-B2
T P-C2
0
0
0
176
1=Enable)
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
/3
IO#
IO#
IO#
BO
2
IO#
IO#
IO#
IO#
IO#
IO#
IO#
IO#
IO#
IO#
IO#
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
(0 =Disable
1=Enable)
BO1
BO2
BO3
1 /14
1
1
1
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
F
B
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
O4
O5
O6
O7
O8
O9
O10
O11
O12
AIL
O13
Enter 1 and press the ENTER key to operate the output relays forcibly.
After completing the entries, press the END key. Then the LCD displays the screen shown
below.
/3 BO
Keep pressing
Press
CANCEL
1
to
to
operate.
cancel.
Timer
The pick-up or drop-off delay time of the variable timer used in the scheme logic can be
measured with monitoring jacks A and B. Monitoring jacks A and B are used to observe the
input signal and output signal to the timer, respectively.
Press 3(= Timer) on the "Test menu" screen to display the "Timer" screen.
/2 Timer
Timer(
1/
1-
48)
Enter the number corresponding to the timer to be observed and press the ENTER key. The
timers and related numbers are listed in Appendix C.
Press the END key to display the following screen.
177
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
/2 Timer
Press ENTER
Press
1/
to
CANCEL
to
operate.
cancel.
Press the ENTER key to operate the timer. The "TESTING" LED turns on, and timer is
initiated and the following display appears. The input and output signals of the timer can be
observed at monitoring jacks A and B respectively. The LEDs above monitoring jacks A or B
are also lit if the input or output signal exists.
/2 T
Oper
Pres
Pres
im
at
s
s
e
i
E
C
r
ng...
ND to
ANCEL
1/
reset.
to cancel.
Press the CANCEL key to test other timers. Repeat the above testing.
Press the END key to reset the input signal to the timer. The "TESTING" LED turns off.
To measure the drop-off delay time, press the END key after the LED above jack B lights.
4.2.7.4
Logic Circuit
It is possible to observe the binary signal level on the signals listed in Appendix B with
monitoring jacks A and B.
Press 4 (= Logic circuit) on the "Test" screen to display the "Logic circuit" screen.
/2 Logic
TermA(
TermB(
circuit
30 7 1 )
00-
30 7 1 )
1/
1
48
Enter a signal number to be observed at monitoring jack A and press the ENTER key.
Enter the other signal number to be observed at monitoring jack B and press the ENTER
key.
After completing the setting, the signals can be observed by the binary logic level at monitoring
jacks A and B or by the LEDs above the jacks.
On screens other than the above screen, observation with the monitoring jacks is disabled.
4.2.7.5
The "Sim. fault" on the "Test" menu is used to generate a synchronized trigger signal for
end-to-end dynamic tests. The signal can be monitored when the signal FG (No.196) in the
signal list is assigned to a user configurable high-speed type auxiliary relay (BO12 or BO13 of
IO2) at the local and remote terminals.
Note: Even if a logic including the signal FG (No.196) is programmed and assigned into the BO13
of IO2, the BO13 outputs the signal FG itself instead of the result of the logic programmed.
The auxiliary relays trigger a simultaneous test current application to the local and remote
terminal differential elements when the 1 key is pressed on the "Sim. fault" screen at either
terminal. The signal transmission delay time is automatically compensated in the relay and the
operation time difference of the auxiliary relays is within 1ms. For the signal list, see Appendix
B.
178
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Note: FG signal cannot be observed at monitoring jacks A and B.
Press 5 (= Test) on the top "MENU" screen to display the "Test" screen.
/1 Test
1=Switch
3=Timer
5=Sim. fault
2=Binary output
4=Logic circuit
Press 5 (= Sim. fault) on the "Test" screen to display the "Simultaneous fault" screen
/2 Simultaneous
Keep pressing 1
fault
to operate.
Press
cancel.
CANCEL
to
4.2.7.6
Init. 2B
To change the synchronization mode to MODE 2B manually in GPS mode, do the followings.
Press 6 (=Init.2B) on the "Test" screen to display the "Init.2B" screen.
/2 Initiate MODE2B
Keep pressing 1 to
Initiate
MODE2B .
MODE2B.
Initiated.
179
MODE2B.
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
4.3
4.4
Harmonic analysis:
Frequency analysis:
Twisted paired
cable
G1PR2
180
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
UTP cable
(10Base-T)
214B-13-10
100/110/115/120V
HUB.
Other
relays
Relay
PC
4.5
The IEC60870-5-103 function in the relay can be customized with the original software
IEC103 configurator. It runs on a personal computer (PC) connected to the relay, and can help
setting of Time-tagged messages, General command, Metering, etc. For details of the setting
method, refer to IEC103 configurator manual. For the default setting of IEC60870-5-103, see
Appendix Q.
The protocol can be used through the RS485 port on the relay rear panel and can be also used
through the optional fibre optical interface. The relay connection is similar to Figure 4.4.1.
The relay supports two baud-rates 9.6kbps and 19.2kbps. The data transfer from the relay can be
blocked by the setting. For the settings, see the Section 4.2.6.4.
4.6
Clock Function
The clock function (Calendar clock) is used for time-tagging for the following purposes:
Event records
Disturbance records
Fault records
Metering
Automatic supervision
Display of the system quantities on the digest screen
Display of the fault records on the digest screen
Display of the automatic monitoring results on the digest screen
The calendar clock can run locally or be synchronized with the external IRIG-B time standard
signal, RSM, IEC or GPS clock. This can be selected by setting.
If it is necessary to synchronize with the IRIG-B time standard signal or GPS signal, it is possible
to transform GMT to the local time by setting.
When the relays are connected to the RSM system as shown in Figure 4.4.1, the calendar clock
of each relay is synchronized with the RSM clock. If the RSM clock is synchronized with the
external time standard (GPS clock etc.), then all the relay clocks are synchronized with the
external time standard.
181
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
5. Installation
5.1
Receipt of Relays
When relays are received, carry out the acceptance inspection immediately. In particular, check
for damage during transportation, and if any is found, contact the vendor.
Check that the following accessories are attached.
3 pins for the monitoring jack, packed in a plastic bag.
An attachment kit required in rack-mounting, if ordered. (See Appendix F.)
1 large bracket with 5 round head screws, spring washers and washers (M410)
1 small bracket with 3 countersunk head screws (M46)
2 bars with 4 countersunk head screws (M38)
Always store the relays in a clean, dry environment.
5.2
Relay Mounting
Either a rack or flush mounting relay is delivered as designated by the customer. The GRL100
models are classified into two types by their case size, type A and type B. Appendix F shows the
case outlines.
If the customer requires a rack-mounting relay, support metal fittings necessary to mount it in the
19-inch rack are also supplied with the relay.
When to mount the relay in the rack, detach the original brackets fixed on both sides of the relay
and seals on the top and bottom of the relay. Attach the larger bracket and smaller bracket on the
left and right side of the relay respectively and the two bars on the top and bottom of the relay.
How to mount the attachment kit, see Appendix F.
Dimensions of the attachment kits EP-101 and EP-102 is also shown in Appendix F.
5.3
Electrostatic Discharge
CAUTION
Do not take out any modules outside the relay case since electronic components on the modules
are very sensitive to electrostatic discharge. If it is absolutely essential to take the modules out of
the case, do not touch the electronic components and terminals with your bare hands.
Additionally, always put the module in a conductive anti-static bag when storing it.
5.4
Handling Precautions
A person's normal movements can easily generate electrostatic potential of several thousand
volts. Discharge of these voltages into semiconductor devices when handling electronic circuits
can cause serious damage, which often may not be immediately apparent but the reliability of the
circuit will have been reduced.
The electronic circuits are completely safe from electrostatic discharge when housed in the case.
Do not expose them to risk of damage by withdrawing modules unnecessarily.
Each module incorporates the highest practicable protection for its semiconductor devices.
However, if it becomes necessary to withdraw a module, precautions should be taken to preserve
182
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
the high reliability and long life for which the equipment has been designed and manufactured.
CAUTION
Before removing a module, ensure that you are at the same electrostatic potential as the
equipment by touching the case.
Handle the module by its front plate, frame or edges of the printed circuit board. Avoid
touching the electronic components, printed circuit board or connectors.
Do not pass the module to another person without first ensuring you are both at the same
electrostatic potential. Shaking hands achieves equipotential.
Place the module on an anti-static surface, or on a conducting surface which is at the same
potential as yourself.
Do not place modules in polystyrene trays.
5.5
External Connections
External connections are shown in Appendix G.
Electrical interface for telecommunication
Connector
To Multiplexer
CH1
E
CH2
Figure 5.5.1
183
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Optical interface for telecommunication
The optical cables tend to come down, therefore, bending requires special attention.
Handling instructions of optical cable are as follows:
Instructions
184
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
These tests are performed for the following hardware to ensure that there is no hardware defect.
Defects of hardware circuits other than the following can be detected by monitoring which
circuits functions when the DC power is supplied.
User interfaces
Binary input circuits and output circuits
AC input circuits
Function tests
These tests are performed for the following functions that are fully software-based. Tests of the
protection schemes and fault locator require a dynamic test set.
Measuring elements
Timers
Protection schemes
Autoreclose
Metering and recording
Fault locator
Conjunctive tests
The tests are performed after the relay is connected with the primary equipment,
telecommunication equipment and other external equipment.
The following tests are included in these tests:
On load test: phase sequence check and polarity check
Signaling circuit test
Tripping and reclosing circuit test
185
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
6.2
Cautions
6.2.1
Safety Precautions
CAUTION
The relay rack is provided with a grounding terminal.
Before starting the work, always make sure the relay rack is grounded.
When connecting the cable to the back of the relay, firmly fix it to the terminal block and
attach the cover provided on top of it.
Before checking the interior of the relay, be sure to turn off the power.
Class 1M laser radiation when remove cap for models with <30km class optical interface. Do
not view directly with optical instruments.
Failure to observe any of the precautions above may cause electric shock or malfunction.
6.2.2
Cautions on Tests
CAUTION
While the power is on, do not connect/disconnect the flat cable on the front of the printed
circuit board (PCB).
While the power is on, do not mount/dismount the PCB.
Before turning on the power, check the following:
- Make sure the polarity and voltage of the power supply are correct.
- Make sure the CT circuit is not open.
- Make sure the VT circuit is not short-circuited.
Be careful that the transformer module is not damaged due to an overcurrent or overvoltage.
If settings are changed for testing, remember to reset them to the original settings.
Failure to observe any of the precautions above may cause damage or malfunction of the relay.
Before mounting/dismounting the PCB, take antistatic measures such as wearing an earthed
wristband.
186
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
6.3
Preparations
Test equipment
Before starting the tests, it must be specified whether the tests will use the users settings or the
default settings.
For the default settings, see the following appendixes:
Appendix D Binary Output Default Setting List
Appendix H Relay Setting Sheet
Visual inspection
After unpacking the product, check for any damage to the relay case. If there is any damage, the
internal module might also have been affected. Contact the vendor.
Relay ratings
Check that the items described on the nameplate on the front of the relay conform to the users
specification. The items are: relay type and model, AC voltage, current and frequency ratings,
and auxiliary DC supply voltage rating.
Local PC
When using a local PC, connect it with the relay via the RS232C port on the front of the relay.
RSM100 software is required to run the PC.
For the details, see the separate instruction manual "PC INTERFACE RSM100".
187
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
6.4
Hardware Tests
The tests can be performed without external wiring, but DC power supply and AC voltage and
current source are required.
6.4.1
User Interfaces
This test ensures that the LCD, LEDs and keys function correctly.
LCD display
Apply the rated DC voltage and check that the LCD is off.
Note: If there is a failure, the LCD displays the "Auto-supervision" screen when the DC voltage is
applied.
Press the RESET key for 1 second when the LCD is off, and check that black dots appear on
the whole screen.
LED display
Apply the rated DC voltage and check that the "IN SERVICE" LED is lit in green.
Press the RESET key for 1 second when the LCD is off, and check that seven LEDs under
the "IN SERVICE" LED and two LEDs for monitoring jacks A and B are lit in red.
VIEW and RESET keys
Press the VIEW key when the LCD is off and check that the "Metering" screen is displayed
on the LCD.
Press the RESET key and check that the LCD turns off.
Keypad
Press any key on the keypad when the LCD is off and check that the LCD displays the
"MENU" screen. Press the END key to turn off the LCD.
Repeat this for all keys.
188
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
6.4.2
BI1
BI2
:
:
:
:
-A11
BI15
-B11
TB3 -A14
BI16
-B14
BI17
-A15
BI18
-B15
DC
power
supply
TB4 -A16
-A17
E
Display the "Binary input & output" screen from the "Status" sub-menu.
/2 Binary input
Input (IO#1)
Input (IO#2)
&
output status
[00 0 000 000
[00 0
000
000]
]
Apply the rated DC voltage to terminal A4, B4, ..., A11 of terminal block TB4, and A14, B14
and A15 of terminal block TB3.
Check that the status display corresponding to the input signal changes from 0 to 1. (For
details of the binary input status display, see Section 4.2.4.2.)
Note: Different models have different terminal block and terminal number, so refer to Appendix G.
The user will be able to perform this test for one terminal to another or for all the terminals at
once.
189
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
6.4.3
CANCEL
1
to
to
operate.
cancel.
190
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
6.4.4
AC Input Circuits
This test can be performed by applying known values of voltages and currents to the AC input
circuits and verifying that the values applied coincide with the values displayed on the LCD
screen.
The testing circuit is shown in Figure 6.4.4.1. A three-phase voltage source and a single-phase
current source are required.
GRL100
V
Three-phase
voltage
source
TB1 -11
-12
-13
Va
Vb
Vc
-14
TB1 -1
A
Single-phase
current
source
-3
-4
-5
-6
-7
-8
DC
power
supply
Ia
-2
TB4 -A16
-A17
Ib
Ic
3I o
Check that the metering data is set to be expressed as secondary values (Display value = 2) on
the "Metering" screen.
191
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
6.5
Function Test
CAUTION
The function test may cause the output relays to operate including the tripping output
relays. Therefore, the test must be performed with tripping circuits disconnected.
6.5.1
Measuring Element
Measuring element characteristics are realized by software, so it is possible to verify the overall
characteristics by checking representative points.
Operation of the element under test is observed by the binary output signal at monitoring jacks A
or B or by the LED indications above the jacks. In any case, the signal number corresponding to
each element output must be set on the "Logic circuit" screen of the "Test" sub-menu.
/2 Logi c
TermA(
TermB(
circuit
03071 )
3071 )
0-
1/
1
48
When a signal number is entered for the TermA line, the signal is observed at monitoring jack A
and when entered for the TermB line, observed at monitoring jack B.
Note:
The voltage level at the monitoring jacks is +15V 3V for logic level "1" when measured by
an instrument with 10k input impedance, and less than 0.1V for logic level "0".
CAUTION
Use test equipment with more than 1k of internal impedance when observing the output
signal at the monitoring jacks.
192
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
6.5.1.1
The phase current differential element is checked for the following items.
Operating current value
Charging current compensation (excluding Model 100s)
Percentage restraining characteristic
The top two items are tested locally or under an end-to-end setup of each terminal relay.
The last item is tested only under an end-to-end setup of each terminal relay.
Operating current value
Figure 6.5.1.1 shows the circuit to test the A-phase element locally.
GRL100
A
TB1 -1
Single-phase
current
source
TX1
Ia
CH1
RX1
-2
TX2
CH2
RX2
DC
power
supply
TB4 -A16
-A17
Monitoring
jack
DC
voltmeter
Signal number
DIF-A
41
DIF-B
42
DIF-C
43
193
A
0V
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Set the [L.test] to 1 (= On) on the Switch screen of the Test sub-menu.
Check that the charging current compensation DIFIC is set to zero on the "Protection
element" screen in the "Setting (view)" sub-menu. If not, set it to zero in the "Setting
(change)" sub-menu.
Press 4 (= Logic circuit) on the "Test" sub-menu screen to display the "Logic circuit" screen.
Enter a signal number 41 for Term A line to observe the DIF-A operation at monitoring jack
A and press the ENTER key.
Apply a test current and change the magnitude of the current applied and measure the value at
which the element operates.
Check that the measured value is within 7% of the setting DIFI1.
Charging current compensation
The charging current compensation function is checked by displaying the differential current on
the LCD.
Figure 6.5.1.2 shows the test circuit.
GRL100
V
TB1 -11
Single-phase
voltage
source
Va
-14
TX2
CH2
RX2
TB1 -1
A
Single-phase
current
source
Ia
-2
TB4 -A9
Monitoring
jack
-B11
DC
power
supply
TX1
CH1
RX1
TB4 -A16
-A17
E
DC
voltmeter
194
A
0V
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Set the [L.test] to 1 (= On) on the Switch screen of the Test sub-menu.
When the charging current compensation is in operation, the differential current Id is expressed
with the following equation:
Id = I (1/n) DIFIC
where,
I = applied test current
n = 2 in case of two-terminal line application
= 3 in case of three-terminal line application
DIFIC = setting of charging current compensation
Open the "Metering" screen in the "Status" sub-menu.
Apply a rated phase voltage and a test current to A-phase, and adjust the voltage lagging by
90.
Check that the A-phase differential current Ida on the "Metering" screen coincides with the Id
When the percentage restraint characteristic is checked, an end-to-end setup using two relays is
required.
<Testing at laboratory>
If the relays can be collected and tested at a laboratory, the end-to-end test is possible by directly
connecting their communication ports. Figure 6.5.1.3 (a) shows the testing circuit of the
laboratory end-to-end test.
In case of two-terminal applications, the signal terminals CH1-TX1 and RX1 of one relay are
directly connected to CH1-RX1 and -TX1 of another relay.
Note: When the relays have an electrical telecommunications interface in accordance with
CCITT-G703-1.2.1 or an optical interface (Short wavelength light, GI, 2km class), the
scheme switch [D. test] must be set to 1 (= On) to test them under the direct connection of
the communication circuits.
195
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Relay A: GRL100
+
Single-phase
current
source
TB1 -1
Ia
TX1
-2
CH1
RX1
(**)
TX2
CH2
RX2
TB4 -A16
-A17
E
Monitoring
jack
0V
Relay C: GRL100
TB1 -1
Ia
(*)
-2
TX1
CH1
RX1
TX2
CH2
RX2
TB4 -A16
-A17
E
Monitoring
jack
A
0V
Relay B: GRL100
+
Single-phase
current
source
TB1 -1
Ia
-2
TX1
CH1
RX1
TX2
CH2
RX2
TB4 -A16
DC
power
supply
-A17
E
Monitoring
jack
A
0V
+
DC
voltmeter
0V
196
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
<Testing on site>
If the relays are tested at each installation site, the end-to-end test is performed after the
telecommunication circuit between terminals is setup. Figure 6.5.1.3 (b) shows the testing circuit
of the on-site end-to-end test.
In the on-site test, it is necessary to set the phase relationship between the test currents of each
terminal. The pulse signal PULSE generated from the synchronized sampling clock is used as a
reference phase signal at each terminal because it is in-phase between the terminals.
197
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
GRL100
+
Single-phase
current
source
TB1 -1
TX1
CH1
RX1
Ia
-2
TX2
CH2
RX2
DC
power
supply
TB4
Monitoring
jack
A
-A16
-A17
0V
PULSE
Reference +
voltage
source
Oscilloscope
Telecomm.
Circuit
+
DC
voltmeter
0V
GRL100
+
Single-phase
current
source
TB1 -1
CH1
Ia
RX1
-2
TX2
CH2
DC
power
supply
TX1
TB4
RX2
Monitoring
jack
A
-A16
-A17
0V
PULSE
Reference +
voltage
source
Oscilloscope
+
DC
voltmeter
GRL100
+
Single-phase
current
source
TB1 -1
TX1
Ia
-2
TB4
RX1
TX2
CH2
RX2
DC
power
supply
CH1
Monitoring
jack
A
-A16
-A17
0V
Reference +
voltage
source
PULSE
Oscilloscope
+
DC
voltmeter
Press 4 (= Logic circuit) on the "TEST" sub-menu screen to display the "Logic circuit"
198
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
screen.
Enter a signal number 270 for Term B to observe a signal PULSE at monitoring jack B, and
then press the ENTER key.
PULSE
signal
Reference
voltage
Time
Testing
current
The percentage restraint characteristic is tested on the outflow current (Iout) and infeed current
(Iin) plane as shown in Figure 6.5.1.5 by applying an infeed current to one relay and an outflow
current to another relay.
Iout
Iin = Iout
DIFI2
B
A
DIFI1
Iin
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Characteristic B is expressed by the following equation,
Iout DIFI2
where, DIFI1 and DIFI2 are setting values.
Set the charging current compensation DIFIC to zero.
Press 4 (= Logic circuit) on the "Test" sub-menu screen to display the "Logic circuit" screen.
Enter a signal number 41 to observe the DIF-A output at monitoring jack A and press the
ENTER key.
Apply a fixed infeed current to one relay. Apply an outflow current to another relay, change
the magnitude of the current applied and measure the value at which the element operates.
Repeat the above by changing the magnitude of the infeed current.
Check that the measured value of the outflow current is within 7% of the theoretical values
obtained using the equations mentioned above. (The infeed current is more than 0.5In).
6.5.1.2
The residual current differential element is checked on the operating current and percentage
restraining characteristic in the same way as described in Section 6.5.1.1.
Element
Signal number
DIFG
44
The differences from the procedure described in Section 6.5.1.1 are as follows.
Apply a test current to terminal 7 and 8 instead of 1 and 2.
Enter a signal number 44 instead of 41 to observe the DIFG element operation at monitoring
jack A.
Use the settings DIFGI instead of DIFI1.
200
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
6.5.1.3
Overcurrent elements OC, EF, OC1 and inverse definite minimum time (IDMT) overcurrent
elements OCI, EFI
TB1 -1
-2
-7
-8
TX1
Ia
3Io
CH1
RX1
TX2
CH2
RX2
Monitoring
jack
A
0V
DC
power
supply
TB4 -A16
-A17
E
DC
voltmeter
Signal number
OC-A
65
EF
71
OC1-A
368
Remarks
201
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
(2) Inverse definite minimum time (IDMT) overcurrent elements OCI, EFI
TB1 -1
-2
-7
-8
TX1
Ia
CH1
RX1
In
TX2
CH2
RX2
Monitoring
jack
A
0V
DC
power
supply
TB4 -A16
-A17
E
Start
Time
counter
Stop
OV
One of the four inverse time characteristics can be set, and the output signal numbers of the
IDMT are as follows:
Element
Signal number
OCI-A
68
EFI
72
Remarks
Fix the time characteristic to test by setting the scheme switch MOCI or MEFI on the "Scheme
switch" screen.
"Setting (change)" sub-menu "Protection" screen "Trip" screen "Scheme switch"
screen
The testing procedures is as follows:
Press 4 (= Logic circuit) on the "Test" sub-menu screen to display the "Logic circuit" screen.
Enter a signal number to observe the OCI or EFI output at monitoring jack A and press the
ENTER key.
Apply a test current and measure the operating time. The magnitude of the test current should
be between 1.2 Is to 20 Is, where Is is the current setting.
Calculate the theoretical operating time using the characteristic equations shown in Section
2.11.3. Check that the measured operating time is within the error mentioned below.
Accuracy:
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
6.5.1.4
The testing circuit is same as the circuit shown in Figure 6.5.1.6 (b).
The output signal of testing element is assigned to the monitoring jack A.
The output signal numbers of the elements are as follows:
Element
Signal No.
THM-A
367
THM-T
363
To test easily the thermal overload element, the scheme switch [THMRST] in the "Switch"
screen on the "Test" menu is used.
Set the scheme switch [THMRST] to "ON".
Enter the signal number to observe the operation at the monitoring jack A as shown in
Section 6.5.1.
Apply a test current and measure the operating time. The magnitude of the test current
should be between 1.2 Is to 10 Is, where Is is the current setting.
CAUTION
After the setting of a test current, apply the test current after checking that the THM% has
become 0 on the "Metering" screen.
Calculate the theoretical operating time using the characteristic equations shown in
Section 2.6. Check that the measured operating time is within 5%.
6.5.1.5
The out-of-step element can be tested with an end-to-end setup using two or three relays.
Figure 6.5.1.7 (a) and (b) shows the testing circuits of the laboratory test and on-site test. For the
test setup, refer to Section 6.5.1.1.
203
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
GRL100
V
TB1 -11
Single-phase
voltage
source
Va
TX1
CH1
RX1
-14
TB4 -A16
-A17
E
Monitoring
jack
A
0V
V
GRL100
TB1 -11
Single-phase
voltage
source
DC
power
supply
Va
TX1
CH1
-14
TB4 -A16
-A17
E
Monitoring
jack
RX1
A
0V
+
DC
voltmeter
0V
204
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
GRL100
V
TB1 -11
+
Single-phase
voltage
source
-14
TX2
CH2
RX2
DC
power
supply
TX1
CH1
RX1
Va
TB4
Monitoring
jack
A
-A16
-A17
0V
Reference +
voltage
source
Oscilloscope
Telecomm.
Circuit
+
DC
voltmeter
0V
GRL100
V
TB1 -11
+
Single-phase
voltage
source
TX1
Va
CH1
TX2
CH2
DC
power
supply
RX1
-14
TB4
RX2
Monitoring
jack
A
-A16
-A17
0V
Reference +
voltage
source
Oscilloscope
+
DC
voltmeter
GRL100
V
TB1 -11
+
Single-phase
voltage
source
CH1
Va
RX1
-14
TX2
CH2
DC
power
supply
TB4
-A16
TX1
RX2
Monitoring
jack
A
-A17
B
0V
Reference +
voltage
source
Oscilloscope
+
DC
voltmeter
205
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
The output signal numbers of the OST element are as follows.
Element
Signal number
Remarks
OST1
47
OST2
51
Three-terminal application
Press 4 (= Logic circuit) on the "Test" sub-menu screen to display the "Logic circuit" screen.
Enter a signal number 47 (OST1) or 51 (OST2) to be observed at monitoring jack A and press
the ENTER key.
Apply the rated voltage in phase with the reference voltage signal to both relays.
Shift the applied voltage phase angle from the reference signal at one terminal, and measure
the angle just at which the element operates.
Check that the measured angle is within 180 5.
6.5.1.6
The test circuit is shown in Figure 6.5.1.8. If scheme switch "3PH-VT" is set to "Bus", the
three-phase voltage simulates the busbar voltage, and the single-phase voltage simulates the line
voltage. If the switch is set to "Line", the opposite is true.
GRL100
V
-12
Va
Vb
-13
Vc
TB1 -11
Three-phase
voltage
source
-14
TX1
CH1
RX1
TX2
CH2
RX2
(**)
Monitoring
jack A
A
0V
V
-15
Single-phase
voltage
source
Vref1
-16
-17
(*)
DC
power
supply
-18
TB4 -A16
-A17
Vref2
DC
voltmeter
When testing OVL2, UVL2 and SYN2, a single-phase voltage must be applied to terminals 17
and 18, instead of terminals 15 and 16 and "3PH-VT" is set to "Line".
Voltage and synchronism check elements and their output signal number are listed below.
206
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
OVL2, UVL2 and SYN2 are used for two-breaker autoreclose and provided in model 300s and
500s.
Element
Signal number
OVB
57
UVB
58
OVL1
60
UVL1
61
OVL2
62
UVL2
63
SYN1
59
SYN2
64
Connect the phase angle meter to the three-phase voltages taking the scheme switch "VT-RATE"
and VTPH-SEL settings into consideration. The phase angle meter connection shown in Figure
6.5.1.8 is the case for the default settings, ie., "VT-RATE" and "VTPH-SEL" are set to PH/G and
A, respectively.
VT-RATE setting
VTPH-SEL setting
PH/G
A-N
B-N
C-N
A-B
B-C
C-A
PH/PH
Voltage check element OVB, UVB, OVL1, UVL1, OVL2, and UVL2
Press 4 (= Logic circuit) on the "Test" screen to display the "Logic circuit" screen.
Enter a signal number for the TermA line to be observed at monitoring jack A and press the
ENTER key.
Apply a three-phase rated voltage and a single-phase rated voltage as shown in Figure
6.5.1.8.
207
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
the value at which the element operates. Check that the measured value is within 5% of the
setting.
Synchronism check element SYN1
Press 4 (= Logic circuit) on the "Test" screen to display the "Logic circuit" screen.
Enter a signal number for the TermA line to be observed at monitoring jack A and press the
ENTER key.
Apply a three-phase rated voltage and a single-phase rated voltage as shown in Figure
6.5.1.8.
Voltage check:
Set the three-phase voltage to any value over the SY1OV setting. (The default setting of
SY1OV is 51V.)
Whilst keeping Vr in-phase with Va, lower the single-phase voltage Vr from the rated value.
Measure the voltage at which the element operates. Check that the measured voltage is within
5% of the SY1UV setting.
Further lower Vr and measure the voltage at which the element resets. Check that the
measured voltage is within 5% of the SY1OV setting.
208
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
6.5.1.7
The overcurrent element is tested locally. The test circuit is shown in Figure 6.5.1.6(a).
The output signal number of the OCBF element is as follows.
Element
Signal number
OCBF-A
54
Press 4 (= Logic circuit) on the "Test" sub-menu screen to display the "Logic circuit" screen.
Enter a signal number 54 (OCBF-A) to be observed at monitoring jack A and press the
ENTER key.
Apply a test current, adjust the magnitude of the current applied and measure the values at
which the element operates and resets.
Check that the measured values are within 5% of the setting in operation and within 5% of the
setting 0.8 in reset.
6.5.1.8
DC
power
supply
TB1 -1
-2
TB4 -A16
-A17
Monitoring
jack
A
0V
DC
voltmeter
Signal number
OCD-A
63
Operation must be verified by abruptly changing the test current from 0 A to 1.2 Setting value
or vice versa.
OCD has a fixed setting of 0.5 A and 0.1 A for 5 A rating and 1 A rating respectively.
6.5.2
Timer
The pick-up delay time of the variable timer can be measured by connecting the monitoring jacks
A and B to a time counter as shown in Figure 6.5.2.1. Jacks A and B are used to observe the input
signal and output signal of the timer, respectively.
209
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
GRL100
DC
power
supply
TB4 -A16
-A17
E
TX1
RX1
TX2
CH2
RX2
A
CH1
Monitoring
jack
B
0V
Start
Time
counter Stop
0V
CANCEL
to
to
operate.
cancel.
Press the ENTER key to operate the timer. The "TESTING" LED turns on, and the timer is
initiated and the following display appears. The input and output signals of the timer can be
observed at monitoring jacks A and B respectively. The LEDs above monitoring jacks A or B
are also lit if the input or output signal exists.
CANCEL
to
cancel.
Press the END key to reset the input signal to the timer. The "TESTING" LED turns off.
Press CANCEL key to test other timers. Repeat the above testing.
To measure the drop-off delay time, press the END key after the LED above jack B lights. The
off-delay time is the time from a signal at the monitoring jack A resets till a signal at the
monitoring jack B resets.
210
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
6.5.3
Protection Scheme
Protection schemes implemented in GRL100 are basically for unit protection. It is recommended
that the protection schemes are tested under end-to-end mode. The setup of the end-to-end
synchronized test is described in Section 6.5.1.
In the protection scheme tests, a dynamic test set with the three-phase voltage source and current
source is required to simulate power system pre-fault, fault and post-fault conditions.
The "Sim.fault" on the LCD "Test" menu is available to test local and remote terminals
synchronously. For use, see Section 4.2.7.5
The autoreclose function can be tested together with these tests. A permanent fault should be
applied to test a reclose-onto-fault.
Tripping is observed with the tripping command output relays TP-A1 to -C1 and TP-A2 to -C2.
Reclosing is observed with the user configurable reclosing command output relays assigned to
signals ARC1 and ARC2. For the default setting, see Appendix D.
Differential tripping
When a phase current is applied, instantaneous per phase based tripping or three-phase tripping
is performed depending on the fault types, setting of the scheme switches [TPMODE],
[ARC-M], and [STUB]. The switch [TPMODE] is valid for model 100s.
The tripping should be checked for the current which is two times or larger than the minimum
operating current DIFI1 or DIFGI. Operating time is measured by the operating time of the
tripping command output relay. It will typically be 1 cycle.
Check that the indications and recordings are correct.
When a residual current is applied, time-delayed three-phase tripping is performed. Operating
time will be 1 cycle plus setting of timer TDIFG. The tripping or reclosing is blocked when the
scheme switch [DIFG] or [ARC-DIFG] is set to "OFF".
Check that the indications and recordings are correct.
Out-of-step tripping
Set the scheme switch [BF1] to "T" or "TOC" and [BF2] to "ON".
Apply a fault and retain it. Check that the adjacent breaker tripping output relay operates after the
time setting of the TBF2.
The adjacent breaker tripping output relay is user configurable and assigned to signal
CBF-TRIP. For the setting, see Sections 4.2.6.9 and 4.2.7.2.
211
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
6.5.4
Some of the internal events such as Trip, Com1.fail, etc., can be checked in the protection
scheme tests.
Disturbance recording can be checked while testing the protection schemes. The LCD display
only shows the date and time when a disturbance is recorded. Open the "Disturbance records"
screen and check that the descriptions are correct.
Details can be displayed on the PC. Check that the descriptions on the PC are correct. For details
on how to obtain disturbance records on the PC, see the RSM100 Manual.
6.5.5
Fault Locator
As the fault locator requires local and remote terminal currents, the fault locator can be tested
under the end-to-end synchronized test setup.
In the tests, a dynamic test set with the three-phase voltage and current source is required for
each terminal to simulate power system pre-fault, fault and post-fault conditions.
The fault locator starts measurement when the current differential protection operates.
Therefore, it is preferable to test it whilst testing the protection schemes by applying a fault.
The line parameter settings must be changed to meet those of the test set.
The measurement result is expressed as a percentage of the line length and the distance, and is
displayed on the "Fault Record" screen of the LCD.
Note: If abnormal settings far from actual transmission line impedance, e.g. resistance
value so larger than reactance value, etc., are done, the location error will be larger.
212
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
6.6
Conjunctive Tests
6.6.1
On Load Test
With the relay connected to the line which is carrying load current, it is possible to check the
polarity of the voltage and current transformers and the phase rotation with the metering displays
on the LCD screen.
Open the following "Metering" screen from the "Status" sub-menu.
/2
Va
Vb
Vc
Metering
63.5V
63.4V -12
63.5V
12
12/Feb/1998
0.0
la
0.0
lb
lc
0.1
22:56
3/13
2.10A
4.9
2.10A -115.0
2.15A
125.1
...
...
Active power
Reactive power
+
-
400.11M W
2 5.51Mvar
Frequency
60.1
Hz
Note: The magnitude of voltage, current and power can be set in values on the primary side or on
the secondary side by the setting. (The default setting is the primary side.)
Phase angles are expressed taking that of the positive sequence voltage as the reference angle.
The sign of the phase angle can be set positive for either lagging phase or leading phase. (In
the default setting, it is set positive when the phase is leading to the reference angle.)
The sign of the power flow direction can be set positive for either power sending or power
receiving. (The default setting is power sending.)
6.6.2
6.6.3
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Enter 1 to select the IO#1 module, then the LCD displays the screen shown below.
/3 BO
IO#1
IO#1
IO#1
(0 =Disable
1=Enable)
TP-A1
TP-B1
TP-C1
1/
1
1
1
IO#1
IO#1
IO#1
TP-A2
TP-B2
TP-C2
0
0
0
TP-A1, B1 and C1 are output relays with one normally open contact, and trip the A-phase,
B-phase and C-phase breakers. TP-A2 to C2 are used if two-breaker tripping is required in a
one-and-a-half-breaker busbar arrangement.
Enter 1 for TP-A1 and press the ENTER key.
Press the END key. Then the LCD displays the screen shown below.
/3 BO
K e e p p r e s si n g
Press
CANCEL
1 to
to
operate.
cancel.
Keep the 1 key pressed to operate the output relay TP-A1 and check that the A-phase
breaker is tripped.
Caution: In case of relay models with fault detector, FD module BO also operates when IO#1
module BO is forcibly operated.
Enter 2 to select the IO#2 module, then the LCD displays the screen shown below.
214
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
/3 BO
IO#2
IO#2
IO#2
(0 =Disable
1=Enable)
BO1
BO2
BO3
1 /14
0
0
0
BO10
BO11
BO12
FAIL
BO13
1
0
0
0
0
...
I
I
I
I
I
O#2
O#2
O#2
O#2
O#2
CANCEL
1
to
to
operate.
cancel.
Keep pressing the 1 key to forcibly operate the output relay BO10 and check that the
breaker is closed.
Release pressing the 1 key to reset the operation.
In case of two-breaker autoreclose, repeat the forcible operation for BO9.
215
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
6.7
Maintenance
6.7.1
Regular Testing
The relay is almost completely self-supervised. The circuits which cannot be supervised are
binary input and output circuits and human interfaces.
Therefore regular testing can be minimized to checking the unsupervised circuits. The test
procedures are the same as described in Sections 6.4.1, 6.4.2 and 6.4.3.
6.7.2
Failures detected by supervision are traced by checking the "Auto-supervision" screen on the
LCD.
If any messages are shown on the LCD, the failed module or failed external circuits can be
located by referring to Table 6.7.2.1.
This table shows the relationship between messages displayed on the LCD and estimated failure
location. Locations marked with (1) have a higher probability than locations marked with (2).
As shown in the table, some of the messages cannot identify the fault location definitely but
suggest plural possible failure locations. In these cases, the failure location is identified by
replacing the suggested failed modules with spare modules one by one or investigating and
restoring the monitored external circuits (the signaling channel and isolator circuit) until the
"ALARM" LED is turned off.
The replacement or investigation should be performed first for the module or circuit with higher
probability in the table.
If there is a failure and the LCD is not working such as a screen is frozen or not displayed, the
failure location is either SPM or HMI module.
216
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Table 6.7.2.1 LCD Message and Failure Location
Message
Failure location
VCT
SPM
(GCOM)
Checksum err
ROM-RAM err
SRAM err
BU-RAM err
DPRAM err
EEPROM err
A/D err
IO1
or
IO8(*)
IO2
IO3,
IO5,
IO6
IO4
FD
HMI
Channel
Disconnector
AC
cable
V0 err
(2)
(1)
(2)
V2 err
(2)
(1)
(2)
I0 err
(2)
(1)
(2)
Id err
(2)
(1)
(2)
CT err
(2)
(2)
(1)
Sampling err
DIO err
(2)
(1)
RSM err
(2)
(1)
(1)
(1)
(1)
COM_ .err
FD: err
(2)
(1)
(1)
(2)
(1)
(1)
DS fail
(2)
(2)
(2)*
(2)*
(2)*
(1)*
(2)*
(2)*
(2)*
(1)*
(1)*
(2)*
(2)*
(1)*
(2)*
(2)*
(2)*
(1)*
(2)*
(2)*
(2)*
(1)*
(2)*
(1)*
(2)*
(1)*
CT fail
No-working of LCD
(2)
(1)
(2)
(1)
(2)
(1)
Note: IO8 required for models 204, 206, 214 and 216.
The location marked with (1) has a higher probability than the location marked with (2).
The item of location marked with (*): also check the remote terminal relays and equipment.
217
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
If no message is shown on the LCD, it means that the failure location is either in the DC power
supply circuit or in the microprocessors mounted on the SPM module. In this case, check the
"ALARM" LED. If it is off, the failure is in the DC power supply circuit. If it is lit, open the relay
front panel and check the LEDs mounted on the SPM module. If the LED is off, the failure is in
the DC power supply circuit. If the LED is lit, the failure is in the microprocessors.
In the former case, check if the correct DC voltage is applied to the relay.
If so, replace the IO1 or IO8 module mounting the DC/DC converter and confirm that the
"ALARM" LED is turned off.
In the latter case, replace the SPM module mounting the processors and confirm that the
"ALARM" LED is turned off.
When a failure is detected during regular testing, it will not be difficult to identify the failed
module to be replaced.
Note: When a failure or an abnormality is detected during the regular test, confirm the following
first:
- Test circuit connections are correct.
- Modules are securely inserted in position.
- Correct DC power voltage with correct polarity is applied and connected to the correct
terminals.
- Correct AC inputs are applied and connected to the correct terminals.
- Test procedures comply with those stated in the manual.
6.7.3
Hardware type-form
VCT
G1PC1 -
SPM
G1SP -
IO1
G1IO1 -
IO2
G1IO2 -
IO3
G1IO3 -
IO4
G1IO2 -
IO5
G1IO3 -
IO6
G1IO3 -
IO8
G1IO8 -
FD
G1FD1 -
HMI
----
218
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
The software name is indicated on the memory device on the module with six letters such as
GS1LM1, GS1LC1, GS1ZF1, etc.
CAUTION
CAUTION
WARNING Hazardous voltage may remain in the DC circuit just after switching off the
DC power supply. It takes approximately 30 seconds for the voltage to
discharge.
Detach the module holding bar by unscrewing the binding screw located on the left side of
the bar.
Unplug the ribbon cable on the SPM (and FD module in models 400s and 500s) by nipping
the catch.
Remove the metal cover by unscrewing the binding screw located at the top and bottom of the
cover.
Pull out the module by grasping the handles.
Insert the replacement module in the reverse procedure.
Replacing other modules
Open the right-side front panel (HMI module) by unscrewing the two binding screws
located on the left side of the panel.
219
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Open the left-side front panel (blind panel) (*) by unscrewing the two binding screws located
on the right side of the panel.
(*) This panel is attached only to models assembled in the type B case.
Detach the module holding bar by unscrewing the binding screw located on the left side of
the bar.
Unplug the ribbon cable running among the modules by nipping the catch (in case of black
connector) and by pushing the catch outside (in case of gray connector) on the connector.
Unplug the cable connector behind the case when replacing the SPM module.
Pull out the module by pulling up or down on the top and bottom levers.
Insert the replacement module in the reverse procedure.
6.7.4
Resumption of Service
After replacing the failed module or repairing failed external circuits, take the following
procedures to restore the relay to service.
Switch on the DC power supply and confirm that the "IN SERVICE" green LED is lit and the
"ALARM" red LED is not lit.
Note: Supply DC power after checking that all the modules are in their original positions and the
ribbon cables are plugged in.
If the telecommunication circuit or trip circuit was repaired, check that the circuit is normal.
Supply the AC inputs and reconnect the trip outputs.
6.7.5
Storage
The spare relay or module should be stored in a dry and clean room. Based on IEC Standard
60255-0 the storage temperature should be 25C to +70C, but the temperature of 0C to +40C
is recommended for long-term storage.
220
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
In particular, when settings are changed temporarily for testing, be sure to restore them.
Clear any unnecessary records on faults, events and disturbances which are recorded during
the tests.
Reset the counter figures of autoreclose(*), if necessary. For resetting the count, see Section
4.2.3.4.
(*)
Press the VIEW key and check that no failure message is displayed on the
"Auto-supervision" screen.
Check that the green "IN SERVICE" LED is lit and no other LEDs are lit on the front panel.
Whilst the relay is put into service at one terminal by supplying DC power and not yet at the
other terminal, a communication failure will be detected by the automatic monitoring at the
in-service terminal and a red "ALARM" LED is lit. But it will be reset when the relays are put
into service at all terminals.
221
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
222
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Appendix A
Block Diagram
Note: These show simplified block diagrams including each protection function.
For details of each protection function, refer to Chapter 2.
223
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
DIF
&
0t
t0
0t
t0
0t
t0
Trip A
Trip B
Trip C
1
&
&
+ (ON)
CB Trip
Command
1
1
0.06s
DIFG
- (OFF)
&
DIFG
TDIFG
tt 0
&
0.10 - 10.00s
OC
tt
&
B
C
0 - 10.00s
+ (ON)
OCBT
- (OFF)
OCI
00
A
1
&
Autoreclosing Circuit
SYN
+ (ON)
OCIBT
- (OFF)
EF
tt
00
&
+(ON)
0 - 10.00s
&
ARC-DIFG
-(OFF)
+ (ON)
- (OFF)
&
+(ON)
-(OFF )
THM
&
+(ON)
THMT
-(OFF )
BU protection block
EXT Trip A
EXT Trip B
EXT Trip C
OST
&
(Local-Remot e1)
0t
0t
0.1s
CB1 contact A ph.
CB1 contact B ph.
CB1 contact C ph.
OST
&
(Local-Remot e2)
+(ON )
OST
-(OFF)
+(ON)
BF2
-(OFF)
A
B
C
Trip-A
EXT.TRIP A ph.
&
tt
tt
TBF12
Interlink
Condition
Circuit
between
Local and
Remote
terminal
Comm.
Channel
(Sending)
&
(TOC)
BFEXT
&
&
+(ON)
-(OFF)
OV
CB1 ready
ARC block
Parallel line link condition A (Term.1)
Parallel line link condition B (Term.1)
Parallel line link condition C (Term.1)
EFIBT
OCBF
UV
EFBT
EFI
- SPAR
- TPAR
(with synchr.check)
- SPAR+TPAR
- Multi-pole ARC
- Multi-shot ARC (4shots)
ARC Initiation
BF1
(T)
&
tt
TBF11
50 - 500ms
(OFF)
: Relay Element
: Binary input/output
Models 201, 211, 202, 212, 204, 214, 206, 216: With autoreclosing circuit / No fault detection unit
Models 401 and 411: With autoreclosing circuit / With fault detection unit
224
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
DIF
&
0t
0t
0t
0t
0t
0t
&
&
+(ON)
DIFG
&
DIFG
Bus CB Trip
Command
1
1
TDIFG
tt 00
&
tt
Center CB Trip
Command
0.10 - 10.00s
A
0.06s
-(OFF)
OC
Trip A
Trip B
Trip C
00
&
1
0 - 10.00s
+(ON)
-(OFF)
OCBT
A
1
&
Autoreclosing Circuit
SYN
+(ON)
C
-(OFF)
EF
OCIBT
tt
- SPAR
- TPAR
(with synchr.check)
- SPAR+TPAR
- Multi-pole ARC (BUS CB
only)
- Multi-shot ARC (4shots)
ARC
00
&
+(ON)
0 - 10.00s
-(OFF)
+(ON)
&
ARC-DIFG
UV
OV
EFBT
-(OFF)
EFI
-(OFF)
EFIBT
THM
Not provided with
model 500s
&
+(ON)
&
+(ON)
THMT
-(OFF)
BU protection block
OST
&
(Local-Remote1)
0t
OST
0t
&
+(ON)
OST
-(OFF)
+(ON)
BF2
&
-(OFF)
OCBF
A
B
C
Trip-A
EXT.TRIP A ph.
&
&
(TOC)
BFEXT
tt
tt
TBF12
&
+(ON)
-(OFF)
&
BF1
(T)
(OFF)
A
B
C
A
B
C
(Term.1)
(Term.1)
(Term.1)
(Term.2)
(Term.2)
(Term.2)
External trip A
External trip B
External trip C
0.1s
(Local-Remote2)
condition
condition
condition
condition
condition
condition
tt
CB1 contact A
CB1 contact B
CB1 contact C
CB2 contact A
CB2 contact B
CB2 contact C
Disconnector N/O contact
Disconnector N/C contact
External CB close signal
Interlink
Condition
Circuit
between
Local and
Remote
terminal
Comm.
Channel
(Sending)
00
TBF11
50 - 500ms
: Relay
: Binary input/output
Models 101, 111, 102 and 112: No autoreclosing circuit / No fault detection unit
Models 301, 302 and 312: With autoreclosing circuit / No fault detection unit
Models 501 and 511: With autoreclosing circuit / With fault detection unit
225
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
DIF
A
B
&
&
&
+(ON)
DIFG
-(OFF)
DIFG
&
DIF
0t
0t
0t
0t
0t
Bus CB Trip
Command
1
1
0.06s
TDIFG
tt 00
&
Remote Terminal
0t
1
Trip A
Trip B
Trip C
Center CB Trip
Command
&
&
&
0.10 - 10.00s
1
+(ON)
-(OFF)
TFC
+(ON)
-(OFF)
OC
TFC
Autoreclosing Circuit
tt
OCBT
+(ON)
-(OFF)
&
+(ON)
-(OFF)
tt
&
ARC-DIFG
OCIBT
00
&
0 - 10.00s +(ON)
-(OFF)
EFI
EFBT
&
+(ON)
-(OFF)
EFIBT
&
0t
BU protection block
0t
0.1s
OST
&
(Local-Remote1)
+(ON)
OST
OST
(Local-Remote2)
+(ON)
-(OFF)
-(OFF)
A
B
C
- SPAR
- TPAR
(with synchr.check)
- SPAR+TPAR
- Multi-pole ARC (BUS CB
only)
M lti h t ARC (4 h t )
ARC
0 - 10.00s
-(OFF)
EF
&
+(ON)
C
OCI
SYN
00
Trip-A
EXT.TRIP A ph.
&
&
&
&
(TOC)
BFEXT
tt
tt
00
tt
00
&
+(ON)
-(OFF)
BF2
BF1
(T)
(OFF)
TBF12
TBF11
50 - 500ms
condition
condition
condition
condition
condition
condition
A
B
C
A
B
C
OV
(Term.1)
(Term.1)
(Term.1)
(Term.2)
(Term.2)
(Term.2)
CB1 contact A
CB1 contact B
CB1 contact C
CB2 contact A
CB2 contact B
CB2 contact C
Disconnector N/O contact
Disconnector N/C contact
External CB close signal
Interlink
Condition
Circuit
between
Local and
Remote
terminal
Comm.
Channel
(Sending)
: Relay
: Binary input/output
226
UV
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Appendix B
Signal List
227
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
Protection
relay
output
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
Signal Name
Contents
CONSTANT 0
CONSTANT 1
constant 0
constant 1
43CX
43BUX
ARC_COM.ON
TELE.COM.ON
PROT.COM.ON
DIF-A
DIF-B
DIF-C
DIFG
OST1A
OST1B
OST1AB
OST1
OST2A
OST2B
OST2AB
OST2
RELAY_BLOCK
OCBF-A
OCBF-B
OCBF-C
OVB
UVB
SYN1
OVL1
UVL1
OVL2
UVL2
SYN2
OC-A
OC-B
OC-C
OCI-A
OCI-B
OCI-C
EF
EFI
OVL-ABC
52AND2
228
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
124
125
126
127
128
129
130
131
132
133
134
135
136
137
138
139
140
141
142
143
144
145
146
147
148
149
150
151
152
153
154
155
156
157
158
159
160
Signal Name
Contents
52AND
DIF-A TRIP
DIF-B TRIP
DIF-C_TRIP
TDIFG
DIFG TRIP
OST_TRIP
RETRIP-A
RETRIP-B
RETRIP-C
CBFDET
CBF TRIP
TRIP-A
TRIP-B
TRIP-C
TRIP-DETOR
TRIP
STUB
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A2
TRIP-B2
TRIP-C2
FDX1
FDX2
M-OR
M-AND
FD
FD-AND
TOC
TEF
OC TRIP
OCI TRIP
EF_TRIP
EFBT
EFI TRIP
BU_TRIP
OST-BO
REC_BLK12
TRDY1
TSPR1
TTPR1
ARC-L
TPARL-SET
TRR1
TRDY2
TSPR2
TTPR2
ARC-F
TPAR-F
TRR2
TS2
TS3
TS4
TS2R
TS3R
TS4R
MULTI-ARC
MAROK0
MAROK1
MAROK2
MAROK3
MAR-FT
89CB-1AB
89CB-2AB
89CC-3AB
89CB-1AC
89CB-2AC
89CC-3AC
LINK
LB.DL-1
DB.LL-1
LB.LL.SYN-1
LB.DL-2
DB.LL-2
LB.LL.SYN-2
SYN-OP
SYN-SEL
229
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
161
162
163
164
165
166
167
168
169
170
171
172
173
174
175
176
177
178
179
180
181
182
183
184
185
186
187
188
189
190
191
192
193
194
195
196
197
198
199
200
201
202
203
204
205
206
207
208
209
210
211
212
213
214
215
216
217
218
219
220
221
222
223
224
225
226
227
228
229
230
231
232
233
234
235
236
237
238
239
240
Signal Name
TDBL1
TLBD1
TSYN1
TDBL2
TLBD2
TSYN2
REC-READY1
REC-READY2
BRIDGE1
BRIDGE2
IN-PROG1
IN-PROG2
SPAR1
SPAR2
TPAR1
TPAR2
ARC1
ARC2
94TT1
94TT2
FT1
FT2
MPAR1
TEVLV
MPAR2
TP-MPH
TP-1PH
TP-2PH
TSPR3
TTPR3
READY
REM1 READY
REM2 READY
MASTER
SLAVE
FG
85R1.REM1
85R2.REM1
REC-BLK1
TFC ON1
LOCAL TEST1
85R1.REM2
85R2.REM2
REC-BLK2
TFC ON2
LOCAL TEST2
REM1 IN SRV
REM1 OFF SRV
REM1 NON USE
REM2 IN SRV
REM2 OFF SRV
REM2 NON USE
UNREADY1
CFSV1
SPSV1
TX LEVEL1
RX LEVEL1
CLK1
UNREADY2
CFSV2
SPSV2
TX LEVEL2
RX LEVEL2
CLK2
COMM1 FAIL
COMM2 FAIL
TRANSFER
RDIF-R1 OR
RDIF-R2 OR
CFSV1/2-L
RLY FAIL
RLY OP BLK
AMF OFF
O/P CIR. SV
LSSV
CFSV1-L
CFSV1-R
CFSV2-L
CFSV2-R
Contents
TDBL1 timer output
TLBD1 timer output
TSYN1 timer output
TDBL2 timer output
TLBD2 timer output
TSYN2 timer output
ARC ready signal in leader CB autoreclose
ARC ready signal in follower CB autoreclose
Bridge condition in leader CB autoreclose
Bridge condition in follower CB autoreclose
ARC in-progress in leader CB autoreclose
ARC in-progress in follower CB autoreclose
Single-phase autoreclose signal for leader CB
Single-phase autoreclose signal for follower CB
Three-phase autoreclose signal for leader CB
Three-phase autoreclose signal for follower CB
Autoreclose command for CB1
Autoreclose command for CB2
Discrepancy trip signal in leader CB autoreclose
Discrepancy trip signal in follower CB ARC
Final trip of leader CB
Final trip of center CB
Multi-phase auoteclosing signal in leader CB ARC
TEVLV timer output
Multi-phase auoteclosing signal in follower CB ARC
Multi-phase trip
single phase trip
two or more phase trip
Dead time count up signal in follower CB MPAR
Dead time count up signal in follower CB MPAR
Local terminal ready
Terminal 1 ready
Terminal 2 ready
Being set to master terminal
Being set to slave terminal
Trigger signal for end-to-end synchronized test
Transfer trip command 1 receiving from terminal 1
Transfer trip command 2 receiving from terminal 1
Autoreclose blocked at terminal 1
TFC scheme ON setting between remote terminal 1
Terminal 1 "under local test"
Transfer trip command 1 receiving from terminal 2
Transfer trip command 2 receiving from terminal 2
Autoreclose blocked at terminal 2
TFC scheme ON setting between remote terminal 2
Terminal 2 "under local test"
Terminal 1 "in-service"
Terminal 1 "out-of-service"
Terminal 1 "not used"
Terminal 2 "in-service"
Terminal 2 "out-of-service"
Terminal 2 "not used"
Terminal 1 communication not ready
Terminal 1 CFSV
Sampling synchronization with terminal 1 failure signal
Terminal 1 drop of transmission signal level
Terminal 1 drop of receiving signal level
Terminal 1 interrupt of clock signal
Terminal 2 communication not ready
Terminal 2 CFSV
Sampling synchronization with terminal 2 failure signal
Terminal 2 drop of transmission signal level
Terminal 2 drop of receiving signal level
Terminal 2 interrupt of clock signal
Communication with terminal 1 failure signal
Communication with terminal 2 failure signal
Transfer trip receive
RDIF1 (Remote differential trip received from remote-1)
RDIF2 (Remote differential trip received from remote-2)
CFSV1/2-L (Communication fail (236+238))
Relay failure
Relay output block
A.M.F disabling signal
False operation of tripping output circuit
DS failure signal
CFSV1-L (Communication with term.1 fail detected by local relay)
CFSV1-R (Communication with term.1 fail detected by remote relay)
CFSV2-L (Communication with term.2 fail detected by local relay)
CFSV2-R (Communication with term.2 fail detected by remote relay)
230
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
241
242
243
244
245
246
247
248
249
250
251
252
253
254
255
256
257
258
259
260
261
262
263
264
265
266
267
268
269
270
271
272
273
274
275
276
277
278
279
280
281
282
283
284
285
286
287
288
289
290
291
292
293
294
295
296
297
298
299
300
301
302
303
304
305
306
307
308
309
310
311
312
313
314
315
316
317
318
319
320
Signal Name
Contents
CHECKING
CHK FAIL-Q
CHK STEP1
CHK_STEP2
CHK_STEP3
OC/OCI_TRIP
EF/EFI TRIP
RYIDSV1
RYIDSV2
TRIP-H
DEG ALARM
AMP ALARM
DEG_OK
CF1
CF2
TDSV1
TDSV2
50/60Hz
1PPS_OFF
1PPS_SV-L
1PPS_SV-R
1PPS ERROR
DIF#1_
DIF#2
DIF-A#1
DIF-B#1
DIF-C#1
DIFG#1
DIF-A#2
DIF-B#2
DIF-C#2
DIFG#2
OVER_PH
INVALID_PH
UNDER PH
MODE2A
Synchronisation in MODE2A
OCMF-L1
OCMF-L2
OCMF-L3
OCMF-L4
OCMF-L5
OCMF-L6
OCMF-L7
OCMF
OCDF-A
OCDF-B
OCDF-C
OVL-A
OVL-B
OVL-C
EFF
UVSF-AB
UVSF-BC
UVSF-CA
231
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
321
322
323
324
325
326
327
328
329
330
331
332
333
334
335
336
337
338
339
340
341
342
343
344
345
346
347
348
349
350
351
352
353
354
355
356
357
358
359
360
361
362
363
364
365
366
367
368
369
370
371
372
373
374
375
376
377
378
379
380
381
382
383
384
385
386
387
388
389
390
391
392
393
394
395
396
397
398
399
400
Signal Name
Contents
UVGF-A
UVGF-B
UVGF-C
UVDF-A
UVDF-B
UVDF-C
TMPR1
TMPR2
TMPR3
CF1_
RXSA1_ERR
CF2_
RXSA2_ERR
1PPS_SV-R2
THMT
THMA
OC1-A
OC1-B
OC1-C
OCD-A
OCD-B
OCD-C
EFD
CTFID-A
CTFID-B
CTFID-C
DIFSV-A
DIFSV-B
DIFSV-C
CTFID
CTFUV-A
CTFUV-B
CTFUV-C
CTFOVG
CTFUVD-A
CTFUVD-B
CTFUVD-C
CTFUV
CTFUVD
Id element output
ditto
ditto
DIFSV-A element output
DIFSV-B element output
DIFSV-C element output
Id0 element output
UV element for CTF function
ditto
ditto
OVG element for CTF function
UVD element for CTF function
ditto
ditto
UV element for CTF function
UVD element for CTF function
DIF.FS_TRIP
232
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
401
402
403
404
405
406
407
408
409
410
411
412
413
414
415
416
417
418
419
420
421
422
423
424
425
426
427
428
429
430
431
432
433
434
435
436
437
438
439
440
441
442
443
444
445
446
447
448
449
450
451
452
453
454
455
456
457
458
459
460
461
462
463
464
465
466
467
468
469
470
471
472
473
474
475
476
477
478
479
480
Signal Name
Contents
DIF.FS-A TRIP
DIF.FS-B_TRIP
DIF.FS-C_TRIP
DIFG.FS_TRIP
DIF_TRIP
DIFFS_OP
DIFFS-A_OP
DIFFS-B_OP
DIFFS-C OP
DIFGFS_OP
THM_ALARM
THM_TRIP
TR1_TRIP
TR1-A_TRIP
TR1-B_TRIP
TR1-C TRIP
INTER_TRIP1
INTER_TRIP1-A
INTER_TRIP1-B
INTER_TRIP1-C
TR2_TRIP
TR2-A_TRIP
TR2-B_TRIP
TR2-C_TRIP
INTER_TRIP2
INTER TRIP2-A
INTER_TRIP2-B
INTER_TRIP2-C
LOCAL_TEST
TP-A
TP-B
TP-C
SHOT_NUM1
SHOT_NUM2
SHOT_NUM3
SHOT NUM4
SHOT_NUM5
I.LINK-A
I.LINK-B
I.LINK-C
TRIP_ALARM
READY1_ALARM
READY2_ALARM
ARCMD_ALARM
TFC ON
RDIF-A-S
RDIF-B-S
RDIF-C-S
RDIF-S
RD.FS_TRIP
RD.FS-A_TRIP
RD.FS-B_TRIP
RD.FS-C_TRIP
OC-A_TRIP
OC-B TRIP
OC-C_TRIP
OCI-A_TRIP
OCI-B_TRIP
OCI-C_TRIP
IDSV-A
IDSV-B
IDSV-C
ARC-SET
CCB-SET
CB_UNDRY.L_ST
ARCMD OFF
233
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
481
482
483
484
485
486
487
488
489
490
491
492
493
494
495
496
497
498
499
500
501
502
503
504
505
506
507
508
509
510
511
512
513
514
515
516
517
518
519
520
521
522
523
524
525
526
527
528
529
530
531
532
533
534
535
536
537
538
539
540
541
542
543
544
545
546
547
548
549
550
551
552
553
554
555
556
557
:
:
880
Signal Name
Contents
ARCMD SPAR
ARCMD_TPAR
ARCMD S&T
ARCMD_MAPR2
ARCMD MPAR3
ARCMD EXT1P
ARCMD EXT3P
ARCMD EXTMP
ARC.L SUCCESS
ARC.F SUCCESS
TSUC1
TSUC2
ARC_FAIL1
ARC FAIL2
(SPAR)
ditto
ditto
(MPAR)
ditto
(SPAR & TPAR)
ditto
(MPAR2)
ditto
(MPAR3)
ditto
(EXT1P)
ditto
(EXT3P)
ditto
(EXTMP)
Leader CB autoreclose success signal
Follower CB autoreclose success signal
ARC.L success reset signal
ARC.F success reset signal
Leader CB autoreclose fail signal
Follower CB autoreclose fail signal
CTF
CTF_ALARM
3PLL
LB
DB
SYN
CTF detection
CTF alarm
Three phase live line element output
Selected live bus mode
Selected dead bus mode
Selected Synchronism check mode
UARCSW P1
UARCSW P2
UARCSW_P3
BI1 COMMAND
BI2_COMMAND
BI3 COMMAND
BI4 COMMAND
BI5 COMMAND
BI6 COMMAND
BI7 COMMAND
BI8 COMMAND
BI9_COMMAND
BI10 COMMAND
BI11_COMMAND
BI12 COMMAND
BI13_COMMAND
BI14 COMMAND
BI15_COMMAND
BI16 COMMAND
BI17 COMMAND
BI18 COMMAND
BI19 COMMAND
BI20 COMMAND
BI21 COMMAND
BI22_COMMAND
BI23 COMMAND
BI24_COMMAND
BI25 COMMAND
BI26_COMMAND
BI27 COMMAND
BI28_COMMAND
BI34 COMMAND
BI35_COMMAND
BI36 COMMAND
234
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
881
882
883
884
885
886
887
888
889
890
891
892
893
894
895
896
897
898
899
900
901
902
903
904
905
906
907
908
909
910
911
912
913
914
915
916
917
918
919
920
921
922
923
924
925
926
927
928
929
930
931
932
933
934
935
936
937
938
939
940
941
942
943
944
945
946
947
948
949
950
951
952
953
954
955
956
957
958
959
960
Signal Name
Contents
MODE0
MODE1
MODE2A-GPS
MODE2A-Td
MODE2A-CF
MODE2A-ANGLE
MODE2A-RMT
MODE2B
Changed to MODE0
Changed to MODE1
Changed to MODE2A due to GPS failure
Changed to MODE2A due to abnormal telecomm. delay time
Changed to MODE2A due to telecomm. failure
Changed to MODE2A due to sync. failure
Changed to MODE2A due to remote end's request
Changed to MODE2B
V.COM1-R1
235
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
961
962
963
964
965
966
967
968
969
970
971
972
973
974
975
976
977
978
979
980
981
982
983
984
985
986
987
988
989
990
991
992
993
994
995
996
997
998
999
1000
1001
1002
1003
1004
1005
1006
1007
1008
1009
1010
1011
1012
1013
1014
1015
1016
1017
1018
1019
1020
1021
1022
1023
1024
1025
1026
1027
1028
1029
1030
1031
1032
1033
1034
1035
1036
1037
1038
1039
1040
Signal Name
Contents
V.COM2-R1
V.COM3-R1
ditto
ditto
S.V.COM1-R1
S.V.COM2-R1
S.V.COM3-R1
S.V.COM4-R1
S.V.COM5-R1
S.V.COM6-R1
S.V.COM7-R1
S.V.COM8-R1
S.V.COM9-R1
S.V.COM10-R1
S.V.COM11-R1
S.V.COM12-R1
V.COM1-R2
V.COM2-R2
V.COM3-R2
S.V.COM1-R2
S.V.COM2-R2
S.V.COM3-R2
S.V.COM4-R2
S.V.COM5-R2
S.V.COM6-R2
S.V.COM7-R2
S.V.COM8-R2
S.V.COM9-R2
S.V.COM10-R2
S.V.COM11-R2
S.V.COM12-R2
I.COM1-R1
I.COM2-R1
I.COM3-R1
S.I.COM1-R1
S.I.COM2-R1
S.I.COM3-R1
S.I.COM4-R1
S.I.COM5-R1
S.I.COM6-R1
S.I.COM7-R1
S.I.COM8-R1
S.I.COM9-R1
S.I.COM10-R1
S.I.COM11-R1
S.I.COM12-R1
I.COM1-R2
I.COM2-R2
I.COM3-R2
S.I.COM1-R2
S.I.COM2-R2
S.I.COM3-R2
S.I.COM4-R2
S.I.COM5-R2
S.I.COM6-R2
S.I.COM7-R2
S.I.COM8-R2
S.I.COM9-R2
S.I.COM10-R2
S.I.COM11-R2
S.I.COM12-R2
FAULT PHA A
fault phase A
236
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
1041
1042
1043
1044
1045
1046
1047
1048
1049
1050
1051
1052
1053
1054
1055
1056
1057
1058
1059
1060
1061
1062
1063
1064
1065
1066
1067
1068
1069
1070
1071
1072
1073
1074
1075
1076
1077
1078
1079
1080
1081
1082
1083
1084
1085
1086
1087
1088
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094
1095
1096
1097
1098
1099
1100
1101
1102
1103
1104
1105
1106
1107
1108
1109
1110
1111
1112
1113
1114
1115
1116
1117
1118
1119
1120
Signal Name
Contents
FAULT PHA B
FAULT PHA C
FAULT PHA N
FL ERR
FL OB FWD
FL OB BACK
FL NC
FL COMPLETED
fault phase B
fault phase C
fault phase N
fault location start up error
fault location out of bounds(forward)
fault location out of bounds(backward)
fault location not converged
fault location completed
COM1-R1
COM2-R1
COM3-R1
COM4-R1
COM5-R1
COM1-R1
COM2-R1
COM3-R1
COM4-R1
COM5-R1
SUB
SUB
SUB
SUB
SUB
UF
UF
UF
UF
UF
COM1-R1
COM2-R1
COM3-R1
COM4-R1
COM5-R1
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
COM1-R1
COM2-R1
COM3-R1
COM4-R1
COM5-R1
COM6-R1
COM7-R1
COM8-R1
COM9-R1
237
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
1121
1122
1123
1124
1125
1126
1127
1128
1129
1130
1131
1132
1133
1134
1135
1136
1137
1138
1139
1140
1141
1142
1143
1144
1145
1146
1147
1148
1149
1150
1151
1152
1153
1154
1155
1156
1157
1158
1159
1160
1161
1162
1163
1164
1165
1166
1167
1168
1169
1170
1171
1172
1173
1174
1175
1176
1177
1178
1179
1180
1181
1182
1183
1184
1185
1186
1187
1188
1189
1190
1191
1192
1193
1194
1195
1196
1197
1198
1199
1200
Signal Name
Contents
SUB2 COM10-R1
SUB2 COM11-R1
SUB2 COM12-R1
ditto
ditto
ditto
COM1-R2
COM2-R2
COM3-R2
COM4-R2
COM5-R2
COM1-R2
COM2-R2
COM3-R2
COM4-R2
COM5-R2
SUB
SUB
SUB
SUB
SUB
UF
UF
UF
UF
UF
COM1-R2
COM2-R2
COM3-R2
COM4-R2
COM5-R2
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
COM1-R2
COM2-R2
COM3-R2
COM4-R2
COM5-R2
COM6-R2
COM7-R2
COM8-R2
COM9-R2
COM10-R2
COM11-R2
COM12-R2
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
COM1-R1
COM2-R1
COM3-R1
COM4-R1
COM5-R1
COM6-R1
COM7-R1
COM8-R1
COM9-R1
COM10-R1
COM11-R1
COM12-R1
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
COM1-R2
COM2-R2
COM3-R2
COM4-R2
COM5-R2
COM6-R2
COM7-R2
COM8-R2
COM9-R2
COM10-R2
COM11-R2
COM12-R2
238
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
1201
1202
1203
1204
1205
1206
1207
1208
1209
1210
1211
1212
1213
1214
1215
1216
1217
1218
1219
1220
1221
1222
1223
1224
1225
1226
1227
1228
1229
1230
1231
1232
1233
1234
1235
1236
1237
1238
1239
1240
1241
1242
1243
1244
1245
1246
1247
1248
1249
1250
1251
1252
1253
1254
1255
1256
1257
1258
1259
1260
1261
1262
1263
1264
1265
1266
1267
1268
1269
1270
1271
1272
1273
1274
1275
1276
1277
1278
1279
1280
Signal Name
Contents
IEC MDBLK
IEC_TESTMODE
GROUP1_ACTIVE
GROUP2_ACTIVE
GROUP3_ACTIVE
GROUP4_ACTIVE
GROUP5_ACTIVE
GROUP6_ACTIVE
GROUP7_ACTIVE
GROUP8 ACTIVE
RLY_FAIL_
RLY_OP_BLK_
AMF_OFF_
IDSV
Id failure signal
RELAY_FAIL-A
TRIP-H_
CT_ERR_UF
I0_ERR_UF
V0_ERR_UF
V2_ERR_UF
CT_ERR
I0_ERR
V0_ERR
V2_ERR
I0-C ERR UF
I0-C_ERR
CT-C_ERR_UF
CT-C_ERR
50Hz/60Hz
GEN_PICKUP
GEN TRIP
General start/pick-up
General trip
239
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
1281
1282
1283
1284
1285
1286
1287
1288
1289
1290
1291
1292
1293
1294
1295
1296
1297
1298
1299
1300
1301
1302
1303
1304
1305
1306
1307
1308
1309
1310
1311
1312
1313
1314
1315
1316
1317
1318
1319
1320
1321
1322
1323
1324
1325
1326
1327
1328
1329
1330
1331
1332
1333
1334
1335
1336
1337
1338
1339
1340
1341
1342
1343
1344
1345
1346
1347
1348
1349
1350
1351
1352
1353
1354
1355
1356
1357
1358
1359
1360
Signal Name
BI1 COM UF
BI2 COM UF
BI3 COM UF
BI4 COM UF
BI5 COM UF
BI6 COM UF
BI7 COM UF
BI8 COM UF
BI9 COM UF
BI10 COM UF
BI11 COM UF
BI12 COM UF
BI13 COM UF
BI14 COM UF
BI15 COM UF
Contents
240
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
1361
1362
1363
1364
1365
1366
1367
1368
1369
1370
1371
1372
1373
1374
1375
1376
1377
1378
1379
1380
1381
1382
1383
1384
1385
1386
1387
1388
1389
1390
1391
1392
1393
1394
1395
1396
1397
1398
1399
1400
1401
1402
1403
1404
1405
1406
1407
1408
1409
1410
1411
1412
1413
1414
1415
1416
1417
1418
1419
1420
1421
1422
1423
1424
1425
1426
1427
1428
1429
1430
1431
1432
1433
1434
1435
1436
1437
1438
1439
1440
Signal Name
Contents
LOCAL OP ACT
REMOTE OP ACT
NORM LED ON
ALM LED ON
TRIP LED ON
TEST LED ON
ARC COM ON
TELE COM ON
PROT COM ON
PRG LED1 ON
PRG LED2 ON
PRG LED3 ON
PRG LED4 ON
F.Record
F.Record
E.Record
D.Record
DONE
CLR
CLR
CLR
241
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
1441
1442
1443
1444
1445
1446
1447
1448
1449
1450
1451
1452
1453
1454
1455
1456
1457
1458
1459
1460
1461
1462
1463
1464
1465
1466
1467
1468
1469
1470
1471
1472
1473
1474
1475
1476
1477
1478
1479
1480
1481
1482
1483
1484
1485
1486
1487
1488
1489
1490
1491
1492
1493
1494
1495
1496
1497
1498
1499
1500
1501
1502
1503
1504
1505
1506
1507
1508
1509
1510
1511
1512
1513
1514
1515
1516
1517
1518
1519
1520
Signal Name
Contents
Sys.set change
Rly.set change
Grp.set change
KEY-VIEW
KEY-RESET
KEY-ENTER
KEY-END
KEY-CANCEL
SUM err
SRAM err
BU-RAM err
EEPROM err
A/D err
DIO err
LCD err
ROM data err
COM DPRAMerr1
242
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
Input for
protection
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540
1541
1542
1543
1544
1545
1546
1547
1548
1549
1550
1551
1552
1553
1554
1555
1556
1557
1558
1559
1560
1561
1562
1563
1564
1565
1566
1567
1568
1569
1570
1571
1572
1573
1574
1575
1576
1577
1578
1579
1580
1581
1582
1583
1584
1585
1586
1587
1588
1589
1590
1591
1592
1593
1594
1595
1596
1597
1598
1599
1600
1601
1602
1603
1604
1605
1606
1607
1608
1609
1610
1611
1612
1613
1614
1615
Signal Name
Contents
CB1 CONT-A
CB1 CONT-B
CB1 CONT-C
CB2 CONT-A
CB2 CONT-B
CB2 CONT-C
DS N/O CONT
DS N/C CONT
CRT BLOCK
CB CLOSE
DC SUPPLY
85S1
85S2
IND.RESET
BUT BLOCK
EXT TRIP-A
EXT TRIP-B
EXT TRIP-C
EXT CBFIN-A
EXT CBFIN-B
EXT CBFIN-C
INT.LINK1-A
INT.LINK1-B
INT.LINK1-C
CB1 READY
CB2 READY
ARC RESET
ARC BLOCK
INT.LINK2-A
INT.LINK2-B
INT.LINK2-C
ARC BLOCK1
ARC BLOCK2
PROT BLOCK
DIF BLOCK
DIFG BLOCK
OST BLOCK
CBF BLOCK
OC BLOCK
OCI BLOCK
EF BLOCK
EFI BLOCK
THMA BLOCK
THM BLOCK
TR1 BLOCK
TR2 BLOCK
EXTTP BLOCK
RDIF BLOCK
ARC
ARC
ARC
ARC
ARC
ARC
ARC
ARC
ARC
CTF
DISABLE
SPAR
TPAR
S&T
MAPR2
MPAR3
EXT1P
EXT3P
EXTMP
BLOCK
243
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
1616
1617
1618
1619
1620
1621
1622
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628
1629
1630
1631
1632
1633
1634
1635
1636
1637
1638
1639
1640
1641
1642
1643
1644
1645
1646
1647
1648
1649
1650
1651
1652
1653
1654
1655
1656
1657
1658
1659
1660
1661
1662
1663
1664
1665
1666
1667
1668
1669
1670
1671
1672
1673
1674
1675
1676
1677
1678
1679
1680
1681
1682
1683
1684
1685
1686
1687
1688
1689
1690
1691
1692
1693
1694
1695
Signal Name
Contents
DIF-A FS
DIF-B FS
DIF-C_FS
DIFG FS
TP-A DELAY
TP-B DELAY
TP-C DELAY
R.DATA_ZERO
RDIF-A FS
RDIF-B FS
RDIF-C FS
INIT MODE2B
DIFG INST TP
OC_INST_TP
EF INST TP
DIF_3PTP
RDIF 3PTP
OC 3PTP
OCI 3PTP
TR1 3PTP
TR2 3PTP
3P_TRIP
DIF-A-R1
DIF-B-R1
DIF-C-R1
DIFG-R1
85R1-R1
85R2-R1
ARC BLOCK-R1
L.TEST-R1
TFC ON-R1
I.LINK-A-R1
I.LINK-B-R1
I.LINK-C-R1
RDIF-A-R1
RDIF-B-R1
RDIF-C-R1
RDIF-R1
TR1-A-R1
TR1-B-R1
TR1-C-R1
TR2-A-R1
TR2-B-R1
TR2-C-R1
244
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
1696
1697
1698
1699
1700
1701
1702
1703
1704
1705
1706
1707
1708
1709
1710
1711
1712
1713
1714
1715
1716
1717
1718
1719
1720
1721
1722
1723
1724
1725
1726
1727
1728
1729
1730
1731
1732
1733
1734
1735
1736
1737
1738
1739
1740
1741
1742
1743
1744
1745
1746
1747
1748
1749
1750
1751
1752
1753
1754
1755
1756
1757
1758
1759
1760
1761
1762
1763
1764
1765
1766
1767
1768
1769
1770
1771
1772
1773
1774
1775
Signal Name
Contents
DIF-A-R2
DIF-B-R2
DIF-C-R2
DIFG-R2
85R1-R2
85R2-R2
ARC_BLOCK-R2
L.TEST-R2
TFC ON-R2
I.LINK-A-R2
I.LINK-B-R2
I.LINK-C-R2
RDIF-A-R2
RDIF-B-R2
RDIF-C-R2
RDIF-R2
TR1-A-R2
TR1-B-R2
TR1-C-R2
TR2-A-R2
TR2-B-R2
TR2-C-R2
OC-A_FS
OC-B FS
OC-C FS
OCI-A_FS
OCI-B_FS
OCI-C_FS
245
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
1776
1777
1778
1779
1780
1781
1782
1783
1784
1785
1786
1787
1788
1789
1790
1791
1792
1793
1794
1795
1796
1797
1798
1799
1800
1801
1802
1803
1804
1805
1806
1807
1808
1809
1810
1811
1812
1813
1814
1815
1816
1817
1818
1819
1820
1821
1822
1823
1824
1825
1826
1827
1828
1829
1830
1831
1832
1833
1834
1835
1836
1837
1838
1839
1840
1841
1842
1843
1844
1845
1846
1847
1848
1849
1850
1851
1852
:
:
2015
Signal Name
Contents
IO#1-TP-A1
IO#1-TP-B1
IO#1-TP-C1
IO#1-TP-A2
IO#1-TP-B2
IO#1-TP-C2
SPR.L-REQ
TPR.L-REQ
MPR.L-REQ
SPR.F-REQ
TPR.F-REQ
MPR.F-REQ
SPR.F-ST.REQ
TPR.F-ST.REQ
MPR.F-ST.REQ
R.F-ST.REQ
SPR.F2-ST.REQ
TPR.F2-ST.REQ
MPR.F2-ST.REQ
ARC.L TERM
ARC.F TERM
246
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
2016
2017
2018
2019
2020
2021
2022
2023
2024
2025
2026
2027
2028
2029
2030
2031
2032
2033
2034
2035
2036
2037
2038
2039
2040
2041
2042
2043
2044
2045
2046
2047
2048
2049
2050
2051
2052
2053
2054
2055
2056
2057
2058
2059
2060
2061
2062
2063
2064
2065
2066
2067
2068
2069
2070
2071
2072
2073
2074
2075
2076
2077
2078
2079
2080
2081
2082
2083
2084
2085
2086
2087
2088
2089
2090
2091
2092
2093
2094
2095
Signal Name
Contents
COM1-S
COM2-S
COM3-S
COM4-S
COM5-S
SUB
SUB
SUB
SUB
SUB
COM1-S
COM2-S
COM3-S
COM4-S
COM5-S
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
SUB2
COM1-S
COM2-S
COM3-S
COM4-S
COM5-S
COM6-S
COM7-S
COM8-S
COM9-S
COM10-S
COM11-S
COM12-S
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
SUB3
COM1-S
COM2-S
COM3-S
COM4-S
COM5-S
COM6-S
COM7-S
COM8-S
COM9-S
COM10-S
COM11-S
COM12-S
247
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
2096
2097
2098
2099
2100
2101
2102
2103
2104
2105
2106
2107
2108
2109
2110
2111
2112
2113
2114
2115
2116
2117
2118
2119
2120
2121
2122
2123
2124
2125
2126
2127
2128
2129
2130
2131
2132
2133
2134
2135
2136
2137
2138
2139
2140
2141
2142
2143
2144
2145
2146
2147
2148
2149
2150
2151
2152
2153
2154
2155
2156
2157
2158
2159
2160
2161
2162
2163
2164
2165
2166
2167
2168
2169
2170
2171
2172
:
:
2575
Signal Name
Contents
V.COM1-S
V.COM2-S
V.COM3-S
S.V.COM1-S
S.V.COM2-S
S.V.COM3-S
S.V.COM4-S
S.V.COM5-S
S.V.COM6-S
S.V.COM7-S
S.V.COM8-S
S.V.COM9-S
S.V.COM10-S
S.V.COM11-S
S.V.COM12-S
I.COM1-S
I.COM2-S
I.COM3-S
S.I.COM1-S
S.I.COM2-S
S.I.COM3-S
S.I.COM4-S
S.I.COM5-S
S.I.COM6-S
S.I.COM7-S
S.I.COM8-S
S.I.COM9-S
S.I.COM10-S
S.I.COM11-S
S.I.COM12-S
248
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
2576
2577
2578
2579
2580
2581
2582
2583
2584
2585
2586
2587
2588
2589
2590
2591
2592
2593
2594
2595
2596
2597
2598
2599
2600
2601
2602
2603
2604
2605
2606
2607
2608
2609
2610
2611
2612
2613
2614
2615
2616
2617
2618
2619
2620
2621
2622
2623
2624
2625
2626
2627
2628
2629
2630
2631
2632
2633
2634
2635
2636
2637
2638
2639
2640
2641
2642
2643
2644
2645
2646
2647
2648
2649
2650
2651
2652
2653
2654
2655
Signal Name
Contents
ALARM_LED_SET
F.RECORD1
F.RECORD2
F.RECORD3
F.RECORD4
D.RECORD1
D.RECORD2
D.RECORD3
D.RECORD4
SET.GROUP1
SET.GROUP2
SET.GROUP3
SET.GROUP4
SET.GROUP5
SET.GROUP6
SET.GROUP7
SET.GROUP8
249
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
2656
2657
2658
2659
2660
2661
2662
2663
2664
2665
2666
2667
2668
2669
2670
2671
2672
2673
2674
2675
2676
2677
2678
2679
2680
2681
2682
2683
2684
2685
2686
2687
2688
2689
2690
2691
2692
2693
2694
2695
2696
2697
2698
2699
2700
2701
2702
2703
2704
2705
2706
2707
2708
2709
2710
2711
2712
2713
2714
2715
2716
2717
2718
2719
2720
2721
2722
2723
2724
2725
2726
2727
2728
2729
2730
2731
2732
:
:
2815
Signal Name
Contents
CON_TPMD1
CON_TPMD2
CON_TPMD3
CON_TPMD4
CON_TPMD5
CON_TPMD6
CON_TPMD7
CON_TPMD8
ARC_COM_RECV
TEL_COM_RECV
PROT_COM_RECV
TPLED_RST_RCV
250
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
2816
2817
2818
2819
2820
2821
2822
2823
2824
2825
2826
2827
2828
2829
2830
2831
2832
2833
2834
2835
2836
2837
2838
2839
2840
2841
2842
2843
2844
2845
2846
2847
2848
2849
2850
2851
2852
2853
2854
2855
2856
2857
2858
2859
2860
2861
2862
2863
2864
2865
2866
2867
2868
2869
2870
2871
2872
2873
2874
2875
2876
2877
2878
2879
2880
2881
2882
2883
2884
2885
2886
2887
2888
2889
2890
2891
2892
2893
2894
2895
Signal Name
Contents
TEMP001
TEMP002
TEMP003
TEMP004
TEMP005
TEMP006
TEMP007
TEMP008
TEMP009
TEMP010
TEMP011
TEMP012
TEMP013
TEMP014
TEMP015
TEMP016
TEMP017
TEMP018
TEMP019
TEMP020
TEMP021
TEMP022
TEMP023
TEMP024
TEMP025
TEMP026
TEMP027
TEMP028
TEMP029
TEMP030
TEMP031
TEMP032
TEMP033
TEMP034
TEMP035
TEMP036
TEMP037
TEMP038
TEMP039
TEMP040
TEMP041
TEMP042
TEMP043
TEMP044
TEMP045
TEMP046
TEMP047
TEMP048
TEMP049
TEMP050
TEMP051
TEMP052
TEMP053
TEMP054
TEMP055
TEMP056
TEMP057
TEMP058
TEMP059
TEMP060
TEMP061
TEMP062
TEMP063
TEMP064
TEMP065
TEMP066
TEMP067
TEMP068
TEMP069
TEMP070
TEMP071
TEMP072
TEMP073
TEMP074
TEMP075
TEMP076
TEMP077
TEMP078
TEMP079
TEMP080
251
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
2896
2897
2898
2899
2900
2901
2902
2903
2904
2905
2906
2907
2908
2909
2910
2911
2912
2913
2914
2915
2916
2917
2918
2919
2920
2921
2922
2923
2924
2925
2926
2927
2928
2929
2930
2931
2932
2933
2934
2935
2936
2937
2938
2939
2940
2941
2942
2943
2944
2945
2946
2947
2948
2949
2950
2951
2952
2953
2954
2955
2956
2957
2958
2959
2960
2961
2962
2963
2964
2965
2966
2967
2968
2969
2970
2971
2972
2973
2974
2975
Signal Name
Contents
TEMP081
TEMP082
TEMP083
TEMP084
TEMP085
TEMP086
TEMP087
TEMP088
TEMP089
TEMP090
TEMP091
TEMP092
TEMP093
TEMP094
TEMP095
TEMP096
TEMP097
TEMP098
TEMP099
TEMP100
TEMP101
TEMP102
TEMP103
TEMP104
TEMP105
TEMP106
TEMP107
TEMP108
TEMP109
TEMP110
TEMP111
TEMP112
TEMP113
TEMP114
TEMP115
TEMP116
TEMP117
TEMP118
TEMP119
TEMP120
TEMP121
TEMP122
TEMP123
TEMP124
TEMP125
TEMP126
TEMP127
TEMP128
TEMP129
TEMP130
TEMP131
TEMP132
TEMP133
TEMP134
TEMP135
TEMP136
TEMP137
TEMP138
TEMP139
TEMP140
TEMP141
TEMP142
TEMP143
TEMP144
TEMP145
TEMP146
TEMP147
TEMP148
TEMP149
TEMP150
TEMP151
TEMP152
TEMP153
TEMP154
TEMP155
TEMP156
TEMP157
TEMP158
TEMP159
TEMP160
252
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
2976
2977
2978
2979
2980
2981
2982
2983
2984
2985
2986
2987
2988
2989
2990
2991
2992
2993
2994
2995
2996
2997
2998
2999
3000
3001
3002
3003
3004
3005
3006
3007
3008
3009
3010
3011
3012
3013
3014
3015
3016
3017
3018
3019
3020
3021
3022
3023
3024
3025
3026
3027
3028
3029
3030
3031
3032
3033
3034
3035
3036
3037
3038
3039
3040
3041
3042
3043
3044
3045
3046
3047
3048
3049
3050
3051
3052
3053
3054
3055
Signal Name
Contents
TEMP161
TEMP162
TEMP163
TEMP164
TEMP165
TEMP166
TEMP167
TEMP168
TEMP169
TEMP170
TEMP171
TEMP172
TEMP173
TEMP174
TEMP175
TEMP176
TEMP177
TEMP178
TEMP179
TEMP180
TEMP181
TEMP182
TEMP183
TEMP184
TEMP185
TEMP186
TEMP187
TEMP188
TEMP189
TEMP190
TEMP191
TEMP192
TEMP193
TEMP194
TEMP195
TEMP196
TEMP197
TEMP198
TEMP199
TEMP200
TEMP201
TEMP202
TEMP203
TEMP204
TEMP205
TEMP206
TEMP207
TEMP208
TEMP209
TEMP210
TEMP211
TEMP212
TEMP213
TEMP214
TEMP215
TEMP216
TEMP217
TEMP218
TEMP219
TEMP220
TEMP221
TEMP222
TEMP223
TEMP224
TEMP225
TEMP226
TEMP227
TEMP228
TEMP229
TEMP230
TEMP231
TEMP232
TEMP233
TEMP234
TEMP235
TEMP236
TEMP237
TEMP238
TEMP239
TEMP240
253
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal list
No.
3056
3057
3058
3059
3060
3061
3062
3063
3064
3065
3066
3067
3068
3069
3070
3071
Signal Name
Contents
TEMP241
TEMP242
TEMP243
TEMP244
TEMP245
TEMP246
TEMP247
TEMP248
TEMP249
TEMP250
TEMP251
TEMP252
TEMP253
TEMP254
TEMP255
TEMP256
254
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Appendix C
Variable Timer List
255
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Variable Timer List
Timer
Timer No.
Contents
TDIFG
TBF1A
TBF1B
TBF1C
TBF2A
TBF2B
TBF2C
TOC
TEF
TIDSV
TEVLV
TRDY1
TSPR1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
16
17
18
TTPR1
19
TW1
20
TRR1
TRDY2
TSPR2
21
22
23
TTPR2
24
TW2
25
TRR2
TS2
TS3
TS4
TS2R
TS3R
TS4R
TSYN1
TSYN2
TDBL1
TDBL2
TLBD1
TLBD2
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
256
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Appendix D
Binary Output Default Setting List
257
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Binary Output Default Setting List (1)
Relay Model Module
Name
GRL100
-101
GRL100
-111
IO#2
IO#2
BO No.
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
(FAIL)
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
(FAIL)
Terminal No.
TB3:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A13-B13
A12-B12
TB3:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A13-B13
A12-B12
Signal Name
Contents
Setting
Signal No.
LOGIC
(OR:1, AND:2)
TIMER
(OFF:0, ON:1)
RELAY FAILURE
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A, B or C phase
Communication failure
Transfer trip 1 receive
Transfer trip 2 receive
--
99
100
101
99
100
101
99
100
101
99, 100, 101
225
197
198
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
--
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1,-B1,-C1
COMM1, 2_FAIL
85R1.REM1, REM2
85R2.REM1, REM2
RELAY FAILURE
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A, B or C phase
Communication failure
Transfer trip 1 receive
Transfer trip 2 receive
--
99
100
101
99
100
101
99
100
101
99, 100, 101
225, 226
197, 202
198, 203
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
--
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1,-B1,-C1C
OMM1_FAIL
85R1.REM1
85R2.REM1
258
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Binary Output Default Setting List (2)
Relay Model Module
Name
GRL100
-102
GRL100
-112
BO No.
IO#2
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
(FAIL)
IO#3
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
IO#2
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
(FAIL)
IO#3
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
Terminal No.
TB3:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A13-B13
A12-B12
TB2:
A1-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
TB3:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A13-B13
A12-B12
TB2:
A1-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
Signal Name
Contents
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1,-B1,-C1
COMM1_FAIL
85R1.REM1
85R2.REM2
RELAY FAILURE
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A, B or C phase
Communication failure
Transfer trip 1 receive
Transfer trip 2 receive
--
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
DIF-A,-B,-C TRIP
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
DIF relay operating
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1,-B1,-C1
COMM1, 2_FAIL
85R1.REM1, REM2
85R1.REM1, REM2
RELAY FAILURE
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A, B or C phase
Communication failure
Transfer trip 1 receive
Transfer trip 2 receive
--
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
DIF-A,-B,-C_TRIP
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
DIF relay operating
259
Setting
Signal No.
LOGIC
(OR:1, AND:2)
TIMER
(OFF:0, ON:1)
99
100
101
99
100
101
99
100
101
99, 100, 101
225
197
198
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
--
99
100
101
99
100
101
99
100
101
82, 83, 84
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
99
100
101
99
100
101
99
100
101
99, 100, 101
226, 226
197, 202
198, 203
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
--
99
100
101
99
100
101
99
100
101
82, 83, 84
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Binary Output Default Setting List (3)
Relay Model Module
Name
GRL100
-201
GRL100
-202
BO No.
IO#2
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
(FAIL)
IO#3
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
IO#2
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
(FAIL)
IO#4
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
BO14
IO#3
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
Terminal No.
TB3:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A13-B13
A12-B12
TB2:
A1-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
TB2:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A13-B13
A12-B12
TB3:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A12-B12
A13-B13
TB5:
A1-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
Signal Name
Contents
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
ARC1
COMM1. FAIL
85R1.REM1
85R2.REM1
RELAY FAILURE
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Autoreclose
Communication failure
Transfer trip 1 receive
Transfer trip 2 receive
--
89CB-1AB
89CB-2AB
89CB-3AB
DIF/DIFG
OST
CBF
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
ARC1
COMM1_FAIL
85R1.REM1
85R2.REM1
RELAY FAILURE
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Autoreclose
Communication failure
Transfer trip 1 receive
Transfer trip 2 receive
--
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1,-B1,-C1
TRIP-A1,-B1,-C1
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A, B or C phase
Trip A, B or C phase
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
DIF-A, -B, -C_TRIP
DIFG_TRIP
OST_TRIP
CBFDET
SPAR1
TPAR1
MPAR
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
DIF relay operating
DIFG relay operating
OST trip
CBF detection
Single pole autoreclose
Three pole autoreclose
Multi-pole autoreclose
260
Setting
Signal No.
LOGIC
(OR:1, AND:2)
TIMER
(OFF:0, ON:1)
99
100
101
99
100
101
99
100
101
177
225
197
198
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
--
146
147
148
82, 83, 84, 86
87
91
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
99
100
101
99
100
101
99
100
101
177
225
197
198
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
--
146
147
148
99
100
101
99
100
101
99
100
101
99, 100, 101
99, 100, 101
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
99
100
101
82, 83, 84
86
87
91
173
175
183
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Binary Output Default Setting List (4)
Relay Model Module
Name
GRL100
-204
GRL100
-206
BO No.
Terminal No.
Signal Name
Contents
IO#2
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
(FAIL)
TB3:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A13-B13
A12-B12
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
ARC1
COMM1_FAIL
85R1.REM1
85R2.REM1
RELAY FAILURE
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Autoreclose
Communication failure
Transfer trip 1 receive
Transfer trip 2 receive
--
IO#3
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
TB2:
A1-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
DIF- /DIFG_TRIP
OST_TRIP
CBFDET
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
DIF, DIFG relay operating
OST trip
CBF detection
IO#2
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
(FAIL)
TB2:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A13-B13
A12-B12
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
ARC1
COMM1_FAIL
85R1.REM1
85R2.REM1
RELAY FAILURE
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Autoreclose
Communication failure
Transfer trip 1 receive
Transfer trip 2 receive
--
IO#4
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
BO14
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1, -B1, -C1
TRIP-A1, -B1, -C1
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A, B or C phase
Trip A, B or C phase
IO#3
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
DIF-A, -B, -C_TRIP
DIFG_TRIP
OST_TRIP
CBFDET
SPAR1
TPAR1
MPAR
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
DIF relay operating
DIFG relay operating
OST trip
CBF detection
Single pole autoreclose
Three pole autoreclose
Multi-pole autoreclose
TB3:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A12-B12
A13-B13
TB5:
A1-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
261
Setting
Signal No.
LOGIC
(OR:1, AND:2)
TIMER
(OFF:0, ON:1)
99
100
101
99
100
101
99
100
101
177
225
197
198
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
--
99
100
101
82, 83, 84, 86
87
91
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
99
100
101
99
100
101
99
100
101
177
225
197
198
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
--
99
100
101
99
100
101
99
100
101
99
100
101
99, 100, 101
99, 100, 101
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
99
100
101
82, 83, 84
86
87
91
173
175
183
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Binary Output Default Setting List (5)
Relay Model Module
Name
GRL100
-211
GRL100
-212
BO No.
Terminal No.
Signal Name
Contents
IO#2
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
(FAIL)
TB3:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A13-B13
A12-B12
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
ARC1
COMM1_FAIL
85R1.REM1
85R2.REM1
RELAY FAILURE
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Autoreclose
Communication failure
Transfer trip 1 receive
Transfer trip 2 receive
--
IO#3
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
TB2:
A1-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
89CB-1AB
89CB-2AB
89CB-3AB
DIF- /DIFG_TRIP
OST_TRIP
CBFDET
IO#2
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
(FAIL)
TB2:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A13-B13
A12-B12
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
ARC1
COMM1_FAIL
85R1.REM1
85R2.REM1
RELAY FAILURE
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Autoreclose
Communication failure
Transfer trip 1 receive
Transfer trip 2 receive
--
IO#4
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
BO14
LINK-A1
LINK-B1
LINK-C1
LINK-A2
LINK-B2
LINK-C2
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1, -B1, -C1
TRIP-A1, -B1, -C1
IO#3
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
DIF-A, -B, -C_TRIP
DIFG_TRIP
OST_TRIP
CBFDET
SPAR1
TPAR1
MPAR
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
DIF relay operating
DIFG relay operating
OST trip
CBF detection
Single pole autoreclose
Three pole autoreclose
Multi-pole autoreclose
TB3:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A12-B12
A13-B13
TB5:
A1-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
262
Setting
Signal No.
LOGIC
(OR:1, AND:2)
TIMER
(OFF:0, ON:1)
99
100
101
99
100
101
99
100
101
177
225, 226
197, 202
198, 203
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
--
146
147
148
82, 83, 84, 86
87
91
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
99
100
101
99
100
101
99
100
101
177
225, 226
197, 202
198, 203
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
--
146
147
148
149
150
151
99
100
101
99
100
101
99, 100, 101
99, 100, 101
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
99
100
101
82, 83, 84
86
87
91
173
175
183
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Binary Output Default Setting List (6)
Relay Model Module
Name
GRL100
-214
GRL100
-216
BO No.
Terminal No.
Signal Name
Contents
IO#2
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
(FAIL)
TB3:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A13-B13
A12-B12
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
ARC1
COMM1_FAIL
85R1.REM1
85R2.REM1
RELAY FAILURE
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Autoreclose
Communication failure
Transfer trip 1 receive
Transfer trip 2 receive
--
IO#3
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
TB2:
A1-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
DIF- /DIFG_TRIP
OST_TRIP
CBFDET
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
DIF, DIFG relay operating
OST trip
CBF detection
IO#2
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
(FAIL)
TB2:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A13-B13
A12-B12
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
ARC1
COMM1_FAIL
85R1.REM1
85R2.REM1
RELAY FAILURE
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Autoreclose
Communication failure
Transfer trip 1 receive
Transfer trip 2 receive
--
IO#4
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
BO14
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1, -B1, -C1
TRIP-A1, -B1, -C1
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A, B or C phase
Trip A, B or C phase
IO#3
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
DIF-A, -B, -C_TRIP
DIFG_TRIP
OST_TRIP
CBFDET
SPAR1
TPAR1
MPAR
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
DIF relay operating
DIFG relay operating
OST trip
CBF detection
Single pole autoreclose
Three pole autoreclose
Multi-pole autoreclose
TB3:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A12-B12
A13-B13
TB5:
A1-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
263
Setting
Signal No.
LOGIC
(OR:1, AND:2)
TIMER
(OFF:0, ON:1)
99
100
101
99
100
101
99
100
101
177
225, 226
197, 202
198, 203
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
--
99
100
101
82, 83, 84, 86
87
91
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
99
100
101
99
100
101
99
100
101
177
225, 226
197, 202
198, 203
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
--
99
100
101
99
100
101
99
100
101
99
100
101
99, 100, 101
99, 100, 101
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
99
100
101
82, 83, 84
86
87
91
173
175
183
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Binary Output Default Setting List (7)
Relay Model Module
Name
GRL100
-301
GRL100
-302
BO No.
Terminal No.
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
TB3:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A13-B13
(FAIL)
IO#3
IO#2
IO#2
Signal Name
Contents
Setting
Signal No.
LOGIC
(OR:1, AND:2)
TIMER
(OFF:0, ON:1)
99, 102
100, 103
101, 104
99, 102
100, 103
101, 104
99, 100, 101, 102, 103, 104
99, 100, 101, 102, 103, 104
177
178
225
197
198
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
--
--
--
146
147
148
82, 83, 84, 86
87
91
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
99, 102
100, 103
101, 104
99, 102
100, 103
101, 104
99, 100, 101, 102, 103, 104
99, 100, 101, 102, 103, 104
177
178
225
197
198
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
--
--
--
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A, B or C phase
Trip A, B or C phase
Bus CB autoreclose
Center CB autoreclose
Communication failure
Transfer trip 1 receive
Transfer trip 2 receive
A12-B12
TRIP-A1/A2
TRIP-B1/B2
TRIP-C1/C2
TRIP-A1/A2
TRIP-B1/B2
TRIP-C1/C2
TRIP-A,B,C
TRIP-A,B,C
ARC1
ARC2
COMM1_FAIL
85R1.REM1
85R2.REM1
RELAY FAILURE
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
TB2:
A1-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
89CB-1AB
89CB-2AB
89CB-3AB
DIF- /DIFG_TRIP
OST_TRIP
CBFDET
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
TB2:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A13-B13
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A, B or C phase
Trip A, B or C phase
Bus CB autoreclose
Center CB autoreclose
Communication failure
Transfer trip 1 receive
Transfer trip 2 receive
(FAIL)
A12-B12
TRIP-A1/A2
TRIP-B1/B2
TRIP-C1/C2
TRIP-A1/A2
TRIP-B1/B2
TRIP-C1/C2
TRIP-A,B,C
TRIP-A,B,C
ARC1
ARC2
COMM1_FAIL
85R1.REM1
85R2.REM1
RELAY FAILURE
89CB-1AB
89CB-2AB
89CB-3AB
TRIP-A1/A2
TRIP-B1/B2
TRIP-C1/C2
TRIP-A1/A2
TRIP-B1/B2
TRIP-C1/C2
TRIP-A1/A2
TRIP-B1/B2
TRIP-C1/C2
TRIP-A1/A2
TRIP-B1/B2
146
147
148
99, 102
100, 103
101, 104
99, 102
100, 103
101, 104
99, 102
100, 103
101, 104
99, 102
100, 103
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
TRIP-C1/C2
DIF-A, -B, -C_TRIP
DIFG_TRIP
OST_TRIP
CBFDET
SPAR1
TPAR1
MPAR
SPAR2
TPAR2
Trip C phase
DIF relay operating
DIFG relay operating
OST trip
CBF detection
Bus CB single pole ARC
Bus CB three pole ARC
Bus multi-pole ARC
Center CB single pole ARC
Center CB three pole ARC
101, 104
82, 83, 84
86
87
91
173
175
183
174
176
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
IO#4
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
BO14
IO#3
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
TB3:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A12-B12
A13-B13
TB5:
A1-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
--
--
264
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Binary Output Default Setting List (8)
Relay Model Module
Name
GRL100
-311
GRL100
-312
BO No.
Terminal No.
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
TB3:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A13-B13
(FAIL)
IO#3
IO#2
IO#2
Signal Name
Contents
Setting
Signal No.
LOGIC
(OR:1, AND:2)
TIMER
(OFF:0, ON:1)
99, 102
100, 103
101, 104
99, 102
100, 103
101, 104
99, 100, 101, 102, 103, 104
99, 100, 101, 102, 103, 104
177
178
225
197
198
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
--
--
--
146
147
148
82, 83, 84, 86
87
91
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
99, 102
100, 103
101, 104
99, 102
100, 103
101, 104
99, 100, 101, 102, 103, 104
99, 100, 101, 102, 103, 104
177
178
225, 226
197, 202
198, 203
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
--
--
--
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A, B or C phase
Trip A, B or C phase
Bus CB autoreclose
Center CB autoreclose
Communication failure
Transfer trip 1 receive
Transfer trip 2 receive
A12-B12
TRIP-A1/A2
TRIP-B1/B2
TRIP-C1/C2
TRIP-A1/A2
TRIP-B1/B2
TRIP-C1/C2
TRIP-A,B,C
TRIP-A,B,C
ARC1
ARC2
COMM1_FAIL
85R1.REM1
85R2.REM1
RELAY FAILURE
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
TB2:
A1-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
89CB-1AB
89CB-2AB
89CB-3AB
DIF- /DIFG_TRIP
OST_TRIP
CBFDET
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
TB2:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A13-B13
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A, B or C phase
Trip A, B or C phase
Bus CB autoreclose
Center CB autoreclose
Communication failure
Transfer trip 1 receive
Transfer trip 2 receive
(FAIL)
A12-B12
TRIP-A1/A2
TRIP-B1/B2
TRIP-C1/C2
TRIP-A1/A2
TRIP-B1/B2
TRIP-C1/C2
TRIP-A,B,C
TRIP-A,B,C
ARC1
ARC2
COMM1_FAIL
85R1.REM1
85R2.REM1
RELAY FAILURE
89CB-1AB
89CB-2AB
89CB-3AB
TRIP-A1/A2
TRIP-B1/B2
TRIP-C1/C2
TRIP-A1/A2
TRIP-B1/B2
TRIP-C1/C2
TRIP-A1/A2
TRIP-B1/B2
TRIP-C1/C2
TRIP-A1/A2
TRIP-B1/B2
146
147
148
149
150
151
99, 102
100, 103
101, 104
99, 102
100, 103
101, 104
99, 102
100, 103
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
TRIP-C1/C2
DIF-A, -B, -C_TRIP
DIFG_TRIP
OST_TRIP
CBFDET
SPAR1
TPAR1
MPAR
SPAR2
TPAR2
Trip C phase
DIF relay operating
DIFG relay operating
OST trip
CBF detection
Bus CB single pole ARC
Bus CB three pole ARC
Bus multi-pole ARC
Center CB single pole ARC
Center CB three pole ARC
101, 104
82, 83, 84
86
87
91
173
175
183
174
176
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
IO#4
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
BO14
IO#3
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
TB3:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A12-B12
A13-B13
TB5:
A1-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
--
--
265
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Binary Output Default Setting List (9)
Relay Model Module
BO No.
Terminal No.
Signal Name
Contents
Name
GRL100
-401
GRL100
-411
IO#2
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
(FAIL)
IO#3
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
IO#4
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
IO#2
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
(FAIL)
IO#3
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
IO#4
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
TB2:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A13-B13
A12-B12
TB5:
A1-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
TB3:
A1-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A10-B10
A11-B11
A12-B12
A13-B13
TB2:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A13-B13
A12-B12
TB5:
A1-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
TB3:
A1-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A10-B10
A11-B11
A12-B12
A13-B13
Setting
Signal No.
LOGIC
(OR:1, AND:2)
TIMER
(OFF:0, ON:1)
99
100
101
99
100
101
99
100
101
177
225
197
198
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
--
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
ARC1
COMM1_FAIL
85R1.REM1
85R2.REM1
RELAY FAILURE
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Autoreclose
Communication failure
Transfer trip 1 receive
Transfer trip 2 receive
--
89CB-1AB
89CB-2AB
89CB-3AB
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1, -B1, -C1
146
147
148
99
100
101
99
100
101
99, 100, 101
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Trip A, B or C phase
DIF relay operating
DIFG relay operating
OST trip
CBF detection
Single pole ARC
Three pole ARC
Multi-pole ARC
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
ARC1
COMM1_FAIL
85R1.REM1
85R2.REM1
RELAY FAILURE
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Autoreclose
Communication failure
Transfer trip 1 receive
Transfer trip 2 receive
--
99
100
101
99
100
101
99
100
101
177
225, 226
197, 202
198, 203
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
--
89CB-1AB
89CB-2AB
89CB-3AB
89CB-1AC
89CB-2AC
89CB-3AC
TRIP-A1
TRIP-B1
TRIP-C1
TRIP-A1, -B1, -C1
146
147
148
149
150
151
99
100
101
99, 100, 101
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Trip A, B or C phase
DIF relay operating
DIFG relay operating
OST trip
CBF detection
Single pole ARC
Three pole ARC
Multi-pole ARC
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
266
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Binary Output Default Setting List (10)
Relay Model Module
BO No.
Terminal No.
Signal Name
Contents
Name
GRL100
-501
IO#2
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
(FAIL)
IO#3
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
IO#4
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
IO#2
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
(FAIL)
IO#3
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
IO#4
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
GRL100
-503
GRL100
-511
GRL100
-513
TB2:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A13-B13
A12-B12
TB5:
A1-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
TB3:
A1-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A10-B10
A11-B11
A12-B12
A13-B13
TB2:
A2-A1
A2-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
A11-B11
A13-B13
A12-B12
TB5:
A1-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A5-B5
A6-B6
A7-B7
A8-B8
A9-B9
A10-B10
TB3:
A1-B1
A2-B2
A3-B3
A4-B4
A10-B10
A11-B11
A12-B12
A13-B13
Setting
Signal No.
LOGIC
(OR:1, AND:2)
TIMER
(OFF:0, ON:1)
99, 102
100, 103
101, 104
99, 102
100, 103
101, 104
99, 100, 101, 102, 103, 104
99, 100, 101, 102, 103, 104
177
178
225
197
198
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
--
TRIP-A1/A2
TRIP-B1/B2
TRIP-C1/C2
TRIP-A1/A2
TRIP-B1/B2
TRIP-C1/C2
TRIP-A,B,C
TRIP-A,B,C
ARC1
ARC2
COMM1_FAIL
85R1.REM1
85R2.REM1
RELAY FAILURE
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A, B or C phase
Trip A, B or C phase
Bus CB autoreclose
Center CB autoreclose
Communication failure
Transfer trip 1 receive
Transfer trip 2 receive
--
89CB-1AB
89CB-2AB
89CB-3AB
TRIP-A1/A2
TRIP-B1/B2
TRIP-C1/C2
TRIP-A1/A2
TRIP-B1/B2
TRIP-C1/C2
DIF-A, -B, -C_TRIP
146
147
148
99, 102
100, 103
101, 104
99, 102
100, 103
101, 104
82, 83, 84
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
DIFG_TRIP
OST_TRIP
CBFDET
SPAR1
TPAR1
MPAR
SPAR2
TPAR2
86
87
91
173
175
183
174
176
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
TRIP-A1/A2
TRIP-B1/B2
TRIP-C1/C2
TRIP-A1/A2
TRIP-B1/B2
TRIP-C1/C2
TRIP-A,B,C
TRIP-A,B,C
ARC1
ARC2
COMM1_FAIL
85R1.REM1
85R2.REM1
RELAY FAILURE
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A phase
Trip B phase
Trip C phase
Trip A, B or C phase
Trip A, B or C phase
Bus CB autoreclose
Center CB autoreclose
Communication failure
Transfer trip 1 receive
Transfer trip 2 receive
--
99, 102
100, 103
101, 104
99, 102
100, 103
101, 104
99, 100, 101, 102, 103, 104
99, 100, 101, 102, 103, 104
177
178
225, 226
197, 202
198, 203
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
--
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
--
89CB-1AB
89CB-2AB
89CB-3AB
89CB-1AC
89CB-2AC
89CB-3AC
TRIP-A1/A2
TRIP-B1/B2
TRIP-C1/C2
DIF-A, -B, -C_TRIP
146
147
148
149
150
151
99, 102
100, 103
101, 104
82, 83, 84
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
DIFG_TRIP
OST_TRIP
CBFDET
SPAR1
TPAR1
MPAR
SPAR2
TPAR2
86
87
91
173
175
183
174
176
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
267
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
268
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Appendix E
Details of Relay Menu
269
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
MENU
1=Record
3=Setting(view)
5=Test
2=Status
4=Setting(change)
/1 Record
1=Fault record
2=Event record
3=Disturbance record 4=Autoreclose count
/2 Fault record
1=Display
2=Clear
/3
#1
#2
#3
Fault record
16/Oct/1998 23:18:03.913
12/Feb/1998 03:51:37.622
30/Jan/1997 15:06:11.835
2/8
/4 Fault record #2
16/Oct/1998 23:18:03.913
Phase BC
Trip ABC
DIF
/2 Fault record
Clear all fault records ?
ENTER=Yes CANCEL=No
/2 Event record
1=Display
2=Clear
/3 Event record
2/48
16/Oct/1998 23:18:04.294 Trip
Off
16/Oct/1998 23:18:03.913 Trip
On
12/Feb/1998 03:51:37.622 Rly.set change
/2 Event record
Clear all event records ?
ENTER=Yes CANCEL=No
/2 Disturbance record
1=Display
2=Clear
/3
#1
#2
#3
Disturbance record
16/Oct/1998 23:18:03.913
12/Feb/1998 03:51:37.622
30/Jan/1997 15:06:11.835
1/ 11
/2 Disturbance record
Clear all disturbance records ?
ENTER=Yes CANCEL=No
/2 Autoreclose count
1=Display
2=Reset
/3 Autoreclose count
SPAR
TPAR
CB1
[ 46] [ 46]
CB2
[ 46] [ 46]
MPAR
[ 12]
a-1
270
3/33
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
a-1
/1 Status
1=Metering
2=Binary I/O
3=Relay element
4=Time sync source
5=Clock adjustment 6=Terminal condition
/2
Va
Vb
Vc
3/13
***.*
***.*
***.*
/1 Setting(view)
1=Version 2=Description 3=Comm
4=Record 5=Status
6=Protection
7=Binary input 8=Binary output 9=LED
/2 Relay version
Relay type :
********************
Serial No. :
********************
Main software: ********************
/2 Description
Plant name:
********************
Description:
********************
/2 Communication
1=Address/Parameter
2=Switch
/2 Relay element
DIF, DIFG
[000 0
OST
[000 00 0
CBF
[000
3/ 6
]
]
]
3/ 4
/2 Terminal condition
Terminal 1: In service
Terminal 2: Out of service
/3 Address/Parameter
HDLC ( 1 )
IEC
( 1
SYADJ ( 0 ms)
IP1-1 ( 10
IP1-2 ( 245 )
IP1-3 ( 105
2/ 8
)
)
)
/3 Switch
3/ 4
PRTCL1 1=HDLC 2=IEC103
2
232C
1=9.6 2=19.2 3=38.4 4=57.6 4
IECBR 1=9.6 2=19.2
2
/2 Record
1=Fault record
2=Event record
3=Disturbance record
4=Automatic test interval
/3 Fault record
Fault locator
0=Off
1=On
1/ 1
1
/4 Signal no.
BITRN ( 128 )
EV2 (
0 )
EV4 (
2 )
/3 Event record
1=Signal no.
2=Event name
EV1
EV3
EV4
3/ 65
( 3071 )
(
1 )
(
4 )
/4 Event name
Event name1 [
Event name2 [
Event name3 [
/3 Disturbance record
1=Record time & starter
2=Scheme switch
3=Binary signal
4=Signal name
/4 Scheme switch
Trip
0=Off
OCP-S
0=Off
OCP-G
0=Off
1/ 1
/4 Binary signal
SIG1 ( 128 )
SIG3 (
0 )
SIG5 (
2 )
/4 Signal name
Signal name1 [
Signal name2 [
Signal name3 [
a-1
3/128
]
]
]
a-2
271
1=On
1=On
1=On
1/ 5
1
1
1
3/ 16
SIG2 ( 3071 )
SIG4 (
1 )
SIG6 (
4 )
3/32
]
]
]
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
a-1
a-2
/3 Metering
3/
Display value 1=Primary 2=Secondary
Power (P/Q) 1=Send
2=Receive
Current
1=Lag
2=Lead
/2 Status
1=Metering
2=Time Synchronization
3=Time zone
3
1
1
1
/3 Time synchronization
1/ 1
Sync 0=Off 1=IRIG 2=RSM 3=IEC 4=GPS 1
/3 Time zone
GMT (
+9 hrs )
/2 Protection
(Active group= *)
1=Group1 2=Group2 3=Group3 4=Group4
5=Group5 6=Group6 7=Group7 8=Group8
/3 Protection
1=Line parameter
2=Telecommunication
4=Autoreclose
1/ 1
(Group 1)
3=Trip
/4 Line parameter
1=Line name
2=VT & CT ratio
3=Fault locator
(Group 1)
/5 Line name
1/ 1
Line name
********************
/5 VT & CT ratio
VT ( 2000 )
VTs2 ( 2000 )
1/ 2
VTs1 ( 2000 )
CT ( 120 )
/5 Fault locator
1=Setting impedance mode
2=Line data
/4 Telecommunication
(Group 1)
1=Scheme switch
2=Telecommunication element
/4 Trip
1=Scheme switch
2=Protection element
(Group 1)
/5 Scheme switch
COMMODE 1=A
SP.SYN. 1=Master
TERM.
1=2TERM
2=B
2=Slave
2=3TERM
(Group 1)
2/ 12
2
1
3=Dual 1 _
3=GPS
/5 Telecommunicatio element
PDTD ( 200 - 2000) : 1000
RYID (
0 63) :
0
RYID1 (
0 63) :
0
1/ 7
us
/5 Scheme switch
TPMODE 1=3PH 2=1PH
STUB
0=Off 1=On
DIFG
0=Off 1=On
3/16
1
1
1
3=MPH
/6 Line data
1X1 (
24.5 )
1Line (
80.0km)
2R1 (
1.5 )
3/ 5
1R1 ( 2.8 )
2X1 ( 12.5 )
2Line ( 41.3km)
/5 Protection element
3/11
DIFI1 ( 1.00A ) DIFI2 ( 2.0A )
DIFG1 ( 0.50A ) DIFIC ( 1.00A )
Vn
( 110V ) TDIFG ( 0.10s )
/4 Autoreclose
1=Autoreclose mode
2=Scheme switch
3=Autoreclose element
(Group 1)
/5 Autoreclose mode
1=Disable 2=SPAR 3=TPAR 4=SPAR&TPAR
5=MPAR2 6=MPAR3 7=EXT1P 8=EXT3P 9=EXTMP
Current No.= 4
/5 Scheme switch
3/ 8
ARC-CB 1=00 2=01 3=02 4=L1 5=L2 1
ARC-EXT 0=Off 1=On
0
ARCDIFG 0=Off 1=On
1
/3 Protection
1=Line parameter
2=Telecommunication
4=Autoreclose
/3 Protection
1=Line parameter
2=Telecommunication
4=Autoreclose
a-1
(Group 2)
3=Trip
/5 Autoreclose element
1=Autoreclose timer
2=Synchrocheck
(Group 1)
/6 Autoreclose timer
3/
TEVLV( 0.30 s ) TRDY1( 60 s
TSPR ( 0.80 s ) TTPR1( 0.60 s
TRR ( 2.00 s ) TW1 ( 0.3 s
/6 Synchrocheck
OVB (
51 V )
OVL1 (
51 V )
SY1UV(
83 V )
(Group 8)
3=Trip
a-2
272
UVB (
UVL1 (
SY1OV(
8
)
)
)
3/
13 V
13 V
51 V
9
)
)
)
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
a-1
a-2
/2 Binary input
BISW 1 1=Norm 2=Inv
BISW 2 1=Norm 2=Inv
BISW 3 1=Norm 2=Inv
/2 Binary output
1=IO#2
2=IO#3
/2 LED
LED1 (
LED2 (
LED3 (
1, 309,
0,
0,
15, 16,
3/ 31
1
1
1
3=IO#4
/3 Binary
BO1 ( 1,
BO2 ( 1,
BO3 ( 1,
output
(IO#2)3/12
2, 3, 4, 5, 6) AND,D
2, 3, 4, 5, 6) OR,
2, 3, 4, 5, 6) OR,D
/3 Binary
BO1 ( 1,
BO2 ( 1,
BO3 ( 1,
output
(IO#4)3/12
2, 3, 4, 5, 6) AND,D
2, 3, 4, 5, 6) OR,
2, 3, 4, 5, 6) OR,D
3/ 4
0) AND, I
0) OR, I
0) OR, L
0,
0,
17,
: Password trap
Password
Input password [_ ]
/1 Setting(change)
1=Password 2=Description 3=Comm
4=Record 5=Status
6=Protection
7=Binary input 8=Binary output 9=LED
/2 Password
Input new password
Retype new password
: Confirmation trap
/2 *************
Change settings?
ENTER=Yes CANCEL=No
[ _ ]
[
]
/2 Description
1=Plant name 2=Description
/3 Plant name [ _
]
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ()[]@_
abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz{}*/+-<=>
0123456789!#$%&:;,.^
/3 Description [ _
]
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ()[]@_
abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz{}*/+-<=>
0123456789!#$%&:;,.^
/2 Communication
1=Address/Parameter
2=Switch
/3 Address/Parameter
HDLC ( 132) :
IEC ( 0- 254) :
SYADJ (-9999- 9999) :
1/ 15
1 _
2
0 ms
/3 Switch
1/ 4
PRTCL1 1=HDLC 2=IEC103
2 _
232C 1=9.6 2=19.2 3=38.4 4=57.6 4
IECBR 1=9.6 2=19.2
2
/2 Record
1=Fault record
2=Event record
3=Disturbance record
4=Automatic test interval
/3 Fault record
Fault locator
0=Off
/3 Event record
BITRN (
0- 128) :
EV1 (
0- 3071) :
EV2 (
0- 3071) :
1=On
1/ 1
1 _
1/129
128 _
0
1
/3 Disturbance record
1=Record time & starter
2=Scheme switch
3=Binary signal
a-1
1/ 1
days
/4 Scheme switch
Trip trigger
0=Off
OCP-S
0=Off
OCP-G
0=Off
/4 Binary
SIG1 (
SIG2 (
SIG3 (
a-2
273
signal
0- 3071) :
0- 3071) :
0- 3071) :
1=On
1=On
1=On
1/ 5
1 _
1
1
1/ 32
1 _
2
1
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
a-1
a-2
/2 Status
1=Metering
2=Time Synchronization
3=Time zone
/3 Metering
1/ 3
Display value 1=Primary 2=Secondary 1_
Power (P/Q) 1=Send
2=Receive 1
Current
1=Lag
2=Lead
1
/3 Time synchronization
1/ 1
Sync 0=Off 1=IRIG 2=RSM 3=IEC 4=GPS 1 _
/3 Time zone
GMT ( -12 -
+12):
+9 _
1/ 1
hrs
/2 Protection
1=Change active group
2=Change setting
3=Copy group
/4 Protection
1=Line parameter
2=Telecommunication
4=Autoreclose
(Group 1)
3=Trip
/5 Line parameter
1=Line name
2=VT & CT ratio
3=Fault locator
(Group 1)
/6 Line name [ _
]
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ()[]@_
abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz{}*/+-<=>
0123456789!#$%&:;,.^
/6 VT & CT ratio
VT (
1- 20000):
VTs1 (
1- 20000):
CT (
1- 20000):
/6 Fault locator
1=Setting impedance mode
2=Line data
/5 Telecommunication
1=Scheme switch
2=Telecommunication
/5 Trip
1=Scheme switch
2=Protection element
(Group 1)
(Group 1)
a-2
a-3
a-4
(Group 1)
/6 Scheme switch
COMMODE 1=A
2=B
3=GPS
SP.SYN. 1=Master 2=Slave
TERM. 1=2TERM 2=3TERM 3=Dual
1/ 12
2 _
1
1
/6 Telecommunication
PDTD ( 200- 2000):
RYID (
063):
RYID1 (
063):
1/ 7
us
/6 Scheme switch
TPMODE 1=3PH 2=1PH
STUB
0=Off 1=On
LSSV
0=Off 1=On
/6 Protection
DIFI1( 0.50
DIFI2( 3.0
DIFG1( 0.25
a-1
1/ 2
2000 _
2000
120
a-5
274
0 _
0
0
3=MPH
element
- 5.00): 1.00 _
- 120.0): 2.0
- 5.00): 0.50
1/16
1 _
1
1
1/17
A
A
A
/7 Setting impedance
1=Positive sequence impedance
2=Phase impedance
Current No.= 1
Select No.= _
/7 Line
1X1 (
1R1 (
1Line(
data
1/ 9
0.0 - 199.9): 24.5 _
0.0 - 199.9): 2.8
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
a-1
a-2
a-3
a-4
a-5
/5 Autoreclose
1=Autoreclose mode
2=Scheme switch
3=Autoreclose element
(Group 1)
/6 Autoreclose mode
1=Disable 2=SPAR 3=TPAR 4=SPAR&TPAR
5=MPAR2
6=MPAR3 7=EXT1P 8=EXT3P
Current No.= 4
Select No.= _
/6 Scheme switch
1/ 8
ARC-CB 1=00 2=01 3=03 4=L1 5=L2 1 _
ARC-EXT 0=Off 1=On
0
ARCDIFG 0=Off 1=On
1
/6 Autoreclose element
1=Autoreclose timer
2=Synchrocheck
/4 Protection
1=Line parameter
2=Telecommunication
4=Autoreclose
(Group 1)
(Group 2)
timer
10.00):
300):
10.00):
1/12
0.30 _ s
60
s
0.60
s
/7 Synchrocheck
OVB (
10 - 100):
UVB (
10 - 100):
OVL1 (
10 - 100):
3=Trip
/4 Protection
1=Line parameters
2=Telecommunication
4=Autoreclose
/7 Autoreclose
TEVLV( 0.01TRDY1(
5 TSPR ( 0.01-
(Group 8)
3=Trip
/2 Binary input
BISW 1 1=Norm 2=Inv
BISW 2 1=Norm 2=Inv
BISW 3 1=Norm 2=Inv
/2 Binary output
1=IO#2
2=IO#3
1/ 31
1 _
1
1
/3 Binary output
Select BO
( 1- 12)
3=IO#4
(IO#2 )
Select No.= _
/4 Setting
(BO 1 of IO#2 )
1=Logic gate type & delay timer
2=Input to logic gate
/4 Setting
(BO 12 of IO#2 )
1=Logic gate type & delay timer
2=Input to logic gate
/5
In
In
In
/4 Binary output
Select BO
Input to logic
#1 (
0 #2 (
0 #3 (
0 -
gate
3071):
3071):
3071):
3/ 6
21
67
12 _
(IO#4 )
( 1- 8)
Select No.=_
/2 LED
Select LED
( 1 -
4)
/3 Setting
1=Logic gate type & reset
2=Input to logic gate
(LED1)
/3 Setting
1=Logic gate type & reset
2=Input to logic gate
(LED4)
/4
In
In
In
Select No.=_
a-1
275
Input to logic
#1 (
0 #2 (
0 #3 (
0 -
gate
3071):
3071):
3071):
1/ 4
274 _
289
295
51 _
13
51
1/18
V
V
V
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
a-1
/1 Test
1=Switch
3=Timer
5=Sim. Fault
2=Binary output
4=Logic circuit
6=Init. 2B
/2 Switch
A.M.F. 0=Off
L.test 0=Off
Open1
0=Off
1/
1 _
0
0
1=On
1=On
1=On
/2 Binary output
1=IO#1 2=IO#2 3=IO#3 4=IO#4
Press number to start test
/3 BO
(0=Disable 1=Enable) 1/ 6
IO#1 TP-A1
1 _
IO#1 TP-B1
1
IO#1 TP-C1
1
/3 BO
IO#4 BO1
IO#4 BO2
IO#4 BO3
/2 Timer
Timer(
(0=Disable 1=Enable) 1/ 8
1 _
1
1
1/ 1
1 -
/3 BO
Keep pressing 1 to operate.
48):
8 _
/2 Timer
Press ENTER to operate.
Press CANCEL to cancel.
/2 Timer
Operating . . .
Press END to reset.
Press CANCEL to cancel.
/2 Logic circuit
TermA(
0 - 3071):
TermB(
0 - 3071):
1/ 2
12 _
48
/2 Simultaneous fault
Keep pressing 1 to operate.
Press CANCEL to cancel.
/2 Initiate MODE2B
Keep pressing 1 to initiate MODE2B.
276
/2 Initiate MODE2B
Keep pressing 1 to initiate MODE2B.
Initiated
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
NORMAL
(DISPLAY OFF)
1=RECORD
VIEW
PRESS
ANY
BUTTON
EXCEPT FOR
"VIEW"
AND
"RESET"
MENU
( DISPLAY ON )
1=FAULT RECORD
2=EVENT RECORD
3=DISTURBANCE RECORD
METERING 1
( DISPLAY ON )
4=AUTOMATIC TEST
5=AUTORECLOSE COUNT
2=STATUS
VIEW
RESET
1=METERING
2=BINARY INPUT&OUPUT
METERING 3
( DISPLAY ON )
3=RELAY ELELMENT
AUTOMODE 1
TRIP OUTPUT
ISSUED !
VIEW
6=TERMINAL CONDITION
RESET
TRIP
( LED ON )
3=SETTING
(VIEW)
1=RELAY VERSION
LATEST FAULT *
( DISPLAY ON )
2=DESCRIPTION
AUTOMODE 2
3=COMMUNICATION
4=RECORD
RELAY
FAILED !
VIEW
5=STATUS
RESET
ALARM
( LED ON )
6=PROTECTION
7=BINARY INPUT
8=BINARY OUTPUT
AUTO SUPERVISON *
( DISPLAY ON )
9=LED
*. "LATEST FAULT" AND "AUTO
SUPERVISION" SCREEN IS
DISPLAYED ONLY IF DATA
IS STORED
VIEW
RESET
4=SETTING
(CHANGE)
5=TEST
1=SWITCH
2=MANUAL TEST
3=BINARY OUTPUT
4=TIMER
5=LOGIC CIRCUIT
6=SIMULTANEOUS FAULT
7=INITIATE MODE2B
277
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
278
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Appendix F
Case Outline
Case Type-A: Flush Mount Type
Case Type-B: Flush Mount Type
Case Type-A, B: Rack Mount Type
279
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
266
28
276.2
Front View
32
Side View
4-5.5
190.5
34.75
223
6.2
260
235.4
Optical interface
Panel Cut-out
TB3/TB4 TB2
A1 B1
A1 B1
TB2-TB4:
M3.5 Ring
terminal
E
()
()
A10 B10
TB1
1
19
20
A18 B18
Electrical interface
Rear View
Terminal Block
280
TB1:
M3.5 Ring
terminal
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
28
276.2
Front View
32
Side View
4-5.5
190.5
6.2
34.75
333
345.4
Optical interface
Panel Cut-out
TB2 - TB5
A1 B1
TB2-TB5:
M3.5 Ring
terminal
TB1
1
19
20
Electrical interface
TB1:
M3.5 Ring
terminal
Rear View
A18 B18
Terminal Block
281
260
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
279
Top View
Attachment kit
(top bar)
Attachment kit
(large bracket)
Attachment kit
(small bracket)
4 HOLES - 6.8x10.3
2 6 5. 9
GRL100
3 7. 7
201A-11-10-30
1A
100/110/115/120V
465.1
483.0
Front View
Rack Mount Type: Case Type-A
282
279
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Attachment kit
(top bar)
Attachment kit
(large bracket)
Attachment kit
(small bracket)
Top View
4 HOLES - 6.8x10.3
2 6 5. 9
GRL100
202A-11-10-30
1A
100/110/115/120V
3 7. 7
110/125Vdc
465.1
483.0
Front View
Rack Mount: Case Type-B
283
265.9
265.9
136
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
247.8
19.4
18
216
Parts
(a)
1 Large bracket,
(b)
1 Small bracket,
(c)
2 Bars,
284
18.8
265.9
265.9
132
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
19.4
137.8
18
18.8
326
Parts
(a)
1 Large bracket, 5 Round head screws with spring washers and washers (M4x10)
(b)
(c)
285
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
How to Mount Attachment Kit for Rack-Mounting
Caution: Be careful that the relay modules or terminal blocks, etc., are not damage while mounting.
Tighten screws to the specified torque according to the size of screw.
Step 1.
Right bracket
Left bracket
Seal
Step 2.
Screw
GPS ALARM
SYNC. ALARM
MODE 2A
CF
Seal
Step 3
Top bar
GPS ALARM
SYNC. ALARM
MODE 2A
CF
Small bracket
Large bracket
Bottom bar
Step 4
Completed.
GPS ALARM
SYNC. ALARM
MODE 2A
CF
286
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Appendix G
Typical External Connection
287
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
BUS
TB3- A2
TB1 -1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CT
CB
(1)
CB
BO 1
A1
BO 2
B1
BO 3
B2
A3
20
(CASE EARTH)
B3
BO4
A4
CT
B4
BO5
A5
B5
BO6
CB
A6
B6
BO7
BUSBAR
A7
B7
BO8
[Default setting]
A8
(+)
CB1 contacts
(Closed when bus CB main
contact closed.)
CB2 contacts
(Closed when center CB main
contact closed.)
52A (A-ph.)
TB4-A4
52B (B-ph.)
B4
52C (C-ph.)
A5
52A (A-ph.)
B5
52B (B-ph.)
A6
52C (C-ph.)
B6
DC power supply
A9
B9
A10
BI6
BI8
B14
A15
(-) B15
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
BO13
B13
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
A12
FAIL
B12
BI12
RELAY
FAILURE
BI13
TB3-A1 8
COM2-B
A1 7
COM2-0V
A1 6
COM1-A
B1 8
COM1-B
B1 7
COM1-0V
B1 6
GPS Signal
(Optical Interface)
BI14
CN2
BI15
TX1
CH1 RX1
CK1
TX2
( *)CH 2 RX2
CK2
BI16
BI17
COM2-A
A13
BI11
A11
(-) B11
TB3-A14
C-ph
IO#1
BI9
B10
B-ph
B11
BO 12
BI10
Indication reset
A11
BI7
B10
BO 11
BI5
B8
B9
A10
BI4
A8
A9
BO 10
BI3
B7
B8
BI1
BI2
A7
BO9
IO#2
BI18
CH1
Electrical
Interface Telecommunication
Links
or
TX1
RX1
Optical
Interface
TX 2
(*) CH2
RX 2
TB3-A18
COM-A
RS485 I/F
B18
A17
COM-B
TB4
CN 1
(IRIG-B )
TB 3
C N2
A1
B1
B17
A16
0V
TB1
1
B16
B18
IO# 2
IO#1
19
20
VC T
F or electrical in terface
TB4
IRIG-B
RELAY FAIL.
DD FAIL.
TB4 -A16
(+) B16
A17
(-) B17
A18
B18
A15
(1)
B15
DC
SUPPLY
DC-DC
E (CASE EARTH)
+5Vdc
0V
TP-A1
A1
TP-B1
A2
TP-C1
B2
TB4-A14
B14
TP-A2
A12
TP-B2
A13
TP-C2
B13
288
B1
TX1
TB4- A3
B3
CN 1
(IR IG-B )
TB3
A1
RX1
(+)
TB 1
TX2
RX2
(*)
TRIP-A
TRIP-B
BUS CB
A18
IO#1
B18
IO# 2
19
20
VCT
F or o ptical interface
TRIP-C
Model GRL100-1*1
TRIP-A
TRIP-B
TRIP-C
CENTER CB
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
BUS
TB1 -1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CT
CB
(1)
CB
TB3- A2
BO1
TB2-A1
BO1
A1
BO2
BO2
BO3
B2
20
BO3
BO4
B3
BO4
B4
BO5
A5
BO6
A6
BO7
A7
BO8
[Default setting]
52B (B-ph.)
CB2 contacts
(Closed when center CB main
contact closed.)
TB4-A4
B4
52C (C-ph.)
A5
52A (A-ph.)
B5
52B (B-ph.)
52C (C-ph.)
B7
DC power supply
A9
B9
A10
Indication reset
B10
B14
C-ph
A15
(-) B15
BO9
BO10
A11
BI7
(HIGH SPEED
B11
RELAY)
A13
(HIGH SPEED
B13
RELAY)
A12
RELAY
B12
FAILURE
BO12
IO#1
BI10
BO13
BI11
FAIL
BI12
BI13
CN2
TX1
CH1 RX1
CK1
TX2
(*) CH2 RX2
CK2
BI16
BI17
IO#2
BI18
CH1
IO#3
COM2-A
COM2-B
COM2-0V
TB3-A18
COM1-A
COM1-B
B18
COM1-0V
B16
B17
TX1
RX1
Optical
Interface
IO#1: IO1 module
IO#2: IO2 module
IO#3: IO3 module
TB3-A18
B18
A17
COM-B
For IEC103
A17
A16
Electrical
Interface Telecommunication
Links
or
TX2
(*)CH2
RX2
COM-A
B10
GPS Signal
(Optical Interface)
BI14
BI15
B9
A10
B10
BI9
A11
(-) B11
TB3-A14
B-ph
B9
BO11
B8
A9
BI6
BI8
B8
BO8
A10
BI5
A8
BO10
BI4
B7
A8
B8
A9
BI3
B6
BO9
BI1
BI2
A6
A7
BO7
A8
52A (A-ph.)
CB1 contacts
(Closed when bus CB main
contact closed.)
B6
A7
B7
(+)
B5
A6
BO6
B6
BUS
B4
A5
BO5
B5
CB
B3
A4
A4
CT
B2
A3
A3
(CASE EARTH)
B1
A2
B1
RS485 I/F
(One RS485 port)
CN1
(IRIG-B)
TB3 TB2
TB4
CN2
B17
A1
B1
B1
A16
0V
B16
TB1
B10
1
IO#3
A18
B18
IO#2
IO#1
19
20
VCT
A1
TB4- A3
B3 (+)
TP-A1
RELAY FAIL.
TB4 -A16
(+) B16
A17
(-) B17
A18
B18
A15
(1)
B15
DC-DC
TP-B1
A2
TP-C1
B2
DD FAIL.
DC
SUPPLY
A1
+5Vdc
0V
TB4-A14
B14
TP-A2
A12
TP-B2
A13
TP-C2
B13
E (CASE EARTH)
289
B1
B1
TX1
RX1
TX2
TRIP-A
TRIP-B
RX2
BUS CB
TRIP-C
TB1
IO#3
B18
IO#2
19
20
VCT
(+)
Model GRL100-1*2
TRIP-A
TRIP-C
B10
1
(*)
A18
IO#1
TRIP-B
CN1
(IRIG-B)
TB3 TB2
TB4
IRIG-B
CENTER CB
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
BUS
BUS VT
TB3- A2
TB1 -1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CT
CB
TB2-A1
BO1
A1
BO2
BO1
B1
B1
BO3
A2
BO2
B2
B2
A3
BO4
B3
A4
11
VT
A3
BO3
B3
A4
BO4
B4
BO5
12
B4
A5
13
14
BO6
A5
B5
BO5
B5
A6
BUS VT
(1)
[Default setting]
BO7
15
16
20
BO8
(CASE EARTH)
B7
52A (A-ph.)
TB4-A4
52B (B-ph.)
B4
A5
B7
BI8
A8
DC power supply
A9
B9
A10
Indication reset
B10
A11
(-) B11
TB3-A14
A-ph
B7
A8
B8
A9
B9
ARC reset
(-)
A10
B10
B11
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
BO13
B13
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
A12
FAIL
BI11
B12
BI12
RELAY
FAILURE
BI13
For IEC103
A17
COM2-0V
A16
COM1-A
COM1-B
B18
COM1-0V
B16
B17
For RSM or IEC103
GPS Signal
(Optical Interface)
BI14
CN2
BI15
BI16
BI17
TB3-A18
COM2-A
COM2-B
A13
BI9
A15
(-) B15
TB2-A7
C-ph.
BO12
IO#1
BI10
B14
B-ph.
B10
A11
BI7
B8
C-ph
BO11
BI6
B-ph
B9
A10
BI5
A-ph
A9
BI4
B6
B8
BO10
BI3
A6
A7
BO9
BI1
BI2
B5
B6
IO#3
A8
52C (C-ph.)
BO6
A7
(+)
CB1 contacts
(Closed when CB main
contact closed.)
A6
B6
IO#2
BI18
TX1
CH1 RX1
CK1
TX2
(*)CH2 RX2
CK2
Electrical
Interface
TX1
RX1
TX2
(*)CH2
RX2
Optical
Interface
or
CH1
BI19
BI20
Communication
Links
BI21
BI22
IO#3
COM-A
TB3-A18
B18
A17
BI23
BI24
COM-B
RS485 I/F
(One RS485 port)
CN2
B17
BI25
CN1
(IRIG-B)
TB3 TB2
TB4
A1
B1
B1
A16
0V
B16
TB1
B10
1
IO#3
A18
B18
IO#2
IO#1
19
20
VCT
A1
IRIG-B
RELAY FAIL.
DD FAIL.
TB4 -A16
(+) B16
A17
(-) B17
A18
B18
A15
(1)
B15
DC
SUPPLY
DC-DC
+5Vdc
0V
A2
TP-C1
B2
TB4-A14
B14
A12
TP-B2
A13
TP-C2
B13
E (CASE EARTH)
290
RX1
TX2
A1
TP-B1
TP-A2
B1
B1
TX1
TB4- A3
B3 (+)
TP-A1
RX2
TRIP-A
TRIP-B
TRIP-C
(+)
TRIP-A
TRIP-B
TRIP-C
CN1
(IRIG-B)
TB3 TB2
TB4
BUS CB
A18
IO#1
B10
1
(*)
TB1
IO#3
B18
IO#2
19
20
VCT
Model GRL100-2*1
Note GRL100-201: 2 terminal system, not provided with
terminals marked with (*).
GRL100-211: 3 terminal system
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
TB3- A2
TB2- A2
BO1
BUS
BO2
BUS VT
TB1 -1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CT
CB
BO4
B2
A3
A3
BO4
A4
B4
B4
BO5
BO6
BO6
B5
BO7
(1)
[Default setting]
15
16
20
BO7
BO8
52B (B-ph.)
52C (C-ph.)
TB4-A4
B4
A5
A6
B6
A7
B7
A8
B8
DC power supply
A9
B9
A10
BI8
C-ph
Interlink signals
(Parallel line interlink signal
for terminal 1)
BI9
A15
(-) B15
TB5-A12
B-ph.
B12
A16
B16
(-)
COM-A
A12
IO#3
B12
A13
B13
B18
COM2-0V
A17
A16
COM1-A
COM1-B
B18
B17
COM1-0V
B16
Communication
Links
IO#1:
IO#2:
IO#3:
IO#4:
For IEC103
IO1
IO2
IO5
IO4
module
module
module
module
TB5
TB4
TB3
OP1
E
OP2
TB1
B16
OP1 R
For IEC103
BI36
B18
A18
IO#3
IO#1
IO#4
IO#2
TB5
TB4
TB3
RELAY FAIL.
DD FAIL.
TB4 -A16
(+) B16
A17
(-) B17
A18
B18
A15
(1)
B15
DC
SUPPLY
DC-DC
E (CASE EARTH)
+5Vdc
0V
TP-A1
A1
TP-B1
A2
TP-C1
B2
TB4-A14
B14
TP-A2
A12
TP-B2
A13
TP-C2
B13
20
VCT
CN1
(IRIG-B)
TB2
A1
IRIG-B
TB4- A3
B3
19
OP2 T
IO#4
B1
A1
A16
0V
BI34
CN1
(IRIG-B)
TB2
CN2
B17
BI28
BI35
A17
COM-B
BI27
TB2-A18
COM2-A
COM2-B
TB2-A18
IO#3
BI26
TB3-A14
B14
Optical
Interface
B10
B11
Electrical
Interface
or
TX1
CH1 RX1
TX2
(*)CH2 RX2
BI25
A18
A15
B15
IO#2
BI18
BI24
B15
C-ph
BI16
BI23
A15
B-ph
TX1
CH1 RX1
CK1
TX2
(*)CH2 RX2
CK2
BI15
BI22
B14
Interlink signals
(Parallel line interlink signal
for terminal 2, used
for Model 212.)
BO10
BI21
A14
A-ph
B10
CN2
BI20
B13
ARC reset
BI14
BI19
A13
B9
A10
GPS Signal
(Optical Interface)
BI13
BI17
A9
BO9
IO#4
BI12
A-ph.
C-ph.
FAIL
BI11
B14
BO13
BI10
A11
B11
(-)
TB2-A14
B-ph
BI5
(HIGH SPEED
BO12
B11
RELAY)
A13
(HIGH SPEED BO13
B13
RELAY)
A12
RELAY
BO14
B12
FAILURE
IO#1
B8
A10
A11
BI4
BO12
BO8
B9
BO11
A11
BI7
B10
Indication reset
BO10
B10
BI6
B7
A9
B9
BO11
BI3
A7
BO7
B8
A10
BI2
B5
BO10
B6
A8
BO9
B8
BI1
A6
BO6
B7
A9
52A (A-ph.)
B5
A8
(+)
CB1 contacts
(Closed when CB main
contact closed.)
A5
A7
B7
BO9
B4
BO5
B6
A8
(CASE EARTH)
A4
A6
B6
BO8
B3
BO4
B5
A7
BUS VT
A3
A5
A6
13
14
B2
BO3
B3
A4
A5
11
12
B1
A2
BO2
B2
B3
BO1
B1
BO3
BO3
TB5-A1
A1
BO2
B1
BO5
VT
BO1
A1
TX1
B1
OP1
RX1
(+)
E
OP2
TX2
RX2
TB1
(*)
TRIP-B
TRIP-C
(+)
TRIP-A
TRIP-B
TRIP-C
291
BUS CB
A18
IO#3
IO#1
IO#4
TRIP-A
B18
IO#2
19
20
VCT
Model GRL100-2*2
Note GRL100-202: 2 terminal system, not provided with
terminals marked with (*).
GRL100-212: 3 terminal system
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
BUS
TB3- A2
BO1
BUS VT
TB1 -1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CT
CB
TB2-A1
A1
BO2
BO1
B1
B1
BO3
A2
BO2
B2
B2
A3
BO4
A3
BO3
B3
B3
A4
B4
A5
12
VT
A4
BO4
B4
BO5
11
BO6
13
14
A5
B5
BO5
B5
A6
A6
BO7
BUS VT
(1)
B6
BO6
B6
A7
15
16
20
BO8
B7
IO#3
A8
(CASE EARTH)
BO9
B8
A9
BO10
Programmable BI
(-)
TB4-B4
A4
B5
A5
B6
A6
B7
A7
B8
A8
B9
A9
B10
A10
B11
A11
B12
A12
B13
A13
B14
A14
B15
A15
TB3-A14
B14
(-)
B7
A8
B8
A9
B9
(-)
A10
B10
BI1
BO11
BI2
B10
A11
BI3
BO12
BI4
BI5
B11
IO#1
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
A13
BI6
BO13
B13
FAIL
A12
BI7
BI8
B12
BI9
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
COM2-0V
A17
A16
COM1-B
B18
B17
BI12
CN2
TX1
CH1 RX1
CK1
TX2
(*)CH2 RX2
CK2
BI16
IO#2
COM1-0V
B16
BI18
BI20
(*)CH2
BI21
IO#3
COM-A
BI23
or
B18
A17
COM-B
BI25
Optical
Interface
TX2
RX2
Communication
Links
TB3-A18
BI24
Electrical
Interface
CH1 TX1
RX1
BI19
For IEC103
GPS Signal
COM1-A
(Optical Interface)
BI11
BI22
TB3-A18
COM2-A
COM2-B
RELAY
FAILURE
BI10
BI17
B15
TB2-A7
B9
A10
RS485 I/F
(One RS485 port)
CN1
(IRIG-B)
TB3 TB2
TB4
CN2
A1
B1
B1
B17
E
A16
0V
B16
B10
1
TB1
2
IO#3
B18
A18
IO#2
IO#1
19
20
VCT
TB4
A1
IRIG-B
B1
B1
TX1
RX1
TB4- A3
B3
(+)
RELAY FAIL.
DD FAIL.
TB4 -A16
DC
(+) B16
DC-DC
A17
SUPPLY
(-) B17
A18
B18
(1)These connections are connected
(1)
by short-bars before shipment.
E (CASE EARTH)
A1
TP-B
A2
(*)
TP-C
0V
B2
TB1
IO#3
TRIP-A
A18
+5Vdc
B10
1
TX2
RX2
TP-A
CN1
(IRIG-B)
TRIP-B
IO#1
B18
IO#2
19
20
VCT
Model GRL100-2*4
Note GRL100-204: 2 terminal system, not provided with
terminals marked with (*).
GRL100-214: 3 terminal system
292
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
BUS
TB3- A2
TB2- A2
BO1
BUS VT
TB1 -1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CT
CB
BO1
A1
BO2
BO2
B1
BO4
B2
A3
A3
BO4
11
VT
BO6
BO6
(1)
15
16
20
BO7
BO8
B8
BO10
(-)
B14
B12
BI4
BI5
IO#1
BO13
FAIL
BI6
BI7
BI9
BI10
TX1
CH1 RX1
CK1
TX2
(*) CH2 RX2
CK2
IO#2
BI18
A15
CH1
COM-A
A13
B13
COM2-A
COM2-B
COM2-0V
A17
A16
COM1-A
COM1-B
B18
B17
COM1-0V
B16
IO#1:
IO#2:
IO#3:
IO#4:
Communication
Links
COM-B
IO8
IO2
IO5
IO4
module
module
module
module
TB3
B1
E
OP2
TB1
2
A16
B16
OP1
T
R
IO#3
IO#1
TB5
TB4
IO#4
TB3
19
20
VCT
CN1
(IRIG-B)
TB2
A1
TX1
B1
OP1
RX1
For IEC103
IO#2
OP2 T
B18
A18
IO#4
BI36
CN1
(IRIG-B)
TB2
A1
B17
0V
BI34
BI35
TB4
For IEC103
OP1
TB3-A14
TB2-A18
A17
BI28
A18
IO#3
B12
TB5
B18
IO#3
BI27
B16
A12
TB2-A18
BI26
A16
Optical
Interface
B10
CN2
BI25
B15
BO10
B11
Electrical
Interface
or
TX1
RX1
TX2
(*) CH2
RX2
BI19
BI24
B10
CN2
BI16
BI23
B14
B9
A10
GPS Signal
(Optical Interface)
BI11
BI22
A14
A9
BO9
IO#4
BI12
B8
A10
A11
BI8
BI21
B13
A15
B15
(HIGH SPEED
BO12
B11
RELAY)
A13
(HIGH SPEED BO13
B13
RELAY)
A12
RELAY
BO14
B12
FAILURE
BI20
A13
B14
BI2
BI17
A15
(-) B15
TB5-A12
(-)
A11
BO12
BO8
B9
BO11
B10
BI1
BI3
B7
A9
B9
BO11
BO7
A8
BO9
A10
TB4-B4
A4
B5
A5
B6
A6
B7
A7
B8
A8
B9
A9
B10
A10
B11
A11
B12
A12
B13
A13
B14
A14
B15
A15
TB2-A14
A7
B7
A9
(+)
B6
A8
B8
BO10
A6
A7
B7
BO9
B5
BO6
B6
A8
(CASE EARTH)
A5
A6
B6
BO8
B4
BO5
B5
A7
BUS VT
A4
A5
A6
BO7
B3
BO4
B4
BO5
B5
13
14
A3
A4
B4
A5
12
B2
BO3
B3
A4
BO5
B1
A2
BO2
B2
B3
BO1
B1
BO3
BO3
TB5-A1
A1
E
OP2
TX2
IRIG-B
TB4- A3
B3
RELAY FAIL.
DD FAIL.
TB4 -A16
DC
(+) B16
DC-DC
A17
SUPPLY
(-) B17
A18
(1)These connections are connected
B18
(1)
by short-bars before shipment.
E (CASE EARTH)
+5Vdc
TP-A1
A1
TP-B1
A2
TP-C1
B2
RX2
TB1
(*)
(+)
A18
IO#3
TRIP-A
TRIP-B
TRIP-C
IO#1
IO#4
B18
IO#2
19
20
VCT
Model GRL100-2*6
Note GRL100-206: 2 terminal system, not provided with
terminals marked with (*).
GRL100-216: 3 terminal system
0V
293
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
BUS
TB3- A2
BUS VT
CT
CB
TB2-A1
BO1
TB1 -1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A1
BO2
BO1
B1
B1
BO3
A2
BO2
B2
B2
A3
BO4
A3
BO3
B3
CB
B3
A4
CT
11
VT
12
BO6
[Default Setting]
CB2 contacts
(Closed when center CB main
contact closed.)
B7
B6
IO#3
A8
BO9
(CASE EARTH)
B8
A9
TB4-A4
52B (B-ph.)
B4
52C (C-ph.)
A5
52A (A-ph.)
B5
52B (A-ph.)
A6
52C (A-ph.)
B6
B8
DC power supply
A9
B9
A10
Indication reset
B10
(-)
B-ph
A-ph
(-)
C-ph.
A8
B8
A9
ARC reset
B9
(-)
A10
B10
A11
BI6
BO12
B11
BO13
B13
BI8
FAIL
A12
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
A13
BI7
IO#1
BI9
BI10
B12
BI11
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
GPS Signal
(Optical Interface)
BI13
BI14
CN2
BI15
BI16
BI17
IO#2
BI18
Electrical
Interface
TX1
RX1
TX2
(*) CH2
RX2
Optical
Interface
or
CH1
BI19
BI20
BI21
BI22
TX1
CH1 RX1
CK1
TX2
(*)CH2 RX2
CK2
COM-A
IO#3
BI23
COM-B
COM2-0V
A16
COM1-A
COM1-B
B18
COM1-0V
B16
B17
For RSM or IEC103
Communication
Links
RS485 I/F
(One RS485 port)
CN1
(IRIG-B)
TB3 TB2
TB4
B17
BI24
BI25
A17
TB3-A18
B18
A17
For IEC103
TB3-A18
COM2-A
COM2-B
RELAY
FAILURE
BI12
A15
B15
TB2-A7
B7
B10
BI5
A11
B11
TB2-A14
B-ph.
BO11
BI4
B14
C-ph
B9
A10
BI3
B7
A8
BO10
BI1
BI2
A7
Interlink signals
(Parallel line interlink
signal for Term1)
BO8
17
18
20
52A (A-ph.)
BO6
A7
(+)
CB1 contacts
(Closed when bus CB main
contact closed.)
B5
A6
B6
15
16
(1)
BO5
A6
BO7
PARALLEL LINE VT
A5
B5
CB
BUS VT
B4
A5
13
14
BUS
A4
BO4
B4
BO5
CN2
A1
B1
B1
A16
0V
B16
TB1
B10
1
IO#3
B18
A18
IO#2
IO#1
19
20
VCT
RELAY FAIL.
IRIG-B
TB4- A3
B3 (+)
DD FAIL.
TB4 -A16
(+) B16
DC
A17
SUPPLY
(-) B17
A18
B18
A15
(1)
(1)These connections are connected
B15
by short-bars before shipment.
DC-DC
E (CASE EARTH)
+5Vdc
TP-A1
A1
0V
TP-B1
A2
TP-C1
B2
A1
TB4-A14
B14
TP-A2
A12
TP-B2
A13
TP-C2
B13
294
RX1
TX2
RX2
B10
1
(*)
TB1
IO#3
BUS CB
A18
TRIP-C
B1
B1
TX1
TRIP-A
TRIP-B
CN1
(IRIG-B)
TB3 TB2
TB4
IO#1
B18
IO#2
19
20
VCT
Model GRL100-3*1
Note GRL100-301: 2 terminal system, not provided with
terminals marked with (*).
GRL100-311: 3 terminal system
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
BUS
BO1
TB1 -1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CT
CB
BO2
VT
BO6
13
14
(1)
BO8
CB1 contacts
(Closed when CB main
contact closed.)
BO9
CB2 contacts
(Closed when CB main
contact closed.)
TB4-A4
B4
52C (C-ph.)
A5
52A (A-ph.)
B5
52B (B-ph.)
A6
52C (C-ph.)
B6
A7
B7
A8
B8
DC power supply
A9
B9
A10
BI6
BI7
BI8
A15
(-) B15
TB5-A12
B12
A13
B13
A14
Interlink signals
(Parallel lineinterlink signal
for terminal 2, used
for Model 312.)
B15
B-ph
A16
C-ph
B16
(-)
COM-A
BO9
A10
B9
B10
A10
A11
BO12
B11
BO13
B12
BO10
A12
IO#3
B10
IO#3
A13
BO14
B13
Electrical
Interface
or
Optical
Interface
A17
COM2-0V
A16
COM1-A
COM1-B
B18
COM1-0V
B16
Communication
Links
For IEC103
TB2-A18
COM2-A
COM2-B
B17
IO#1:
IO#2:
IO#3:
IO#4:
IO1
IO2
IO5
IO4
module
module
module
module
TB2-A18
B18
A17
COM-B
BI22
TB5
TB4
TB3
OP1
E
OP2
TB1
B16
BI26
T
OP1 R
For IEC103
IO#1
IO#4
IO#2
TB5
TB4
TB3
IRIG-B
IO#4
TB4 -A16
(+) B16
A17
(-) B17
A18
B18
A15
(1)
B15
DC-DC
A1
TP-B1
A2
DD FAIL.
DC
SUPPLY
CN1
(IRIG-B)
TB2
A1
TX1
B1
OP1
TP-C1
+5Vdc
0V
B2
TB4-A14
B14
TP-A2
A12
TP-B2
A13
TP-C2
B13
E
OP2
(+)
TX2
RX2
TP-A1
20
VCT
RX1
TB4- A3
B3
BI36
RELAY FAIL.
19
BI34
BI35
B18
A18
IO#3
BI28
B1
A1
A16
0V
BI27
CN1
(IRIG-B)
TB2
CN2
B17
BI25
A18
B14
BI18
BI24
A9
B9
BO11
TX1
RX1
TX2
(*) CH2
RX2
BI21
TB3-A14
A15
B15
BO10
CH1
IO#2
BI20
A15
A-ph
BI16
B8
A9
TX1
CH1 RX1
CK1
TX2
(*)CH2 RX2
CK2
BI15
BI23
BO8
CN2
BI19
B14
ARC reset
B8
IO#4
BI14
B7
A8
BI12
BI17
BO7
GPS Signal
(Optical Interface)
BI13
B6
A7
B7
BO9
BI11
B14
C-ph.
FAIL
IO#1
BI9
B-ph
B-ph.
BO13
A6
BO6
A8
BI10
A-ph
A-ph.
Interlink signals
(Parallel lineinterlink signal
for terminal 1)
BO8
(HIGH SPEED
B11
RELAY)
A13
(HIGH SPEED
B13
RELAY)
A12
RELAY
B12
FAILURE
BI5
B5
A7
B10
BO12
A5
B6
A11
BI4
A11
B11
(-)
TB2-A14
C-ph
BO7
B9
BI3
B4
BO5
B5
A10
BO11
A4
BO4
A6
B8
BI2
B10
Indication reset
Backup protection block(#43BU)
BO6
A9
BI1
B3
A5
B7
BO10
52B (B-ph.)
BO5
A8
17
18
20
(+)
52A (A-ph.)
B4
B4
B6
(CASE EARTH)
[Default setting]
A4
A7
15
16
PARALLEL LINE VT
A4
B5
BO7
A3
BO3
B3
A6
CB
B2
A3
BO4
A5
12
BUS VT
BO2
B3
BO5
B1
A2
B2
B2
A3
11
BO1
B1
BO3
BO3
TB5-A1
A1
BO2
B1
CB
CT
BO1
A1
BO4
BUS
TB3- A2
TB2- A2
BUS VT
TB1
(*)
TRIP-A
TRIP-B
TRIP-C
(+)
TRIP-A
TRIP-B
TRIP-C
E (CASE EARTH)
295
BUS CB
A18
IO#3
IO#1
IO#4
B18
IO#2
19
20
VCT
Model GRL100-3*2
Note GRL100-302: 2 terminal system, not provided with
terminals marked with (*).
GRL100-312: 3 terminal system
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
BUS
TB2- A2
BO1
BUS VT
TB1 -1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CT
CB
BO2
BO1
B1
BO4
BO3
BO3
13
14
(1)
BO8
A10
52A (A-ph.)
TB4-A4
52B (B-ph.)
B4
52C (C-ph.)
A5
BO5
BO6
A7
B7
A8
B8
DC power supply
A9
B9
A10
BO7
BI8
A-ph.
A15
(-) B15
TB5-A12
B-ph.
B12
C-ph.
A13
B14
ARC reset
A15
A-ph
B15
B-ph
A16
C-ph
B16
(-)
A18
BO8
B13
FAIL
A12
B12
BI17
IO#2
TX1
RX1
TX2
(*) CH2
RX2
BI19
BI20
COM-A
BI21
BI24
Optical
Interface
B18
(+)
COM-B
B10
IO#3
COM2-A
COM2-B
Communication
Links
A17
A16
COM1-A
COM1-B
B18
COM1-0V
B16
TB5
B17
IO#1:
IO#2:
IO#3:
IO#4:
B17
For IEC103
TB2-A18
COM2-0V
A17
IO#3
TB4
IO1 module
IO2 module
IO5 module
FD module
TB3
A16
0V
BI25
BO10
TB2-A18
BI22
BI23
A15
B15
B9
A10
IO#4
Electrical
Interface
or
CH1
BI18
BO9
(+)
GPS Signal
(Optical Interface)
TX1
CH1 RX1
CK1
TX2
(*)CH2 RX2
CK2
BI16
A17
B17
A16
B16
RELAY
FAILURE
CN2
BI15
FD1
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
B8
A9
A18
B18
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
A13
BI14
A8
BO8
B13
FD2
BI12
B14
A14
BO13
BI11
B-ph
B13
B11
BI10
A-ph
BO12
BI13
B7
B12
A11
BI9
BO7
A13
B10
BI6
A11
B11
(-)
TB2-A14
C-ph
BO11
IO#1
B6
A7
A12
A10
BI4
B10
Indication reset
Backup protection block(#43BU)
BI1
BI7
A6
BO6
B11
B9
BI2
B6
B5
B10
B8
BO10
BI5
B4
BO5
A11
A8
BI3
A4
BO4
A5
A9
A6
Interlink signals
(Parallel line interlink signal
for terminal 2, used
for Model 411.)
B5
B7
(CASE EARTH)
B5
Interlink signals
(Parallel line interlink signal
for terminal 1)
B4
A7
(+)
CB1 contacts
(Closed when CB main
contact closed.)
A5
B6
BO9
[Default setting]
BO4
A6
BO7
B3
B3
A4
B4
BO6
A3
A3
B3
BO5
B2
B2
12
BUS VT
A2
BO2
BO2
B2
A3
15
16
20
B1
A2
A4
VT
BO1
B1
BO3
11
TB5-A1
TB3-A1
A1
BI27
BI28
B1
A1
OP1
B16
BI26
CN1
(IRIG-B)
TB2
CN2
OP2
TB1
2
OP1 R
B18
A18
For IEC103
IO#3
IO#1
TB5
TB4
IO#4
IO#2
19
20
VCT
RELAY FAIL.
DC-DC
E (CASE EARTH)
(+)
TB3
CN1
(IRIG-B)
TB2
A1
TX1
B1
OP1
RX1
TRIP-A
E
OP2
TX2
DD FAIL.
TB4 -A16
(+) B16
DC
A17
SUPPLY
(-) B17
A18
B18
(1)These connections are connected
A15
(1)
B15
by short-bars before shipment.
A1
()Caution:
+5Vdc
0V
TP-B1
A2
TP-C1
B2
TB4-A14
B14
TP-A2
A12
TP-B2
A13
TP-C2
B13
RX2
TRIP-B
BUS CB
TRIP-C
TB1
(*)
A18
IO#3
IO#1
IO#4
B18
IO#2
19
(+)
20
VCT
296
Model GRL100-4*1
Note GRL100-401: 2 terminal system, not provided with
terminals marked with (*).
GRL100-411: 3 terminal system
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
TB2- A2
BUS
BO1
BUS VT
TB1 -1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CT
CB
A1
A3
B2
B3
A3
BO3
A4
11
VT
12
BO6
BO4
BO7
CB
BUS
BUS VT
BO5
(1)
[Default setting]
CB2 contacts
(Closed when CB main
contact closed.)
BO10
TB4-A4
52B (B-ph.)
B4
52C (C-ph.)
A5
52A (A-ph.)
B5
52B (B-ph.)
A6
52C (C-ph.)
B6
B7
A8
B8
DC power supply
A9
B9
A10
(-)
BO7
BI4
BO8
BI7
BI8
B12
B13
A14
B14
ARC reset
A15
A-ph
B15
B-ph
A16
C-ph
B16
(-)
A18
BO13
B13
IO#1
FAIL
A12
A9
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
TX1
CH1 RX1
CK1
TX2
(*) CH2 RX2
CK2
BI14
BI15
BI16
IO#2
BI19
BI20
COM-A
B18
For IEC103
TB2-A18
A17
COM2-0V
A16
COM1-A
COM1-B
B18
COM1-0V
B16
B17
For RSM or IEC103
Communication
Links
IO#1:
IO#2:
IO#3:
IO#4:
TB5
TB4
IO1 module
IO2 module
IO5 module
FD module
IO#3
CN2
B1
A1
OP1
A16
0V
E
OP2
B16
TB1
BI27
T
BI28
DD FAIL.
+5Vdc
0V
A1
TP-B1
A2
TP-C1
B2
TB4-A14
B14
TP-A2
A12
TP-B2
A13
TP-C2
IO#3
IO#1
TB5
TB4
For IEC103
TB4- A3
B3
B13
B18
A18
IRIG-B
OP1 R
TP-A1
CN1
(IRIG-B)
TB2
TB3
B17
BI26
E (CASE EARTH)
COM2-A
COM2-B
A17
COM-B
BI25
DC-DC
IO#3
TB2-A18
BI21
BI22
Optical
Interface
TB4 -A16
(+) B16
A17
(-) B17
A18
B18
A15
(1)
B15
(+)
B10
A16
B16
Electrical
Interface
or
TX1
CH1 RX1
TX2
(*) CH2
RX2
BI18
RELAY FAIL.
BO10
CN2
BI13
BI24
A10
IO#4
BI12
BI23
A15
B15
B9
(+)
GPS Signal
(Optical Interface)
OP2 T
DC
SUPPLY
FD1
RELAY
FAILURE
BI11
BI17
A17
B17
BO9
A18
B18
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
B12
BI9
A15
(-) B15
TB5-A12
A13
FD2
BI10
C-ph
C-ph.
B11
B8
B13
A13
BI6
B14
B-ph.
BO12
BI5
A11
B11
TB2-A14
A8
BO8
A13
B10
B7
B12
A11
BI3
B-ph
A-ph.
BO11
BI1
BI2
B10
Indication reset
Interlink signals
(Parallel line interlink signal
for terminal 2, used
for Model 511.)
A7
BO7
A12
B9
B6
B11
A9
52A (A-ph.)
A7
Interlink signals
(Parallel line interlink signal
for terminal 1)
BO6
BO6
A10
A6
A11
B8
(+)
CB1 contacts
(Closed when CB main
contact closed.)
B5
B10
B7
BO9
(CASE EARTH)
BO5
B6
BO8
17
18
20
B4
A5
A8
PARALLEL LINE VT
A4
BO4
A10
A7
15
16
B3
B4
B5
A6
13
14
A3
BO3
A4
A5
B2
B3
B4
BO5
A2
BO2
BO2
CB
CT
B1
A2
B2
BO4
BO1
B1
B1
BO3
TB5-A1
TB3-A1
BO1
BO2
IO#4
IO#2
19
20
VCT
(+)
CN1
(IRIG-B)
TB2
TB3
A1
()Caution:
TX1
B1
OP1
RX1
E
OP2
TX2
TRIP-A
TRIP-B
RX2
TB1
(*)
BUS CB
A18
IO#3
TRIP-C
IO#1
IO#4
B18
IO#2
19
20
VCT
(+)
297
Model GRL100-5*1
CENTER CB
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
BUS
TB2- A2
BO1
A1
BUS VT
CT
CB
CT
A4
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
PARALLEL LINE VT
(1)
[Default setting]
TB4-A4
52B (B-ph.)
B4
A5
52A (A-ph.)
B5
52B (B-ph.)
A6
52C (C-ph.)
B6
B7
B8
DC power supply
A9
B9
A10
B11
(-)
B-ph
C-ph
BI7
BI8
A13
A-ph
B15
B-ph
A16
B16
C-ph
(-)
A18
BI14
BI15
COM-A
IO#2
(+)
COM2-A
COM2-B
Communication
Links
A17
COM2-0V
A16
COM1-A
COM1-B
B18
COM1-0V
B16
B17
IO#1:
IO#2:
IO#3:
IO#4:
TB5
For IEC103
TB2-A18
TB4
IO1 module
IO2 module
IO5 module
FD module
TB3
B1
A1
OP1
E
OP2
TB1
OP2
BI25
IRIG-B
TB4- A3
B3
BI28
TP-A1
1
DD FAIL.
+5Vdc
0V
IO#3
IO#1
TB5
TB4
For IEC103
A1
TP-B1
A2
TP-C1
B2
TB4-A14
B14
TP-A2
A12
TP-B2
A13
TP-C2
B13
298
IO#4
TB3
()Caution:
CN1
(IRIG-B)
B1
OP1
E
OP2
TX2
RX2
BUS CB
TB1
(*)
IO#1
IO#4
A18
IO#3
TRIP-C
B18
IO#2
29
30
VCT
(+)
Model GRL100-5*3
TRIP-A
TRIP-C
30
VCT
RX1
TRIP-A
TRIP-B
29
TB2
A1
TX1
(+)
TRIP-B
IO#2
BI26
BI27
B18
A18
T
R
OP1 R
IO#3
CN1
(IRIG-B)
TB2
CN2
B16
BI22
E (CASE EARTH)
IO#3
A16
BI21
DC-DC
B10
B17
BI20
RELAY FAIL.
TB4 -A16
DC
(+) B16
A17
SUPPLY
(-) B17
A18
B18
(1)These connections are connected
A15
(1)
B15
by short-bars before shipment.
A15
B15
A17
0V
BI19
Optical
Interface
B18
COM-B
BI18
BI24
BO10
TB2-A18
BI16
BI23
Electrical
Interface
or
TX1
CH1
RX1
TX2
(*) CH2
RX2
BI13
BI17
A10
A16
B16
RELAY
FAILURE
TX1
CH1 RX1
CK1
TX2
(*) CH2 RX2
CK2
BI12
C-ph.
A15
FD1
B9
(+)
CN2
IO#1
BI11
B12
ARC reset
A9
IO#4
BI10
B-ph.
B14
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
B8
BO9
GPS Signal
(Optical Interface)
BI9
A-ph.
A14
B12
BI6
A15
(-) B15
TB5-A12
FAIL
A12
A17
B17
A18
B18
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
BI5
B14
B13
BI4
A11
B11
TB2-A14
B13
BO13
BI3
B10
Indication reset
BI1
BI2
A8
Interlink signals
(Parallel line interlink signal
for terminal 2, used
for Model 513.)
FD2
A13
52A (A-ph.)
52C (C-ph.)
A8
BO8
B13
A11
(CASE EARTH)
A7
Interlink signals
(Parallel line interlink signal
for terminal 1)
BO8
B10
(+)
CB2 contacts
(Closed when CB main
contact closed.)
BO11
B7
B12
A10
27
28
30
BO12
CB1 contacts
(Closed when CB main
contact closed.)
A7
BO7
A13
B9
B6
B11
A9
BO10
BO6
A12
B8
CB
BUS
A6
A11
B7
BO9
25
26
B5
B10
A8
BUS VT
BO5
B6
BO8
23
24
B4
B4
A5
A7
22
BO4
A10
A6
21
VT
B3
B3
B5
BO7
BO3
A4
A5
BO6
A3
A3
BO3
B4
BO5
B2
B2
B3
A4
CB
A2
BO2
BO2
A3
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
B1
A2
B2
BO4
BO1
B1
B1
BO3
TB5-A1
TB3-A1
BO1
BO2
TB1 -1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CENTER CB
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Appendix H
Relay Setting Sheet
Relay Identification
Transmission line parameters
Protection
Autoreclose scheme
Contacts setting
Contacts setting (continued)
Relay and Protection Scheme Setting Sheets
299
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Relay Setting Sheets
1. Relay Identification
Date:
Relay type
Serial Number
Frequency
CT rating
VT rating
dc supply voltage
Password
Active setting group
Line length
Z1 =
Z0 =
Z0 (mutual) =
Zm =
VT ratio
Tripping mode
CT ratio
1 + 3 phase/3 phase
3. Protection
Master
Slave
2 Term
3 Term
4. Autoreclose scheme
Not used
SPAR
SPAR + TPAR
TPAR
MPAR 2 (for two-phase interlinking)
MPAR 3 (for three-phase interlinking)
EX1P (external autoreclose SPAR + TPAR scheme)
EX3P (external autoreclose TPAR scheme)
1CB or 2CB reclosing
Multi-shot autoreclose
1 shot, 2 shots, 3 shots or 4 shots
300
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
5. Contacts setting
(1) IO#2 BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
(2) IO#3 BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
BO14
(3) IO#4 BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
BO14
(Memo: For relay elements and scheme logic settings, the setting list as shown on the next page is made.)
301
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Relay and Protection Scheme Setting Sheet
Name
Range
5A rating
Contents
1A rating
Active group
1-8
2
3
4
5
6
Line name
VT
VTs1
VTs2
CT
Specified by user
1 -20000
1 -20000
1 -20000
1 -20000
Units
NO-ARC,NO-FD
2TERM 3TERM
1CB-ARC,NO-FD
2TERM
3TERM
101, 102 111, 112 201 202 211 212
Line name
VT ratio
VT ratio
VT ratio
CT ratio
Specified by user
2000
2000
2000
400
----
--
Specified by user
2000
2000
-400
2000
Fault location
--
Positive sequecce
impedance
2.00 / 10.0
1X1
0.00 - 199.99
0.0 - 999.9
ditto
--
2.00 / 10.0
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
1R1
1Line
2X1
2R1
2Line
3X1
3R1
km
km
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
--------
------
2.00 / 10.0
0.20 / 1.0
50.0
2.00 / 10.0
0.20 / 1.0
------
0.20 / 1.0
50.0
2.00 / 10.0
0.20 / 1.0
50.0
2.00 / 10.0
0.20 / 1.0
16
3Line
km ditto
--
--
50.0
--
17
1Xaa
0.00 - 199.99
0.0 - 999.9
ditto
--
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
1Xbb
1Xcc
1Xab
1Xbc
1Xca
1Raa
1Rbb
1Rcc
1Rab
1Rbc
1Rca
1Line
2Xaa
2Xbb
2Xcc
2Xab
2Xbc
2Xca
2Raa
2Rbb
2Rcc
2Rab
2Rbc
2Rca
2Line
3Xaa
3Xbb
3Xcc
3Xab
3Xbc
3Xca
3Raa
3Rbb
3Rcc
3Rab
3Rbc
3Rca
km
km
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
--------------------------------------
--------------------------
2.10 / 10.5
2.10 / 10.5
2.10 / 10.5
0.10 / 0.5
0.10 / 0.5
0.10 / 0.5
0.21 / 1.1
0.21 / 1.1
0.21 / 1.1
0.01 / 0.1
0.01 / 0.1
0.01 / 0.1
50.0
2.10 / 10.5
2.10 / 10.5
2.10 / 10.5
0.10 / 0.5
0.10 / 0.5
0.10 / 0.5
0.21 / 1.1
0.21 / 1.1
0.21 / 1.1
0.01 / 0.1
0.01 / 0.1
0.01 / 0.1
--------------------------
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
3Line
COMMODE
SP.SYN.
TERM
CH.CON
RYIDSV
T.SFT1
T.SFT2
0.0 - 399.9
A - B - GPS
Master - Slave
2TERM - 3TERM - Dual
Normal - Exchange
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
--
--
50.0
--
0.0 - 399.9
1CB-ARC,NO-FD
2TERM
3TERM
204 206 214 216
km ditto
communication mode
SP synchronization setting
Terminal selection
CH connection
Relay address supervision
CH#1 bit shifter for multiplexer link
CH#2 bit shifter for multiplexer link
50.0
------
2.00 / 10.0
0.20 / 1.0
50.0
2.00 / 10.0
0.20 / 1.0
------
2.00 / 10.0
0.20 / 1.0
50.0
2.00 / 10.0
0.20 / 1.0
------
--
50.0
--
50.0
--
2.10 / 10.5
---
3TERM
Normal
---
3TERM
Normal
---
--
Off
--
Off
--
302
50.0
2.10 / 10.5
2.10 / 10.5
2.10 / 10.5
0.10 / 0.5
0.10 / 0.5
0.10 / 0.5
0.21 / 1.1
0.21 / 1.1
0.21 / 1.1
0.01 / 0.1
0.01 / 0.1
0.01 / 0.1
50.0
2.10 / 10.5
-2.10 / 10.5
-2.10 / 10.5
-0.10 / 0.5
-0.10 / 0.5
-0.10 / 0.5
-0.21 / 1.1
-0.21 / 1.1
-0.21 / 1.1
-0.01 / 0.1
-0.01 / 0.1
-0.01 / 0.1
-50.0
-2.10 / 10.5
-2.10 / 10.5
-2.10 / 10.5
-0.10 / 0.5
-0.10 / 0.5
-0.10 / 0.5
-0.21 / 1.1
-0.21 / 1.1
-0.21 / 1.1
-0.01 / 0.1
-0.01 / 0.1
-0.01 / 0.1
-50.0
B
Master
3TERM
Normal
On
Off
Off
0.20 / 1.0
50.0
2.00 / 10.0
0.20 / 1.0
50.0
2.00 / 10.0
0.20 / 1.0
2.10 / 10.5
2.10 / 10.5
2.10 / 10.5
0.10 / 0.5
0.10 / 0.5
0.10 / 0.5
0.21 / 1.1
0.21 / 1.1
0.21 / 1.1
0.01 / 0.1
0.01 / 0.1
0.01 / 0.1
50.0
2.10 / 10.5
2.10 / 10.5
2.10 / 10.5
0.10 / 0.5
0.10 / 0.5
0.10 / 0.5
0.21 / 1.1
0.21 / 1.1
0.21 / 1.1
0.01 / 0.1
0.01 / 0.1
0.01 / 0.1
--------------------------
2.10 / 10.5
2.10 / 10.5
2.10 / 10.5
0.10 / 0.5
0.10 / 0.5
0.10 / 0.5
0.21 / 1.1
0.21 / 1.1
0.21 / 1.1
0.01 / 0.1
0.01 / 0.1
0.01 / 0.1
50.0
2.10 / 10.5
2.10 / 10.5
2.10 / 10.5
0.10 / 0.5
0.10 / 0.5
0.10 / 0.5
0.21 / 1.1
0.21 / 1.1
0.21 / 1.1
0.01 / 0.1
0.01 / 0.1
0.01 / 0.1
--
50.0
--
50.0
---
3TERM
Normal
---
3TERM
Normal
--
Off
--
Off
2.10 / 10.5
2.10 / 10.5
0.10 / 0.5
0.10 / 0.5
0.10 / 0.5
0.21 / 1.1
0.21 / 1.1
0.21 / 1.1
0.01 / 0.1
0.01 / 0.1
0.01 / 0.1
50.0
-2.10 / 10.5
-2.10 / 10.5
-2.10 / 10.5
-0.10 / 0.5
-0.10 / 0.5
-0.10 / 0.5
-0.21 / 1.1
-0.21 / 1.1
-0.21 / 1.1
-0.01 / 0.1
-0.01 / 0.1
-0.01 / 0.1
-50.0
-2.10 / 10.5
-2.10 / 10.5
-2.10 / 10.5
-0.10 / 0.5
-0.10 / 0.5
-0.10 / 0.5
-0.21 / 1.1
-0.21 / 1.1
-0.21 / 1.1
-0.01 / 0.1
-0.01 / 0.1
-0.01 / 0.1
--
50.0
B
Master
-3TERM
-Normal
On
Off
-Off
User
Settiing
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Relay and Protection Scheme Setting Sheet
Name
Range
Units
Contents
63
64
65
66
67
B.SYN1
B.SYN2
GPSBAK
AUTO2B
SRC
5A rating
1A rating
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Disable - I
68
PDTD
200 - 2000
us
69
70
71
72
73
RYID
RYID1
RYID2
TDSV
TCDT1
0 - 63
0 - 63
0 - 63
100 - 16000
-10000 - +10000
us
us
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
101
102
103
TCDT2
TPMODE
STUB
DIFG
OST
OCBT
OCIBT
MOCI
EFBT
EFBTAL
EFIBT
MEFI
BF1
BF2
BFEXT
THMT
THMAL
TTSW1
TTSW2
RDIF
T.F.C
OTD
DIF-FS
DIFG-FS
LSSV
SVCNT
CTSV
IDSV
CTFEN
CTFCNT
-10000 - +10000
3PH - 1PH - MPH
Off - On
Off - On
Off - Trip - BO
Off - On
Off - On
Long - Std - Very - Ext
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Long - Std - Very - Ext
Off - T - TOC
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - Trip - BO
Off - Trip - BO
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - OC - OCD Both
Off - On
Off - On
ALM&BLK - ALM
Off - ALM&BLK - ALM
Off - ALM&BLK - ALM
Off - On - OPT-On
NA - BLK
104
AOLED
Off - On
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
124
125
DIFI1
DIFI2
DIFGI
DIFIC
Vn
TDIFG
DIFSV
TIDSV
CBF
OCBF
TBF1
TBF2
OC
OC
TOC
OC1
OCD
OCI
OCI
TOCI
TOCIR
EF
EF
TEF
EFD
A
A
A
A
V
s
A
s
A
ms
ms
A
s
A
A
A
s
A
s
A
NO-ARC,NO-FD
2TERM 3TERM
1CB-ARC,NO-FD
2TERM
3TERM
101, 102 111, 112 201 202 211 212
--
On
--
On
--
0
3PH
Off
---
--
--
--
On
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
--Off
Off
On
--
-Off
Off
--
Off
Off
ALM&BLK
Off
Off
---
Off
NA
On
-5.00 / 1.00
15.0 / 3.0
2.50 / 0.50
0.00 / 0.00
110
0.50
0.50 / 0.10
10
4.0 /0.8
150
200
10.0 / 2.0
3.00
1.0 / 0.2
0.04 / 0.08
10.0 / 2.0
0.50
0.0
5.0 / 1.0
3.00
0.20 / 0.04
-----
0
Off
----
--
On
On
Std
On
On
On
Std
On
Off
0
0
0
6000
0
On
1000
0
0
0
6000
0
--
EF back-up trip
EF back-up trip alarm
EFI back-up trip
CBF re-trip
CBF related trip
CBF initiation by ext. trip
Thermal trip enable
Thermal alarm enable
Transfer trip selection (CH1)
Transfer trip selection (CH2)
1000
--
Off
----
IDMT OC element
ditto
OC definite time reset delay
Earth fault OC element
Earth fault OCD element
303
1CB-ARC,NO-FD
2TERM
3TERM
204 206 214 216
On
-On
On
Off
I
Off
--
Off
0
-Off
On
Off
On
On
Std
On
On
On
Std
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
On
-Off
Off
Off
Off
ALM&BLK
Off
Off
Off
NA
On
5.00 / 1.00
15.0 / 3.0
2.50 / 0.50
0.00 / 0.00
110
0.50
0.50 / 0.10
10
4.0 /0.8
150
200
10.0 / 2.0
3.00
1.0 / 0.2
0.04 / 0.08
10.0 / 2.0
0.50
0.0
5.0 / 1.0
3.00
0.20 / 0.04
User
Settiing
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Relay and Protection Scheme Setting Sheet
Default Setting of Relay Series(5A rating / 1A rating)
Name
Range
Units
Contents
NO-ARC,NO-FD
2TERM 3TERM
126
EFI
EFI
5A rating
1A rating
0.5 - 5.0
0.10 - 1.00
127
TEFI
0.05 - 1.00
128
TEFIR
0.0 - 10.0
129 Thermal
THM
2.0 - 10.0
0.40 - 2.00
130
THMIP
0.0 - 5.0
0.00 - 1.00
131
TTHM
0.5 - 300.0
132
THMA
50 - 99
133
OCCHK
0.5 - 5.0
0.10 - 1.00
2TERM
2CB-ARC,NO-FD
3TERM
202
211
212
2TERM
301
302
3TERM
312
401
411
2CB-ARC,FD
2TERM
501
1CB-ARC,NO-FD
3TERM
503
511
513
2TERM
204
206
214
5.0 / 1.0
5.0 / 1.0
ditto
0.50
0.50
0.0
5.0 / 1.00
--
5.0 / 1.00
0.0 / 0.00
--
0.0 / 0.00
10.0
--
10.0
80
--
HYS
CFID
136
CFUV
20 - 60
137
CFDV
1 - 10
138
CFOVG
0.1 - 10.0
0.0
80
0.5 / 0.10
0.5 / 0.10
--
0.50 / 0.10
0.50 / 0.10
--
20
20
--
--
1.0
1.0
--
SPAR&TPAR
SPAR&TPAR
(Off) - Disable - SPAR - TPAR 139 Autoreclose mode SPAR&TPAR - MPAR2 - MPAR3 -
EXT1P - EXT3P - EXTMP
Autoreclosing mode
140
ARC-CB
ONE - O1 - 02 - L1 - L2
--
141
ARC-EXT
Off - On
--
142
ARCDIFG
Off - On
--
Off
Off
143
ARC-BU
Off - On
--
Off
Off
1CB
Off - LB - DB - SY
TPAR condition
2CB
144
VCHK
--
L1
--
L1
Off
--
LB
-- (SY)
LB
-- (SY)
--
LB1
--
LB1
--
ARC-SM
Off - S2 - S3 - S4
146
ARC-CCB
147
ARC-SUC
Off - On
--
Off
Off
148
MA-NOLK
FT - T - S+T
--
FT
FT
149
VTPHSEL
A-B -C
VT phase selection
--
150
VT-RATE
PH/G - PH/PH
VT rating
--
PH/G
PH/G
Line
--
Off
LB
145
--
-Off
--
--
MPAR
Off
--
MPAR
--
151
3PH-VT
Bus - Line
3ph. VT location
--
Line
152
UARCSW
P1 - P2 - P3
--
P1
P1
153
TEVLV
0.01 - 10.00
--
0.30
0.30
154
TRDY1
5 - 300
Reclaim timer
--
60
60
155
TSPR1
0.01 - 10.00
--
0.80
0.80
156
TTPR1
0.01 - 100.00
--
0.60
0.60
157
TMPR1
0.01 - 10.00
--
0.80
0.80
158
TRR
0.01 - 100.00
--
2.00
2.00
159
TW1
0.1 - 10.0
--
0.2
160
TRDY2
5 - 300
Reclaim timer
--
--
60
--
60
--
161
TSPR2
0.01 - 10.00
--
--
0.80
--
0.80
--
162
TTPR2
0.1 - 10.0
--
--
0.1
--
0.1
--
163
TMPR2
0.01 - 10.00
--
--
0.80
--
0.80
--
164
TW2
0.1 - 10.0
--
--
0.2
--
0.2
165
TS2
5.0 - 300.0
--
166
TS2R
5.0 - 300.0
--
30.0
30.0
167
TS3
5.0 - 300.0
--
20.0
20.0
168
TS3R
5.0 - 300.0
--
30.0
30.0
169
TS4
5.0 - 300.0
--
20.0
20.0
170
TS4R
5.0 - 300.0
--
30.0
30.0
171
TSUC
0.1 - 10.0
--
3.0
3.0
172
OVB
10 - 150
OV element
--
51
51
173
UVB
10 - 150
UV element
--
13
13
174
OVL1
10 - 150
OV element
--
51
51
175
UVL1
10 - 150
UV element
--
13
13
176
SY1UV
10 - 150
--
83
83
177
SY1OV
10 - 150
178
SY1
5 - 75
179
TSYN1
0.01 - 10.00
180
TDBL1
0.01 - 1.00
181
TLBD1
0.01 - 1.00
20.0
0.2
-20.0
--
51
51
--
30
30
--
1.00
1.00
--
0.05
0.05
--
0.05
0.05
304
User
3TERM
134
0.05 - 1.00
2TERM
1-5
1CB-ARC,FD
3TERM
135
0.25 - 5.00
1CB-ARC,NO-FD
216
Settiing
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Relay and Protection Scheme Setting Sheet
Default Setting of Relay Series(5A rating / 1A rating)
Name
Range
Units
Contents
NO-ARC,NO-FD
2TERM 3TERM
5A rating
1A rating
1CB-ARC,NO-FD
2TERM
2CB-ARC,NO-FD
3TERM
202
211
212
2TERM
301
1CB-ARC,FD
3TERM
302
312
2TERM
3TERM
401
411
2CB-ARC,FD
2TERM
501
1CB-ARC,NO-FD
3TERM
503
511
513
2TERM
204
206
214
182
T3PLL
0.01 - 1.00
--
183
OVL2
10 - 150
OV element
--
--
51
--
51
184
UVL2
10 - 150
UV element
--
--
13
--
13
--
185
SY2UV
10 - 150
--
--
83
--
83
--
186
SY2OV
10 - 150
187
SY2
5 - 75
188
TSYN2
0.01 - 10.00
189
TDBL2
0.01 - 1.00
190
TLBD2
0.01 - 1.00
191
BISW1
Norm - Inv
192
BISW2
Norm - Inv
193
BISW3
Norm - Inv
194
BISW4
195
0.05
User
3TERM
216
0.05
--
--
--
51
--
51
--
--
--
30
--
30
--
--
--
1.00
--
1.00
--
--
--
0.05
--
0.05
--
--
--
0.05
--
0.05
--
Binary input
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
ditto
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
ditto
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm - Inv
ditto
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
BISW5
Norm - Inv
ditto
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
196
BISW6
Norm - Inv
ditto
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
197
BISW7
Norm - Inv
ditto
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
198
BISW8
Norm - Inv
ditto
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
199
BISW9
Norm - Inv
ditto
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
200
BISW10
Norm - Inv
ditto
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
201
BISW11
Norm - Inv
ditto
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
202
BISW12
Norm - Inv
ditto
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
203
BISW13
Norm - Inv
ditto
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
--
204
BISW14
Norm - Inv
ditto
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
--
205
BISW15
Norm - Inv
ditto
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
--
206
BISW16
Norm - Inv
ditto
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
207
BISW17
Norm - Inv
ditto
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
208
BISW18
Norm - Inv
ditto
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
209
BISW19
Norm - Inv
ditto
--
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
210
BISW20
Norm - Inv
ditto
--
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
211
BISW21
Norm - Inv
ditto
--
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
212
BISW22
Norm - Inv
ditto
--
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
213
BISW23
Norm - Inv
ditto
--
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
214
BISW24
Norm - Inv
ditto
--
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
215
BISW25
Norm - Inv
ditto
--
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
216
BISW26
Norm - Inv
ditto
--
--
Norm
--
Norm
--
Norm
Norm
Norm
--
Norm
--
Norm
217
BISW27
Norm - Inv
ditto
--
--
Norm
--
Norm
--
Norm
Norm
Norm
--
Norm
--
Norm
218
BISW28
Norm - Inv
ditto
--
--
Norm
--
Norm
--
Norm
Norm
Norm
--
Norm
--
Norm
219
BISW34
Norm - Inv
ditto
--
--
Norm
--
Norm
--
Norm
--
--
--
Norm
--
Norm
Norm
220
BISW35
Norm - Inv
ditto
--
--
Norm
--
Norm
--
Norm
--
--
--
Norm
--
Norm
221
BISW36
Norm - Inv
ditto
--
--
Norm
--
Norm
--
Norm
--
--
--
Norm
--
Norm
Configurable LEDs
222
Logic
OR - AND
OR
OR
223
Reset
Inst - Latch
Inst
Inst
224
In #1
0 - 3071
225
In #2
0 - 3071
226
In #3
0 - 3071
227
In #4
0 - 3071
Logic
OR - AND
OR
OR
229
Reset
Inst - Latch
Inst
Inst
230
In #1
0 - 3071
231
In #2
0 - 3071
232
In #3
0 - 3071
233
In #4
0 - 3071
Logic
OR - AND
OR
OR
235
Reset
Inst - Latch
Inst
Inst
236
In #1
0 - 3071
237
In #2
0 - 3071
238
In #3
0 - 3071
239
In #4
0 - 3071
Logic
OR - AND
OR
OR
241
Reset
Inst - Latch
Inst
Inst
242
In #1
0 - 3071
243
In #2
0 - 3071
244
In #3
0 - 3071
245
In #4
0 - 3071
228
234
240
LED1
LED2
LED3
LED4
Configurable LEDs
Configurable LEDs
Configurable LEDs
305
Settiing
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Relay and Protection Scheme Setting Sheet
Name
Range
246
Plant name
Specified by user
247
248
249
250
251
252
253
254
255
256
257
258
259
260
261
262
263
264
265
Description
HDLC
IEC
SYADJ
PRTCL1
IP1-1
IP1-2
IP1-3
IP1-4
SM1-1
SM1-2
SM1-3
SM1-4
GW1-1
GW1-2
GW1-3
GW1-4
232C
IECBR
ditto
1 - 32
0 - 254
-9999 - 9999
HDLC - IEC103
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 255
0 - 255
0 - 255
0 - 255
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
9.6 - 19.2 - 38.4 - 57.6
9.6 - 19.2
266
IECBLK
Normal - Blocked
267
Fault locator
Off - On
268
BITRN
0 - 128
269
270
271
272
Time
OCP-S
OCP-G
UVP-S
0.1 - 3.0
0.5 - 250.0
0.1 - 50.0
0.5 - 250.0
0.1 - 50.0
0 - 132
s
A
A
V
Disturbance record
OC element for disturbance
recorder initiation
UV element for disturbance
--
273
274
275
276
277
UVP-G
TRIP
OCP-S
OCP-G
UVP-S
0 - 76
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
recorder initiation
--
Disturbance trigger
ditto
ditto
ditto
278
UVP-G
Off - On
279
280
Display value
Power(P/Q)
281
5A rating
Units
Contents
1A rating
NO-ARC,NO-FD
2TERM 3TERM
1CB-ARC,NO-FD
2TERM
3TERM
101, 102 111, 112 201 202 211 212
Plant name
ms
Specified by user
Specified by user
Specified by user
1
2
0
HDLC
192
168
19
172
255
255
255
0
192
168
19
1
9.6
19.2
Specified by user
1
2
0
HDLC
192
168
19
172
255
255
255
0
192
168
19
1
9.6
19.2
Normal
Normal
--
On
1CB-ARC,NO-FD
2TERM
3TERM
204 206 214 216
On
100
100
1.0
10.0 / 2.0
5.0 / 1.0
1.0
10.0 / 2.0
5.0 / 1.0
88
88
51
On
On
On
--
On
--
51
On
On
On
On
Primary - Secondary
Send - Receive
ditto
Metering
Metering
On
On
Send
Primary
Send
--
Current
Lag - Lead
Metering
--
282
Sync
Time
Off
Lead
Lead
Off
283
GMT
-12 - +12
hrs Time
Primary
306
User
Settiing
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Event record
No.
Name
Range
Unit
Signal No.
Signal name
Type
EV1
0 - 3071
Contents
1536
CB1 A
On/Off
EV2
0 - 3071
ditto
1537
CB1 B
On/Off
EV3
0 - 3071
ditto
1538
CB1 C
On/Off
EV4
0 - 3071
ditto
1539
CB2 A
On/Off
EV5
0 - 3071
ditto
1540
CB2 B
On/Off
EV6
0 - 3071
ditto
1541
CB2 C
On/Off
EV7
0 - 3071
ditto
1542
DS
On/Off
EV8
0 - 3071
ditto
1544
Dif.block
On/Off
On/Off
EV9
0 - 3071
ditto
1550
BU block
10
EV10
0 - 3071
ditto
1545
Ext.close
On/Off
11
EV11
0 - 3071
ditto
1546
DC supply
On/Off
12
EV12
0 - 3071
ditto
1547
Trans.trip1
On/Off
13
EV13
0 - 3071
ditto
1548
Trans.trip2
On/Off
14
EV14
0 - 3071
ditto
1549
Ind. reset
On/Off
15
EV15
0 - 3071
ditto
1552
Ext.trip A
On/Off
16
EV16
0 - 3071
ditto
1553
Ext.trip B
On/Off
17
EV17
0 - 3071
ditto
1554
Ext.trip C
On/Off
18
EV18
0 - 3071
ditto
1571
CB1 ready
On/Off
19
EV19
0 - 3071
ditto
1572
CB2 ready
On/Off
20
EV20
0 - 3071
ditto
1573
ARC block
On/Off
21
EV21
0 - 3071
ditto
446
Trip
On/Off
22
EV22
0 - 3071
ditto
177
CB1 ARC
On/Off
23
EV23
0 - 3071
ditto
178
CB2 ARC
On/Off
24
EV24
0 - 3071
ditto
231
Relay fail
On/Off
25
EV25
0 - 3071
ditto
1268
V0 err
On/Off
26
EV26
0 - 3071
ditto
1269
V2 err
On/Off
27
EV27
0 - 3071
ditto
1267
I0 err
On/Off
28
EV28
0 - 3071
ditto
235
DS fail
On/Off
29
EV29
0 - 3071
ditto
214
Com1 fail
On/Off
30
EV30
0 - 3071
ditto
215
Sync1 fail
On/Off
31
EV31
0 - 3071
ditto
220
Com2 fail
On/Off
32
EV32
0 - 3071
ditto
221
Sync2 fail
On/Off
33
EV33
0 - 3071
ditto
447
Term1 rdy
On/Off
34
EV34
0 - 3071
ditto
448
Term2 rdy
On/Off
35
EV35
0 - 3071
ditto
272
On/Off
36
EV36
0 - 3071
ditto
289
Angle over
On/Off
On/Off
37
EV37
0 - 3071
ditto
1513
RYID1 err
38
EV38
0 - 3071
ditto
1514
RYID2 err
On/Off
39
EV39
0 - 3071
ditto
1511
Td1 over
On/Off
On/Off
40
EV40
0 - 3071
ditto
1512
Td2 over
41
EV41
0 - 3071
ditto
1503
CLK1 fail
On/Off
42
EV42
0 - 3071
ditto
1504
CLK2 fail
On/Off
43
EV43
0 - 3071
ditto
1507
TX level1 err
On/Off
44
EV44
0 - 3071
ditto
1508
TX level2 err
On/Off
45
EV45
0 - 3071
ditto
1509
RX level1 err
On/Off
46
EV46
0 - 3071
ditto
1510
RX level2 err
On/Off
47
EV47
0 - 3071
ditto
1501
Com1 fail-R
On/Off
48
EV48
0 - 3071
ditto
1502
Com2 fail-R
On/Off
49
EV49
0 - 3071
ditto
489
AS1
On/Off
50
EV50
0 - 3071
ditto
490
AS2
On/Off
51
EV51
0 - 3071
ditto
228
RDIF1
On/Off
52
EV52
0 - 3071
ditto
229
RDIF2
On/Off
53
EV53
0 - 3071
ditto
1266
CT err
On/Off
54
EV54
0 - 3071
ditto
1256
Id err
On/Off
55
EV55
0 - 3071
ditto
496
CTF
On/Off
56
EV56
0 - 3071
ditto
493
AF1
On/Off
57
EV57
0 - 3071
ditto
494
AF2
On/Off
58
EV58
0 - 3071
ditto
1271
I0-C err
On/Off
59
EV59
0 - 3071
ditto
1273
CT-C err
On/Off
60
EV60
0 - 3071
ditto
61
EV61
0 - 3071
ditto
62
EV62
0 - 3071
ditto
63
EV63
0 - 3071
ditto
64
EV64
0 - 3071
ditto
307
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Event record
No.
Name
Range
Unit
65
EV65
0 - 3071
ditto
Contents
Signal No.
0
Signal name
Type
66
EV66
0 - 3071
ditto
67
EV67
0 - 3071
ditto
68
EV68
0 - 3071
ditto
69
EV69
0 - 3071
ditto
70
EV70
0 - 3071
ditto
71
EV71
0 - 3071
ditto
72
EV72
0 - 3071
ditto
73
EV73
0 - 3071
ditto
74
EV74
0 - 3071
ditto
75
EV75
0 - 3071
ditto
76
EV76
0 - 3071
ditto
77
EV77
0 - 3071
ditto
78
EV78
0 - 3071
ditto
79
EV79
0 - 3071
ditto
80
EV80
0 - 3071
ditto
81
EV81
0 - 3071
ditto
82
EV82
0 - 3071
ditto
83
EV83
0 - 3071
ditto
84
EV84
0 - 3071
ditto
85
EV85
0 - 3071
ditto
86
EV86
0 - 3071
ditto
87
EV87
0 - 3071
ditto
88
EV88
0 - 3071
ditto
89
EV89
0 - 3071
ditto
90
EV90
0 - 3071
ditto
91
EV91
0 - 3071
ditto
92
EV92
0 - 3071
ditto
93
EV93
0 - 3071
ditto
94
EV94
0 - 3071
ditto
95
EV95
0 - 3071
ditto
96
EV96
0 - 3071
ditto
97
EV97
0 - 3071
ditto
98
EV98
0 - 3071
ditto
99
EV99
0 - 3071
ditto
100
EV100
0 - 3071
ditto
101
EV101
0 - 3071
ditto
2640
102
EV102
0 - 3071
SET.GROUP1
On
ditto
2641
SET.GROUP2
103
EV103
0 - 3071
On
ditto
2642
SET.GROUP3
104
EV104
On
0 - 3071
ditto
2643
SET.GROUP4
105
On
EV105
0 - 3071
ditto
2644
SET.GROUP5
On
106
EV106
0 - 3071
ditto
2645
SET.GROUP6
On
107
EV107
0 - 3071
ditto
2646
SET.GROUP7
On
108
EV108
0 - 3071
ditto
2647
SET.GROUP8
On
109
EV109
0 - 3071
ditto
1448
On
110
EV110
0 - 3071
ditto
1449
On
111
EV111
0 - 3071
ditto
1450
On
112
EV112
0 - 3071
ditto
950
MODE0
On
113
EV113
0 - 3071
ditto
951
MODE1
On
114
EV114
0 - 3071
ditto
952
MODE2A-GPS
On
115
EV115
0 - 3071
ditto
953
MODE2A-Td
On
116
EV116
0 - 3071
ditto
954
MODE2A-CF
On
117
EV117
0 - 3071
ditto
955
MODE2A-ANGLE
On
118
EV118
0 - 3071
ditto
957
MODE2B
On
119
EV119
0 - 3071
ditto
1445
On
120
EV120
0 - 3071
ditto
956
MODE2A-REMOT E
On
121
EV121
0 - 3071
ditto
1409
LED RST
On
122
EV122
0 - 3071
ditto
1435
F.record_CLR
On
123
EV123
0 - 3071
ditto
124
EV124
0 - 3071
ditto
1436
E.record_CLR
On
125
EV125
0 - 3071
ditto
1437
D.record_CLR
On
126
EV126
0 - 3071
ditto
127
EV127
0 - 3071
ditto
128
EV128
0 - 3071
ditto
308
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Disturbance record
No.
Name
Range
Unit
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
SIG1
SIG2
SIG3
SIG4
SIG5
SIG6
SIG7
SIG8
SIG9
SIG10
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
SIG11
SIG12
SIG13
SIG14
SIG15
SIG16
SIG17
SIG18
SIG19
SIG20
SIG21
SIG22
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
SIG23
SIG24
SIG25
SIG26
SIG27
SIG28
SIG29
SIG30
SIG31
SIG32
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
Contents
Default
Signal No.
99
100
101
102
103
104
82
83
84
86
Signal name
CB1_TRIP-A
CB1_TRIP-B
CB1_TRIP-C
CB2_TRIP-A
CB2_TRIP-B
CB2_TRIP-C
DIF-A_TRIP
DIF-B_TRIP
DIF-C_TRIP
DIFG_TRIP
87
92
53
177
178
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540
1541
1542
OST_TRIP
CBF_TRIP
RELAY_BLOCK
ARC1
ARC2
CB1_CONT-A
CB1_CONT-B
CB1_CONT-C
CB2_CONT-A
CB2_CONT-B
CB2_CONT-C
DS_N/O_CONT
1571
1572
113
114
115
117
0
0
0
0
CB1_READY
CB2_READY
OC_TRIP
OCI_TRIP
EF_TRIP
EFI_TRIP
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
309
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
-
9
-
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
-
9
9
9
9
9 9 9 9
9 9 9 9
9 9 9 9
- 9
- 9
- 9
- 9
- 9
- 9
9 9 9 9
9 9 9 9
9 9 9 9
9 9 9 9
9 9 9 9
9 9 9 9
9 9 9 9
9 9 9 9
- 9
- 9
9 9 9 9
9 9 9 9
9 9 9 9
- 9
- 9
- 9
- 9
- 9
- 9
9 9 9 9
9 9 9 9
- 9
- 9
9 9 9 9
9 9 9 9
9 9 9 9
9 9 9 9
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
PLC Default Setting: GRL100-B1-04
Output
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540
1541
1542
1543
1544
1545
1546
1547
1548
1549
1550
1551
1552
1553
1554
1555
1556
1557
1558
1559
1560
1561
1562
1563
1564
1565
1566
1567
1568
1569
1570
1571
1572
1573
1574
1575
1576
1577
1578
1579
1580
1581
1582
1583
1584
1585
1586
1587
1588
1589
1590
1591
1592
1593
1594
1595
1596
1597
1598
1599
1600
1601
1602
1603
1604
1605
1606
1607
1608
1609
1610
Signal
Timing
Cycle
30
90
User
Logic ex pression
Turn
Model 1x 1, 1x 2, 2x 1, 2x 2, 3x 1, 3x 2, 4x 1, 5x 1,
5x 3
[513]BI1_COMMAND
[514]BI2_COMMAND
[515]BI3_COMMAND
Norm
Back
Release
Up
Signal
Timer
Off
On
One
Time Value
None
CB1_CONT-A
CB1_CONT-B
CB1_CONT-C
CB2_CONT-A
CB2_CONT-B
CB2_CONT-C
DS_N/O_CONT
DS_N/C_CONT
CRT_BLOCK
CB_CLOSE
DC_SUPPLY
85S1
85S2
IND.RESET
BUT_BLOCK
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
EXT_TRIP-A
EXT_TRIP-B
EXT_TRIP-C
X
X
X
[528]BI16_COMMAND
[529]BI17_COMMAND
[530]BI18_COMMAND
X
X
X
EXT_CBFIN-A
EXT_CBFIN-B
EXT_CBFIN-C
X
X
X
[528]BI16_COMMAND
[529]BI17_COMMAND
[530]BI18_COMMAND
X
X
X
INT.LINK1-A
INT.LINK1-B
INT.LINK1-C
CB1_READY
CB2_READY
ARC_RESET
ARC_BLOCK
INT.LINK2-A
INT.LINK2-B
INT.LINK2-C
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
[516]BI4_COMMAND
[517]BI5_COMMAND
[518]BI6_COMMAND
---[519]BI7_COMMAND
[520]BI8_COMMAND
[521]BI9_COMMAND
[522]BI10_COMMAND
[523]BI11_COMMAND
[1295]BI12_COM_UF
[1296]BI13_COM_UF
[526]BI14_COMMAND
[527]BI15_COMMAND
[1287]BI4_COM_UF
[517]BI5_COMMAND
[518]BI6_COMMAND
[531]BI19_COMMAND
[532]BI20_COMMAND
[533]BI21_COMMAND
----
[534]BI22_COMMAND
[535]BI23_COMMAND
[536]BI24_COMMAND
[87]OST_TRIP + [91]CBFDET + [98]STUB + [417]THM_TRIP + [418]TR1_TRIP + [426]TR2_TRIP
[538]BI26_COMMAND
-[539]BI27_COMMAND
-[540]BI28_COMMAND
--
PROT_BLOCK
DIF_BLOCK
DIFG_BLOCK
OST_BLOCK
CBF_BLOCK
OC_BLOCK
OCI_BLOCK
EF_BLOCK
EFI_BLOCK
THMA_BLOCK
THM_BLOCK
TR1_BLOCK
TR2_BLOCK
EXTTP_BLOCK
RDIF_BLOCK
ARC_OFF
ARC_SPAR
ARC_TPAR
ARC_S&T
ARC_MAPR2
ARC_MPAR3
ARC_EXT1P
ARC_EXT3P
ARC_EXTMP
310
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
PLC Default Setting
Output
1611
1612
1613
1614
1615
1616
1617
1618
1619
1620
1621
1622
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628
1629
1630
1631
1632
1633
1634
1635
1636
1637
1638
1639
1640
1641
1642
1643
1644
1645
1646
1647
1648
1649
1650
1651
1652
1653
1654
1655
1656
1657
1658
1659
1660
1661
1662
1663
1664
1665
1666
1667
1668
1669
1670
1671
1672
1673
1674
1675
1676
1677
1678
1679
1680
1681
1682
1683
1684
1685
Signal
DIF-A_FS
DIF-B_FS
DIF-C_FS
DIFG_FS
TP-A_DELAY
TP-B_DELAY
TP-C_DELAY
R.DATA_ZERO
RDIF-A_FS
RDIF-B_FS
RDIF-C_FS
Timing
Cycle
30
90
User
Logic ex pression
Turn
Model 1x 1, 1x 2, 2x 1, 2x 2, 3x 1, 3x 2, 4x 1, 5x 1,
5x 3
Norm
Back
Release
Up
Signal
Timer
Off
On
One
Time Value
None
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
[408]DIFFS_OP
[408]DIFFS_OP
[408]DIFFS_OP
[412]DIFGFS_OP
[435]TP-A
[436]TP-B
[437]TP-C
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
[408]DIFFS_OP + [412]DIFGFS_OP
[408]DIFFS_OP + [412]DIFGFS_OP
[408]DIFFS_OP + [412]DIFGFS_OP
X
X
X
[1]CONSTANT_1
[1]CONSTANT_1
X
X
X
X
X
60
60
60
ms
ms
ms
INIT_MODE2B
DIFG_INST_TP
OC_INST_TP
EF_INST_TP
DIF_3PTP
RDIF_3PTP
OC_3PTP
OCI_3PTP
X
X
2
2
TR1_3PTP
TR2_3PTP
3P_TRIP
DIF-A-R1
DIF-B-R1
DIF-C-R1
DIFG-R1
X
X
X
X
[1088]COM1-R1
[1089]COM2-R1
[1090]COM3-R1
[1106]SUB_COM3-R1
X
X
X
X
85R1-R1
85R2-R1
ARC_BLOCK-R1
L.TEST-R1
TFC_ON-R1
X
X
X
X
X
[1091]COM4-R1
[1092]COM5-R1
[1104]SUB_COM1-R1
[1105]SUB_COM2-R1
[1107]SUB_COM4-R1
X
X
X
X
X
I.LINK-A-R1
I.LINK-B-R1
I.LINK-C-R1
X
X
X
X
X
X
RDIF-A-R1
RDIF-B-R1
311
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
PLC Default Setting
Output
1686
1687
1688
1689
1690
1691
1692
1693
1694
1695
1696
1697
1698
1699
1700
1701
1702
1703
1704
1705
1706
1707
1708
1709
1710
1711
1712
1713
1714
1715
1716
1717
1718
1719
1720
1721
1722
1723
1724
1725
1726
1727
1728
1729
1730
1731
1732
1733
1734
1735
1736
1737
1738
1739
1740
1741
1742
1743
1744
1745
1746
1747
1748
1749
1750
1751
1752
1753
1754
1755
1756
:
:
:
1780
Signal
Timing
Cycle
30
90
User
Logic ex pression
Turn
Model 1x 1, 1x 2, 2x 1, 2x 2, 3x 1, 3x 2, 4x 1, 5x 1,
5x 3
Norm
Back
Release
Up
Signal
Timer
Off
On
One
Time Value
None
RDIF-C-R1
RDIF-R1
TR1-A-R1
TR1-B-R1
TR1-C-R1
TR2-A-R1
TR2-B-R1
TR2-C-R1
DIF-A-R2
DIF-B-R2
DIF-C-R2
DIFG-R2
X
X
X
X
[1128]COM1-R2
[1129]COM2-R2
[1130]COM3-R2
[1146]SUB_COM3-R2
X
X
X
X
85R1-R2
85R2-R2
ARC_BLOCK-R2
L.TEST-R2
TFC_ON-R2
X
X
X
X
X
[1131]COM4-R2
[1132]COM5-R2
[1144]SUB_COM1-R2
[1145]SUB_COM2-R2
[1147]SUB_COM4-R2
X
X
X
X
X
I.LINK-A-R2
I.LINK-B-R2
I.LINK-C-R2
X
X
X
X
X
X
RDIF-A-R2
RDIF-B-R2
RDIF-C-R2
RDIF-R2
TR1-A-R2
TR1-B-R2
TR1-C-R2
TR2-A-R2
TR2-B-R2
TR2-C-R2
OC-A_FS
OC-B_FS
OC-C_FS
X
X
X
0
0
0
[1]CONSTANT_1
[1]CONSTANT_1
[1]CONSTANT_1
X
X
X
OCI-A_FS
OCI-B_FS
OCI-C_FS
X
X
X
1
1
1
[1]CONSTANT_1
[1]CONSTANT_1
[1]CONSTANT_1
X
X
X
312
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
PLC Default Setting
Output
Signal
1781
1782
1783
1784
1785
1786
1787
1788
1789
1790
1791
1792 IO#1-TP-A1
1793 IO#1-TP-B1
1794 IO#1-TP-C1
1795 IO#1-TP-A2
1796 IO#1-TP-B2
1797 IO#1-TP-C2
1798
1799
1800
1801
1802
1803
1804
1805
1806
1807
1808
1809
1810
1811
1812
1813
1814
1815
1816
1817
1818
1819
1820
1821
1822
1823
1824 SPR.L-REQ
1825 TPR.L-REQ
1826 MPR.L-REQ
1827 SPR.F-REQ
1828 TPR.F-REQ
1829 MPR.F-REQ
1830 SPR.F-ST.REQ
1831 TPR.F-ST.REQ
1832 MPR.F-ST.REQ
1833
1834
1835
1836 R.F-ST.REQ
1837
1838
1839
1840 ARC.L_TERM
1841 ARC.F_TERM
1842
1843
1844
1845
1846
1847
1848
1849
1850
1851
:
:
:
2045
Timing
Cycle
30
90
User
Logic expression
Turn
[99]TRIP-A1
[100]TRIP-B1
[101]TRIP-C1
X
X
X
X
X
X
[102]TRIP-A2
[103]TRIP-B2
[104]TRIP-C2
----
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
0
0
0
2
2
2
1
1
1
[1]CONSTANT_1
[159]SYN-OP
[1]CONSTANT_1
[1]CONSTANT_1
[159]SYN-OP
[1]CONSTANT_1
[1]CONSTANT_1
[477]ARC-SET + [478]CCB-SET
[1]CONSTANT_1
[0]CONSTANT_0
X
X
0
0
[0]CONSTANT_0
[0]CONSTANT_0
313
X
X
X
X
X
X
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
PLC Default Setting
Output
2046
2047
2048
2049
2050
2051
2052
2053
2054
2055
2056
2057
2058
2059
2060
2061
2062
2063
2064
2065
2066
2067
2068
2069
2070
2071
2072
2073
2074
2075
2076
2077
2078
2079
2080
2081
2082
2083
2084
2085
2086
2087
2088
2089
2090
2091
2092
2093
2094
2095
2096
2097
2098
2099
2100
2101
2102
2103
2104
2105
2106
2107
2108
2109
2110
2111
2112
2113
2114
2115
2116
2117
2118
2119
2120
Signal
Timing
Cycle
30
90
User
Logic ex pression
Turn
Model 1x 1, 1x 2, 2x 1, 2x 2, 3x 1, 3x 2, 4x 1, 5x 1,
5x 3
Norm
Flip Flop
Back
Release
Up
Signal
Off
On
Timer
One
Time Value
None
COM1-S
COM2-S
COM3-S
COM4-S
COM5-S
X
X
X
X
X
[41]DIF-A
[42]DIF-B
[43]DIF-C
[1547]85S1
[1548]85S2
X
X
X
X
X
SUB_COM1-S
SUB_COM2-S
SUB_COM3-S
SUB_COM4-S
SUB_COM5-S
X
X
X
X
[1573]ARC_RESET
[434]LOCAL_TEST
[44]DIFG
[450]TFC_ON
X
X
X
X
SUB2_COM1-S
SUB2_COM2-S
SUB2_COM3-S
SUB2_COM4-S
SUB2_COM5-S
SUB2_COM6-S
SUB2_COM7-S
SUB2_COM8-S
SUB2_COM9-S
SUB2_COM10-S
SUB2_COM11-S
SUB2_COM12-S
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
[443]I.LINK-A
[444]I.LINK-B
[445]I.LINK-C
[443]I.LINK-A
[444]I.LINK-B
[445]I.LINK-C
[443]I.LINK-A
[444]I.LINK-B
[445]I.LINK-C
[443]I.LINK-A
[444]I.LINK-B
[445]I.LINK-C
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
SUB3_COM1-S
SUB3_COM2-S
SUB3_COM3-S
SUB3_COM4-S
SUB3_COM5-S
SUB3_COM6-S
SUB3_COM7-S
SUB3_COM8-S
SUB3_COM9-S
SUB3_COM10-S
SUB3_COM11-S
SUB3_COM12-S
V.COM1-S
V.COM2-S
V.COM3-S
S.V.COM1-S
S.V.COM2-S
S.V.COM3-S
S.V.COM4-S
S.V.COM5-S
S.V.COM6-S
S.V.COM7-S
S.V.COM8-S
S.V.COM9-S
S.V.COM10-S
S.V.COM11-S
S.V.COM12-S
I.COM1-S
I.COM2-S
I.COM3-S
S.I.COM1-S
S.I.COM2-S
S.I.COM3-S
S.I.COM4-S
S.I.COM5-S
314
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
PLC Default Setting
Output
2121
2122
2123
2124
2125
2126
2127
2128
2129
2130
2131
2132
2133
2134
2135
2136
2137
2138
2139
2140
2141
2142
2143
2144
2145
2146
2147
2148
2149
2150
2151
2152
2153
2154
2155
2156
2157
2158
2159
2160
2161
2162
2163
2164
2165
2166
2167
2168
2169
2170
2171
2172
:
:
:
2601
2602
2603
2604
2605
2606
2607
2608
2609
2610
2611
2612
2613
2614
2615
2616
2617
2618
2619
2620
Signal
Timing
Cycle
30
90
User
Logic ex pression
Turn
Model 1x 1, 1x 2, 2x 1, 2x 2, 3x 1, 3x 2, 4x 1, 5x 1,
5x 3
Norm
Flip Flop
Back
Release
Up
Signal
Off
On
Timer
One
Time Value
None
S.I.COM6-S
S.I.COM7-S
S.I.COM8-S
S.I.COM9-S
S.I.COM10-S
S.I.COM11-S
S.I.COM12-S
ALARM_LED_SET
[237]CFSV1-R + [239]CFSV2-R
315
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
PLC Default Setting
Output
2621
2622
2623
2624
2625
2626
2627
2628
2629
2630
2631
2632
2633
2634
2635
2636
2637
2638
2639
2640
2641
2642
2643
2644
2645
2646
2647
2648
2649
2650
2651
2652
2653
2654
2655
2656
2657
2658
2659
2660
2661
2662
2663
2664
2665
2666
2667
2668
2669
2670
2671
2672
2673
2674
2675
2676
2677
2678
2679
2680
2681
2682
2683
2684
2685
2686
2687
2688
2689
2690
2691
2692
:
:
2815
Signal
Timing
Cycle
30
90
User
Logic ex pression
Turn
Model 1x 1, 1x 2, 2x 1, 2x 2, 3x 1, 3x 2, 4x 1, 5x 1,
5x 3
F.RECORD1
F.RECORD2
F.RECORD3
F.RECORD4
D.RECORD1
D.RECORD2
D.RECORD3
D.RECORD4
SET.GROUP1
SET.GROUP2
SET.GROUP3
SET.GROUP4
SET.GROUP5
SET.GROUP6
SET.GROUP7
SET.GROUP8
CON_TPMD1
CON_TPMD2
CON_TPMD3
CON_TPMD4
CON_TPMD5
CON_TPMD6
CON_TPMD7
CON_TPMD8
ARC_COM_RECV
TEL_COM_RECV
PROT_COM_RECV
TPLED_RST_RCV
316
Norm
Flip Flop
Back
Release
Up
Signal
Off
On
Timer
One
Time Value
None
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
PLC Default Setting
Output
2816
2817
2818
2819
2820
2821
2822
2823
2824
2825
2826
2827
2828
2829
2830
2831
2832
2833
2834
2835
2836
2837
2838
2839
2840
2841
2842
2843
2844
2845
2846
2847
2848
2849
2850
2851
2852
2853
2854
2855
2856
2857
2858
2859
2860
2861
2862
2863
2864
2865
2866
2867
2868
2869
2870
2871
2872
2873
2874
2875
2876
2877
2878
2879
2880
2881
2882
2883
2884
2885
2886
2887
2888
2889
2890
Signal
Timing
Cycle
30
90
User
Logic ex pression
Turn
Model 1x 1, 1x 2, 2x 1, 2x 2, 3x 1, 3x 2, 4x 1, 5x 1,
5x 3
TEMP001
TEMP002
TEMP003
TEMP004
TEMP005
TEMP006
TEMP007
TEMP008
TEMP009
TEMP010
TEMP011
TEMP012
TEMP013
TEMP014
TEMP015
TEMP016
TEMP017
TEMP018
TEMP019
TEMP020
TEMP021
TEMP022
TEMP023
TEMP024
TEMP025
TEMP026
TEMP027
TEMP028
TEMP029
TEMP030
TEMP031
TEMP032
TEMP033
TEMP034
TEMP035
TEMP036
TEMP037
TEMP038
TEMP039
TEMP040
TEMP041
TEMP042
TEMP043
TEMP044
TEMP045
TEMP046
TEMP047
TEMP048
TEMP049
TEMP050
TEMP051
TEMP052
TEMP053
TEMP054
TEMP055
TEMP056
TEMP057
TEMP058
TEMP059
TEMP060
TEMP061
TEMP062
TEMP063
TEMP064
TEMP065
TEMP066
TEMP067
TEMP068
TEMP069
TEMP070
TEMP071
TEMP072
TEMP073
TEMP074
TEMP075
317
Norm
Flip Flop
Back
Release
Up
Signal
Off
On
Timer
One
Time Value
None
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
PLC Default Setting
Output
2891
2892
2893
2894
2895
2896
2897
2898
2899
2900
2901
2902
2903
2904
2905
2906
2907
2908
2909
2910
2911
2912
2913
2914
2915
2916
2917
2918
2919
2920
2921
2922
2923
2924
2925
2926
2927
2928
2929
2930
2931
2932
2933
2934
2935
2936
2937
2938
2939
2940
2941
2942
2943
2944
2945
2946
2947
2948
2949
2950
2951
2952
2953
2954
2955
2956
2957
2958
2959
2960
2961
2962
2963
2964
2965
Signal
Timing
Cycle
30
90
User
Logic ex pression
Turn
Model 1x 1, 1x 2, 2x 1, 2x 2, 3x 1, 3x 2, 4x 1, 5x 1,
5x 3
TEMP076
TEMP077
TEMP078
TEMP079
TEMP080
TEMP081
TEMP082
TEMP083
TEMP084
TEMP085
TEMP086
TEMP087
TEMP088
TEMP089
TEMP090
TEMP091
TEMP092
TEMP093
TEMP094
TEMP095
TEMP096
TEMP097
TEMP098
TEMP099
TEMP100
TEMP101
TEMP102
TEMP103
TEMP104
TEMP105
TEMP106
TEMP107
TEMP108
TEMP109
TEMP110
TEMP111
TEMP112
TEMP113
TEMP114
TEMP115
TEMP116
TEMP117
TEMP118
TEMP119
TEMP120
TEMP121
TEMP122
TEMP123
TEMP124
TEMP125
TEMP126
TEMP127
TEMP128
TEMP129
TEMP130
TEMP131
TEMP132
TEMP133
TEMP134
TEMP135
TEMP136
TEMP137
TEMP138
TEMP139
TEMP140
TEMP141
TEMP142
TEMP143
TEMP144
TEMP145
TEMP146
TEMP147
TEMP148
TEMP149
TEMP150
318
Norm
Flip Flop
Back
Release
Up
Signal
Off
On
Timer
One
Time Value
None
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
PLC Default Setting
Output
2966
2967
2968
2969
2970
2971
2972
2973
2974
2975
2976
2977
2978
2979
2980
2981
2982
2983
2984
2985
2986
2987
2988
2989
2990
2991
2992
2993
2994
2995
2996
2997
2998
2999
3000
3001
3002
3003
3004
3005
3006
3007
3008
3009
3010
3011
3012
3013
3014
3015
3016
3017
3018
3019
3020
3021
3022
3023
3024
3025
3026
3027
3028
3029
3030
3031
3032
3033
3034
3035
3036
3037
3038
3039
3040
Signal
Timing
Cycle
30
90
User
Logic ex pression
Turn
Model 1x 1, 1x 2, 2x 1, 2x 2, 3x 1, 3x 2, 4x 1, 5x 1,
5x 3
TEMP151
TEMP152
TEMP153
TEMP154
TEMP155
TEMP156
TEMP157
TEMP158
TEMP159
TEMP160
TEMP161
TEMP162
TEMP163
TEMP164
TEMP165
TEMP166
TEMP167
TEMP168
TEMP169
TEMP170
TEMP171
TEMP172
TEMP173
TEMP174
TEMP175
TEMP176
TEMP177
TEMP178
TEMP179
TEMP180
TEMP181
TEMP182
TEMP183
TEMP184
TEMP185
TEMP186
TEMP187
TEMP188
TEMP189
TEMP190
TEMP191
TEMP192
TEMP193
TEMP194
TEMP195
TEMP196
TEMP197
TEMP198
TEMP199
TEMP200
TEMP201
TEMP202
TEMP203
TEMP204
TEMP205
TEMP206
TEMP207
TEMP208
TEMP209
TEMP210
TEMP211
TEMP212
TEMP213
TEMP214
TEMP215
TEMP216
TEMP217
TEMP218
TEMP219
TEMP220
TEMP221
TEMP222
TEMP223
TEMP224
TEMP225
319
Norm
Flip Flop
Back
Release
Up
Signal
Off
On
Timer
One
Time Value
None
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
PLC Default Setting
Output
3041
3042
3043
3044
3045
3046
3047
3048
3049
3050
3051
3052
3053
3054
3055
3056
3057
3058
3059
3060
3061
3062
3063
3064
3065
3066
3067
3068
3069
3070
3071
Signal
Timing
Cycle
30
90
User
Logic ex pression
Turn
Model 1x 1, 1x 2, 2x 1, 2x 2, 3x 1, 3x 2, 4x 1, 5x 1,
5x 3
TEMP226
TEMP227
TEMP228
TEMP229
TEMP230
TEMP231
TEMP232
TEMP233
TEMP234
TEMP235
TEMP236
TEMP237
TEMP238
TEMP239
TEMP240
TEMP241
TEMP242
TEMP243
TEMP244
TEMP245
TEMP246
TEMP247
TEMP248
TEMP249
TEMP250
TEMP251
TEMP252
TEMP253
TEMP254
TEMP255
TEMP256
320
Norm
Flip Flop
Back
Release
Up
Signal
Off
On
Timer
One
Time Value
None
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Appendix I
Commissioning Test Sheet (sample)
1. Relay identification
2. Preliminary check
3. Hardware check
3.1 User interface check
3.2 Binary input/Binary output circuit check
3.3 AC input circuit check
4. Function test
4.1 Phase current differential element DIF test
4.2 Residual current differential element DIFG test
4.3 Overcurrent elements OC, EF, OCI, EFI & THM test
4.4 Out-of-step element OST test
4.5 Voltage and synchronism check elements test
5. Protection scheme test
6. Metering and recording check
7. Conjunctive test
321
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
1.
Relay identification
Type
Serial number
Model
System frequency
Station
Date
Circuit
Engineer
Protection scheme
Witness
Preliminary check
Ratings
CT shorting contacts
DC power supply
Power up
Wiring
Relay inoperative
alarm contact
Calendar and clock
3.
Hardware check
Function test
Measured current
Measured current
322
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
(3) Percentage restraining characteristic test
Tap setting
I
Tap
Tap
20 Tap
I1
I1
5 Tap
20 Tap
Tap setting
Measured current
Tap setting
Measured current
Element
Test current
OCI
2 Is
OC
OC1
(2) EF element
Element
EF
20 Is
Test current
EFI
2 Is
20 Is
Test current
THM-A
1.2 Is
THM-T
10 Is
323
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
(6) OCD, EFD element
Element
Test current
OCD
EFD
Result
Measured angle
OST1-
OST1-
OST2-
OST2-
Setting
Measured voltage
Element
OVB
UVL1
UVB
OVL2
OVL1
UVL2
Setting
Measured voltage
Setting
Measured voltage
Element
SYN1(SY1UV)
SYN2(SY2UV)
SYN1(SY1OV)
SYN2(SY2OV)
Setting
SYN1(SY1)
SYN2(SY2)
5.
6.
7.
Conjunctive test
Item
Results
On load check
Tripping circuit
Reclosing circuit
324
Measured angle
Setting
Measured voltage
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Appendix J
Return Repair Form
325
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Type:
Model:
GRL100
(Example: Type:
GRL100
Sub No.
Model:
201B
Product No.:
Serial No. :
Date:
1.
2.
Fault records, event records or disturbance records stored in the relay and relay settings are
very helpful information to investigate the incident.
Please inform us of this information in respect to the incident on a Floppy Disk, or by
completing the Fault Record sheet and Relay Setting sheet attached.
326
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Fault Record
Date/Month/Year Time
15:09:58.442)
Faulty phase:
Fault Locator :
Prefault values (CT ratio:
Va:
kV or V
Vb:
kV or V
Vc:
kV or V
Vs1
kV or V
Vs2
kV or V
V1:
kV or V
V2:
kV or V
V0:
kV or V
V11:
kV or V
V12:
kV or V
Ia1:
kA or A
Ib1:
kA or A
Ic1:
kA or A
I01:
kA or A
Ida:
kA or A
Idb:
kA or A
Idc:
kA or A
Id0:
kA or A
Fault values
Prefault values (CT ratio:
Va:
kV or V
Vb:
kV or V
Vc:
kV or V
Vs1
kV or V
Vs2
kV or V
V1:
kV or V
V2:
kV or V
V0:
kV or V
V11:
kV or V
V12:
kV or V
Ia1:
kA or A
Ib1:
kA or A
Ic1:
kA or A
I01:
kA or A
Ida:
kA or A
Idb:
kA or A
Idc:
kA or A
Id0:
kA or A
THM
%
Telecomm. delay time 1
Telecomm. delay time 2
km (
%)
kA/:
kA/:
A, VT ratio:
Ia:
Ib :
Ic:
kV/:
V)
kA or A
kA or A
kA or A
I1 :
I2 :
I0 :
kA or A
kA or A
kA or A
Ia2:
Ib2:
Ic2:
I02:
kA or A
kA or A
kA or A
kA or A
kV/:
V)
kA or A
kA or A
kA or A
I1 :
I2 :
I0 :
kA or A
kA or A
kA or A
Ia2:
Ib2:
Ic2:
I02:
kA or A
kA or A
kA or A
kA or A
A, VT ratio:
Ia:
Ib :
Ic:
s
s
327
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
3.
What was the message on the LCD display at the time of the incident.
4.
5.
328
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Customer
Name:
Company Name:
Address:
Telephone No.:
Facsimile No.:
Signature:
329
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
330
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Appendix K
Technical Data
331
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
TECHNICAL DATA
Ratings
AC current In:
1A or 5A
AC voltage
Frequency:
DC power supply:
50Hz or 60Hz
110Vdc/125Vdc (Operative range: 88 - 150Vdc)
220Vdc/250Vdc (Operative range: 176 - 300Vdc)
48Vdc/54Vdc/60Vdc (Operative range: 38.4 - 72Vdc)
24Vdc/30Vdc (Operative range: 19.2 - 36Vdc)
maximum 12%
up to 50ms at 110V
less than 10s
110/125Vdc
220/250Vdc
48/54/60Vdc
24/30Vdc
Overload Ratings
AC current input
AC voltage input
Burden
AC current input
AC voltage input
DC power supply:
Operating time
Resetting time
332
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Telecommunication Interface for current differential protection
Bit rate
64kbs
Transmission format
Electrical interface (Telecomm. equipment link)
Applicable standard
IEC60870-5-1
Type of code
Connector type
Optical interface (2 km class)
Type of fibre
Connector type
Wave length
Optical transmitter
Optical receiver
CCITT-G703-1.2.1
CCITT-G703-1.2.2 or 1.2.3
X.21
NRZ (Non-Return to Zero)
D-sub connector
Graded-index multi-mode 50/125m or 62.5/125m
ST type
820nm
LED, more than 19dBm or 16dBm
PIN diode, less than 24dBm
DSF 8/125m
Duplex LC
1550nm
Laser, more than 5dBm
PIN diode, less than 34dBm
Stub Protection
Stub
ON / OFF
333
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Breaker Failure (BF) Protection
Overcurrent element
Reset
BF timer for retry-trip of failed circuit breaker
BF timer for adjacent circuit breaker tripping
Operating time of overcurrent element
Resetting time of overcurrent element
Accuracy
Current differential protection: pick-up
Inverse time overcurrent characteristics
Definite time overcurrent protection: pick-up
Overcurrent element for BF: pick-up
Autoreclose function
Number of shots
Timer settings
Dead time for single-phase autoreclose
Dead time for three-phase autoreclose
Multi-shot dead line time
Multi-shot reset time
Reclaim time
Pulse width of reclosing signal output
Autoreclose reset time
Reset time for developing fault
One-and-a-half breaker system
Follower breaker autoreclose delay time
Voltage and synchronism check element
Synchronism check angle
UV element
OV element
Busbar or line dead check
Busbar or line live check
Synchronism check time
Voltage check time
Fault Detector
Multi-step overcurrent element
1 to 4 shots
0.01 to 10.00s in 0.01s steps
0.01 to 100.00s in 0.01s steps
5.0 to 300.0s in 0.1s steps
5.0 to 300.0s in 0.1s steps
5 to 300s in 1s steps
0.1 to 10.0s in 0.1s steps
0.01 to 100.00s in 0.01s steps
0.01 to 10.00s in 0.01s steps
0.1 to 10.0s in 0.1s steps
5 to 75 in 1 steps
60 to 150V in 1V steps
10 to 100V in 1V steps
10 to 100V in 1V steps
10 to 100V in 1V steps
0.01 to 10.00s in 0.01s steps
0.01 to 1.00s in 0.01s steps
L1: 0.10A, L2: 0.16A, L3: 0.26A, L4: 0.41A,
L5: 0.66A, L6: 1.05A, L7: 1.68A (1A relay)
L1: 0.50A, L2: 0.80A, L3: 1.28A, L4: 2.05A
L5: 3.28A, L6: 5.24A, L7: 8.39A (5A relay)
0.1 times rated current
0.1 times rated current
46V
80V
0.07 times voltage before fault
0.0 to 999.9 in 0.1 steps (1A relay)
0.00 to 199.99 in 0.01 steps (5A relay)
0.0 to 399.9km in 0.1km steps
1km (up to 100km) or 1% (up to 399.9km at DIFI=0.5In
setting and Id=2In
2km (up to 100km) or 2% (up to 399.9km at DIFI=0.25In
setting and Id=2In
2 cycles
334
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Disturbance Record Initiation
Overcurrent element
Undervoltage element
Pre-fault time
0.3s (fixed)
Post-fault time
Communication Port
Front communication port (local PC)
Connection
Cable type
Cable length
Connector
Rear communication port (remote PC)
RS485 I/F:
Transmission data rate for RSM system
Connection
Connector
Cable and length
Isolation
Fibre optic I/F:
Ethernet LAN I/F:
IRIG-B Port
IRIG Time Code
Input impedance
Input voltage range
Connector type
Cable type
Point to point
Multi-core (straight)
15m (max.)
RS232C 9-pin D-sub miniature connector female
64kbps
Multidrop mode (max. 32 relays)
Screw terminals
Twisted pair cable, max. 1200m
2kVac for 1min.
ST connector, graded-index multi-mode 50/125m or
62.5/125m type optical fibres
10BASE-T, RJ-45 connector
IRIG-B122
4k-ohm
4Vp-p to 10Vp-p
BNC connector
50 ohm coaxial cable
Binary Inputs
Operating voltage
Contact Ratings
Trip contacts
Make and carry
Break
Auxiliary contacts
Make and carry
Break
Durability
Make and carry
Break
Mechanical design
Weight
Case colour
Installation
5A continuously,
30A, 290Vdc for 0.5s (L/R=10ms)
0.15A, 290Vdc (L/R=40ms)
4A continuously,
10A, 220Vdc for 0.5s (L/R5ms)
0.1A, 220Vdc (L/R=40ms)
10,000 operations minimum
100,000 operations minimum
11kg (Type-A), 14kg (Type-B)
10YR8/1
Flush mounting or rack mounting
335
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
CT REQUIREMENT
Ideally it would be preferable to employ current transformers that did not saturate; this is
particularly desirable if operation of the protection is to be avoided during external faults.
However, there are circumstances due to accommodation requirements and occasionally on the
basis of cost where this is not always possible.
The type GRL100 current differential protection will remain stable for external faults provided
that the characteristics of the current transformers are such that they saturate in a similar manner.
Instability can occur if current transformers having different characteristics have been used or for
3-terminal applications or for instances where the remnance flux is not negligible.
For the GRL100 appropriate setting of the large current region can prevent instability for these
more onerous conditions. This report details the CT requirements for the GRL100 current
differential protection.
1. General
The setting of the large current region is defined by DIFI2. Fig.K-1.1 shows the DIFI2
characteristic. As shown in Fig.K-1.1, the operating zone increases as the value of DIFI2
increases.
Id
Operating Zone
Id = (1/6)Ir + (5/6)DIFI1
DIFI1
5/6DIFI1
0
Id = Ir - 2DIFI2
2DIFI2
Ir (=I)
-2DIFI2
I L max DIFI 2
(K-1.1)
where,
ILmax : Maximum load current
: Maximum value of DIFI2 to prevent mal-operation caused by CT saturation for external
faults.
Whether the CT is applicable or not is determined by whether or not it is possible to achieve a
setting for DIFI2. depends on several conditions, for example, the CT specification, fault
current, time constant of the primary system, etc. However, in order to confirm that a CT for a
particular application is satisfactory, it is not necessary to know and DIFI2 at this stage.
Instead, the CT requirement can be obtained by following the procedure in the next section.
336
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
From the point of view of hardware limitation, secondary maximum through fault current must be
smaller than full scale of measurement which is 65 times rated current.
2. CT requirement
<Step 1> Check the maximum through fault current Ifmaxth
Ifmaxth < 65 X In
where,
Ifmaxth : Secondary maximum through fault current
In :Rated secondary current
<Step 2> Check the CT satisfies the condition given by table K-2.1 or K-2.2 depending on CT
types. Each table has two requirements. Both must be satisfied.
<Knee point voltage of CTs is given>
Table K-2.1 CT Requirement defined by Vk
Td [ms]
Requirement 1
Requirement 2
35
Vk Ifmax(Rct+ R2)3
Vk ILmax(Rct+ R2)14.4
50
Vk Ifmax(Rct+ R2)3
Vk ILmax(Rct+ R2)20
75
Vk Ifmax(Rct+ R2)4
Vk ILmax(Rct+ R2)28.8
100
Vk Ifmax(Rct+ R2)4
Vk ILmax(Rct+ R2)36.8
150
Vk Ifmax(Rct+ R2)8
Vk ILmax(Rct+ R2)50.4
Requirement 1
Requirement 2
35
n In 3.75 Ifmax
n In ILmax18
50
n In 3.75 Ifmax
n In ILmax25
75
n In 5 Ifmax
n In ILmax36
100
n In 5 Ifmax
n In ILmax46
150
n In 10 Ifmax
n In ILmax63
n' =
RVA / I n2 + Rct
n
R2 + Rct
(K-1.1)
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
n : rated accuracy limit factor
ILmax :maximum secondary load current
Ifmax :maximum secondary fault current
Note : The values in the table are based on the following assumption.
- 100% DC component is superimposed.
- Only one CT is saturated.
- No remnance flux is assumed.
3. Special case
In the case of a 3 terminal-double circuit line configuration, an additional system condition must
be considered. It is possible, under certain circumstances, that when an internal fault occurs,
out-flowing fault current can also be experienced.
In this case, the effect of the out-flowing fault current must be considered when calculating DIFI1
and DIFI2. For example, the following application can be considered.
Terminal A
Line 2
D
S1
Terminal B
S2
Line 1
X
X-Y
Y
Z
Terminal C
Terminal B :
Y+Z
Terminal C :
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
the right of where it would normally fall.
Id
Id = Ir - 2DIFI2
X+Z
Id = 1/6Ir+5/6DIFI1
2DIFI2
X+2Y+Z
Ir
In order to ensure that the GRL100 relay will operate correctly in this case, the point shown on the
plot must fall within the operating zone.
According to this requirement, DIFI2 can be calculated as follows.
X +Z > X+2Y+Z2DIFI2
DIFI2 > Y
(K-3.1)
This means that DIFI2 must be larger than the amount of out-flowing current.
Therefore the condition shown in Table K-2.1 and Table K-2.2 should be replaced by that in Table
K-3.1 and Table K-3.2 respectively.
Table K-3.1 CT Requirement defined by Vk
Td [ms]
Requirement 1
Requirement 2
35
Vk Ifmax(Rct+ R2)3
50
Vk Ifmax(Rct+ R2)3
75
Vk Ifmax(Rct+ R2)4
100
Vk Ifmax(Rct+ R2)4
150
Vk Ifmax(Rct+ R2)8
Max { ILMAX+ Ifmin/2, Ifmaxout } : The larger of (ILMAX + Ifmin/2) and Ifmaxout .
Ifmin: Minimum fault current
Ifmaxout : Maximum out-flowing fault current for the special condition.
339
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Requirement 1
Requirement 2
35
n In 3.75 Ifmax
50
n In 3.75 Ifmax
75
n In 5 Ifmax
100
n In 5 Ifmax
150
n In 10 Ifmax
Max { ILMAX+ Ifmin/2, Ifmaxout } : The larger of (ILMAX + Ifmin/2) and Ifmaxout .
Ifmin: Minimum fault current
Ifmaxout : Maximum out-flowing fault current for the special condition.
Y is determined by the ratio of the impedance between node D to Terminal C and node D to
Terminal B. If their impedance is assumed to be p and q respectively, Y can be obtained using the
following equation.
Y=X
q
2 p + 2q
(K-3.2)
340
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
ENVIRONMENTAL PERFORMANCE CLAIMS
Test
Atmospheric Environment
Temperature
Standards
Details
Operating range: -10C to +55C.
Storage / Transit: -25C to +70C.
56 days at 40C and 93% relative humidity.
IP51 (Rear: IP20)
I1EC60068-2-1/2
Humidity
IEC60068-2-78
Enclosure Protection
IEC60529
Mechanical Environment
Vibration
IEC60255-21-1
Shock and Bump
IEC60255-21-2
Seismic
Electrical Environment
Dielectric Withstand
IEC60255-21-3
IEC60255-5
Response - Class 1
Endurance - Class 1
Shock Response Class 1
Shock Withstand Class 1
Bump Class 1
Class 1
IEC60255-5
Electromagnetic Environment
High Frequency
IEC60255-22-1 Class 3,
IEC61000-4-12 / EN61000-4-12
Disturbance / Damped
Oscillatory Wave
Electrostatic Discharge
IEC60255-22-2 Class 3,
IEC61000-4-2 / EN61000-4-2
Radiated RF
IEC60255-22-3 Class 3,
IEC61000-4-3 / EN61000-4-3
Electromagnetic
Disturbance
Fast Transient
IEC60255-22-4, IEC61000-4-4 /
Disturbance
EN61000-4-4
Surge Immunity
IEC60255-22-5,
IEC61000-4-5 / EN61000-4-5
Conducted RF
Electromagnetic
Disturbance
Power Frequency
Disturbance
IEC60255-22-6 Class 3,
IEC61000-4-6 / EN61000-4-6
IEC60255-25,
EN55022 Class A,
IEC61000-6-4 / EN61000-6-4
IEC60255-22-7,
IEC61000-4-16 / EN61000-4-16
73/23/EEC
341
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
342
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Appendix L
Symbols Used in Scheme Logic
343
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Symbols used in the scheme logic and their meanings are as follows:
Signal names
Marked with
Marked with
: Signal number
Marked with
Signal No.
Signal name
Marked with [
] : Scheme switch
Unmarked
AND gates
A
B
&
Output
A
1
&
Output
A
1
B
C
1
0
Other cases
Output
1
0
&
Output
A
1
B
C
0
0
Other cases
Output
1
0
B
C
0
0
Other cases
Output
0
1
A
B
C
B
C
1
1
Other cases
Output
1
0
A
B
C
OR gates
A
B
Output
A
0
Output
A
0
B
C
0
1
Other cases
Output
0
1
Output
A
0
B
C
1
1
Other cases
Output
0
1
A
B
C
A
B
C
344
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Signal inversion
A
0
1
Output
Output
1
0
Timer
t
XXX:
Set time
XXX
0
XXX:
Set time
XXX
t
One-shot timer
A
A
Output
Output
XXX - YYY
S
F/F
Output
R
0
0
1
1
Output
No change
1
0
0
Scheme switch
Output
ON
Output
ON
345
A
Switch
1
ON
Other cases
Switch
ON
OFF
Output
1
0
Output
1
0
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
346
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Appendix M
Multi-phase Autoreclose
347
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Table M-1 and M-2 show operations of the multi-phase autoreclose for different faults. The
operations of the autoreclose depend on the settings of [ARC-M] and [MA-NOLK].
Cases 1 to 3 show the case when one of the double circuit lines is out of service. In MPAR2 and
[MA-NOLK]=FT, only case 1 results in single-phase tripping and multi-phase reclosing. Other
cases result in three-phase final tripping. In MPAR2 and [MA-NOLK]=FT or S+T, case 1 results
in single-phase tripping and multi-phase reclosing, and cases 2 and 3 result in three-phase tripping
and three-phase reclosing. In MPAR3 and [MA-NOLK]=FT, all cases result in three-phase final
tripping. In MPAR3 and [MA-NOLK]=T, all cases result in three-phase tripping and three-phase
reclosing. In MPAR3 and [MA-NOLK]=S+T, case 1 results in single-phase tripping and
single-phase reclosing, and cases 2 and 3 result in three-phase tripping and three-phase reclosing.
In cases 4, 6, 7, 10 and 11, three different phases remain in the power transmission state, so both
MPAR2 and MPAR3 perform fault phase(s) tripping and reclosing.
In case 5, 8, 12 and 13, two different phases remain in the power transmission state, so MPAR2
performs fault phase(s) tripping and multi-phase reclosing. In MPAR3 and [MA-NOLK]=FT, all
cases result in three-phase final tripping. In MPAR3 and [MA-NOLK]=T, all cases result in
three-phase tripping and three-phase reclosing. In MPAR3 and [MA-NOLK]=S+T, single- or
three-phase tripping and single- or three-phase reclosing is performed according to fault phase(s).
In cases 9, 14 and 15, the number of remaining different phases is less than two, so the operations
of the autoreclose depends on only the [MA-NOLK] setting. In [MA-NOLK]=FT, all cases result
in three-phase final tripping. In [MA-NOLK]=T or S+T, all cases result in three-phase tripping
and three-phase reclosing.
Table M-1 Reclosing in MPAR2 ([ARC-M]=M2 setting)
Tripping and Reclosing (Tripping mode Reclosing mode)
Fault phase
Case
#1 line
B
#2 line
No.
10
11
12
13
14
15
[MA-NOLK] = FT setting
[MA-NOLK] = T setting
#1 line
#2 line
#1 line
#2 line
#1 line
#2 line
1TMPAR
1TMPAR
1TMPAR
3FT
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
3FT
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
1TMPAR
1TMPAR
1TMPAR
1TMPAR
2TMPAR
1TMPAR
2TMPAR
1TMPAR
1TMPAR
2TMPAR
1TMPAR
1TMPAR
1TMPAR
1TMPAR
1TMPAR
1TMPAR
2TMPAR
1TMPAR
2TMPAR
1TMPAR
2TMPAR
1TMPAR
3FT
3FT
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
3TMPAR
1TMPAR
1TMPAR
3TMPAR
3TMPAR
2TMPAR
1TMPAR
2TMPAR
1TMPAR
2TMPAR
1TMPAR
2TMPAR
2TMPAR
2TMPAR
2TMPAR
2TMPAR
2TMPAR
3TMPAR
1TMPAR
3TMPAR
1TMPAR
3TMPAR
1TMPAR
3FT
3FT
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
3FT
3FT
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
: Fault,
MPAR: Multi-phase reclosing
SPAR: Single-phase reclosing
1 T: single-phase tripping
3 T: three-phase tripping
348
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Table M-2 Reclosing in MPAR3 ([ARC-M]=M3 setting)
Tripping and Reclosing (Tripping mode Reclosing mode)
Fault phase
Case
#1 line
B
#2 line
No.
10
11
12
13
14
15
[MA-NOLK] = FT setting
[MA-NOLK] = T setting
#1 line
#2 line
#1 line
#2 line
#1 line
#2 line
3FT
3TTPAR
1TSPAR
3FT
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
3FT
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
1TMPAR
3FT
1TMPAR
3FT
2TMPAR
3TTPAR
2TMPAR
1TSPAR
1TSPAR
2TMPAR
1TMPAR
1TMPAR
1TMPAR
1TMPAR
1TMPAR
1TMPAR
3FT
3FT
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
1TSPAR
3FT
3FT
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
3TMPAR
3TTPAR
1TMPAR
3TMPAR
3TMPAR
2TMPAR
1TMPAR
2TMPAR
1TMPAR
2TMPAR
1TMPAR
3FT
3FT
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
3FT
3FT
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
1TSPAR
3FT
3FT
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
3FT
3FT
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
3TTPAR
349
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
350
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Appendix N
Data Transmission Format
351
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Transmission Format
The data transmission format depends on the communication mode.
Figures N-1 and N-2 show the data transmission format that applies to the data transmission
between terminals of the transmission lines by the relay. The individual parts of the transmission
format are described below.
(1) Frame header
A signal indicating the head of a frame.
(2) Current data
12 bit data (incl. one sign bit) indicating the current value of sampling of each phase.
(3) SA flag and control data
Device data (CB, DS) and control data necessary for the protective function are transmitted
by sub-commutation. Sub-commutation is used for signals that may be transmitted at low
speed, and has the meaning that 1-bit information is different from frame to frame.
Frames are identified by the SA flag, which is also transmitted by sub-commutation. It
detects the signal pattern of 00001 and identifies a frame number. One cycle of frame
numbers covers 12 frames.
(4) SP flag and time data
The SP flag and time data for sampling time synchronization are transmitted by
sub-commutation. Sub-commutation detects the signal pattern of 00001 and identifies a
frame number.
The time data for sampling time synchronization has 16 bits.
(5) CRC (Cyclic Redundancy Check) data
CRC data is added to check transmitting data for transmission errors.
Data without the frame header is divided by a polynomial and the resultant remainder is
transmitted as the CRC data.
On the receiving side, the CRC data is subtracted from the transmitted data, the result divided
by the same polynomial, and the remainder checked for 0.
Polynomial: X16 + X12 + X5 + 1
(6) User configurable data
Number of user configurable data depends on the communication mode and whether a
function is used or not. The transmission data and user configurable data is shown in Table
N-1 and Figures N-1 and N-2.
352
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Table N-1
Transmission data
Sending side
Receiving side
Remarks
Phase current
Fixed.
Positive-sequence
Voltage
B-/GPS-MODE: V1 for OST/FL. If the OST/FL are not used, the following
are configurable.
B-/GPS-MODE: I1 for DIFG. If the DIFG are not used, the following are
configurable.
Zero-sequence
current
COM1 COM3
COM4, COM5
(85S1, 85S2)
SUB2-COM
(CBDS/RA1)
SP2/RA2
SA
Configurable data.
SUB_COM1-S (Signal No.: 2056) to
SUB_COM5-S (Signal No.: 2060)
Sent by 12 SSP
cycle.
SUB2_COM1-R1 (Sig. No.: 1112) to SUB2_COM12-R1 (Sig. No.: 1123) /
SUB2_COM1-R2 (Sig. No.: 1152) to SUB2_COM12-R2 (Sig. No.: 1153)
SUB3_COM1-R1 (Sig. No.: 1168) to SUB3_COM12-R1 (Sig. No.: 1179) /
SUB3_COM1-R2 (Sig. No.: 1184) to SUB3_COM12-R2 (Sig. No.: 1195)
SUB_COM1-R1 (Sig. No.: 1104) to SUB_COM5-R1 (Sig. No.: 1108) /
SUB_COM1-R2 (Sig. No.: 1144) to SUB_COM5-R2 (Sig. No.: 1148)
353
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Next
Frame
88 bits
Frame
header
10 bits
(1)
Legend
Ia, Ib, Ic :
V1 :
Io :
ON / OFF :
RDY :
SA :
SP :
CRC :
S.F.C.
Ia
1 Ia
Ib 1
Ib
Ic
1 Ic
V1 1 Io
COM
1
2
3
1 4
C1CRRSSR C
O OA DAP A R
2 C
M M1 Y
4 5
3 11111111 2 1
CRC
(5)
(2)
Phase current
Positive-sequence voltage
Zero-sequence current
Control data
Ready
Sampling address
Sampling synchronization
Cyclic redundancy check
Simultaneous fault control
(synchronized test trigger signal)
1 CRC
COM1
COM2
COM3
COM4
DIF-A
DIF-B
DIF-C
85S1
Frame
No.
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
SUB2_COM
SUB2 COM1
SUB2 COM2
SUB2 COM3
SUB2 COM4
SUB2 COM5
SUB2 COM5
SUB2 COM7
SUB2 COM8
SUB2 COM9
SUB2 COM10
SUB2 COM11
SUB2 COM12
CBDS-A
-B
-C
CBDS-A
-B
-C
CBDS-A
-B
-C
CBDS-A
-B
-C
Fixed
bit
COM5
SUB2
COM
85S2
SA
SUB_COM
0
0
0
0
1
SUB COM1
SUB COM2
SUB COM3
ARC BLOCK
Local Test
DIFG
1
SUB COM5
SUB COM4
SPARE
TFC
S.F.C.
(3)
R
D
Y
S
A
SP1
0
2
1
2
2
2
3
2
SP flag
4
2
5
2
6
2
7
2
-
S
P
1
S
P
2
SP2
8
2
9
2
10
2
11
2
12
2
13
2
14
2
15
2
-
Time
data(*)
(4)
354
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Next
Frame
88 bits
Frame
header
10 bits
Ia
1 Ia
Ib 1
Ib
Ic
1 Ic
V1 1 Io
1 8 RRSSR C 1
5 ADAP A R
S 1 Y
2 C
2
CRC
3 11111111 2 1
Frame
No.
V1 /
SPARE
Legend
Ia, Ib, Ic :
V1 :
Io :
ON / OFF :
RDY :
SA :
SSA
SP :
CRC :
S.F.C.
V.COM2
COM1
COM2
COM3
COM4
SA
SA
SSA
85S1
V1 /
SPARE
Io
V.COM3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
V1 /
SPARE
(5)
V1
V.COM1
1 CRC
(2)
(1)
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
87 8
SA/ 5
SSA S
1
S.V.COM
V1 / SPARE
V1 / SPARE
V1 / SPARE
V1 / SPARE
V1 / SPARE
V1 / SPARE
V1 / SPARE
V1 / SPARE
V1 / SPARE
V1 / SPARE
V1 / SPARE
V1 / SPARE
I.COM1
Io /
SPARE
I.COM2
Io /
SPARE
COM5
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
S.I.COM
Io / SPARE
Io / SPARE
Io / SPARE
Io / SPARE
Io / SPARE
Io / SPARE
Io / SPARE
Io / SPARE
Io / SPARE
Io / SPARE
Io / SPARE
Io / SPARE
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
R
D
Y
SP1
RA0 / CBDS-A
RA1 / CBDS-B
RA2 / CBDS-C
RA0 / CBDS-A
RA1 / CBDS-B
RA2 / CBDS-C
RA0 / CBDS-A
RA1 / CBDS-B
RA2 / CBDS-C
RA0 / CBDS-A
RA1 / CBDS-B
RA2 / CBDS-C
1
2
3
S
A
S
P
1
20, 28
21, 29
22, 210
23, 211
SP flag
24, 212
25, 213
26, 214
27, 215
-
0
0
0
0
1
ARC BLOCK
Local test
0
1
5
4
S.F.C.
SUB3_COM
RA2
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
RA3 / SPARE
RA4 / SPARE
RA5 / SPARE
RA3 / SPARE
RA4 / SPARE
RA5 / SPARE
RA3 / SPARE
RA4 / SPARE
RA5 / SPARE
RA3 / SPARE
RA1 / SPARE
RA2 / SPARE
Time
data(*)
(4)
(*) Time data are transmitted once per two cycle.
SUB_COM:
V.COM1 to V.COM3 and S.V.COM1 to S.V.COM12: If the OST and FL functions are not used,
the user can use these commands. The V.COM1 to V.COM3 commands
are sent every frame. The S.V.COM1 to S.V.COM12 are sent every 12
frames.
I.COM1 to I.COM3 and S.I.COM1 to S.I.COM12: If the DIFG function is not used, the user can
use these commands. The I.COM1 to I.COM3 commands are sent every
frame. The S.I.COM1 to S.I.COM12 are sent every 12 frames.
355
SUB3
COM
RA2
SA
SUB-COM
(3)
Phase current
Positive-sequence voltage
Zero-sequence current
Control data
Ready
Sampling address for a cycle
Sampling address for a second
Sampling synchronization
Cyclic redundancy check
Simultaneous fault control
(synchronized test trigger signal)
SUB2
COM
85S2
SUB2-COM
CBDS / RA
I.COM3
Io /
SPARE
Fixed
bit
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
SUB2_COM1 to SUB2_COM12: These commands are assigned to bits (RA) for relay address
monitoring RYIDSV as default setting. If the RYIDSV is not used, the user
can use these commands. If multi-phase autoreclosing function is applied,
for example, these commands are assigned to CBDS-A, -B and C such as
shown in Figure N-1.
SUB3_COM1 to SUB3_COM12: These commands are also assigned to bits (RA) for relay
address monitoring RYIDSV as default setting. If the RYIDSV is not used,
the user can use these commands.
356
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Appendix O
Example of DIF and DIFG Setting
357
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
1. Segregated-phase Current Differential Element DIF
(1) Small current region DIFI1
The characteristic of the DIF for small current region is expressed by the following equation.
Id (1/6)Ir + (5/6)DIFI1
Where, DIFI1 defines the minimum operating current. Therefore, DIFI1 is determined to detect
minimum fault current with margin of 1.5.
Examples: Minimum fault current = 3000A, CT ratio = 2000
DIFI1 = 3000A/1.5/2000 = 1 A
(2) Large current region DIFI2
The characteristic of the DIF for large current region is expressed by the following equation.
Id Ir - 2 DIFI2
Where, DIFI2 defines the maximum out-flow current during an internal fault.
The characteristic has stronger restraint and prevents the element from operating falsely in
response to the erroneous current caused by the CT saturation. The CT saturation occurs in smaller
current than the current determined CT over current constant when the fault current includes
transient DC. Therefore, DIFI2 is preferable as small as possible, but it must be larger than the
maximum out-flowing current during an internal fault.
In case of two terminal network, the maximum out-flowing current is the maximum load current.
In this case, DIFI2 is determined to the maximum load current with margin of 3 or 4.
Examples: Maximum load current = 2000A, CT ratio = 2000
DIFI2 = 2000A 3/2000 = 3 A
358
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Appendix P
Programmable Reset Characteristics
and Implementation of Thermal Model
to IEC60255-8
359
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Intermittent
Fault Condition
TRIP LEVEL
Figure P-1
360
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
t
I2
1 e 100%
2
I AOL
(1)
where:
= thermal state of the system as a percentage of allowable thermal capacity,
I = applied load current,
IAOL = allowable overload current of the system,
= thermal time constant of the system.
The thermal stateis expressed as a percentage of the thermal capacity of the protected system, where
0% represents the cold state and 100% represents the thermal limit, that is the point at which no further
temperature rise can be safely tolerated and the system should be disconnected. The thermal limit for any
given electrical plant is fixed by the thermal setting IAOL. The relay gives a trip output when = 100%.
If current I is applied to a cold system, then will rise exponentially from 0% to (I2/IAOL2 100%), with time
constant , as in Figure P-2. If = 100%, then the allowable thermal capacity of the system has been reached.
(%)
100%
I2
I AOL
100%
2
= I I 2 1 e
AOL
100 %
t (s)
Figure P-2
A thermal overload protection relay can be designed to model this function, giving tripping times
according to the IEC60255-8 Hot and Cold curves.
I2
t =Ln 2 2
I I AOL
(1)
Cold curve
I2 I 2
t =Ln 2 2P
I I AOL
(2)
Hot curve
where:
IP = prior load current.
361
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
In fact, the cold curve is simply a special case of the hot curve where prior load current IP = 0, catering for
the situation where a cold system is switched on to an immediate overload.
Figure P-3 shows a typical thermal profile for a system which initially carries normal load current, and is
then subjected to an overload condition until a trip results, before finally cooling to ambient temperature.
(%)
Overload Current
Condition
Trip at 100%
100%
Normal Load
Current Condition
Cooling Curve
t (s)
Figure P-3
362
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Appendix Q
IEC60870-5-103: Interoperability
363
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
IEC60870-5-103 Configurator
IEC103 configurator software is included in a same CD as RSM100, and can be installed easily as
follows:
Installation of IEC103 Configurator
Insert the CD-ROM (RSM100) into a CDROM drive to install this software on a PC.
Double click the Setup.exe of the folder \IEC103Conf under the root directory, and operate it
according to the message.
When installation has been completed, the IEC103 Configurator will be registered in the start
menu.
Starting IEC103 Configurator
Click [Start][Programs][IEC103 Configurator][IECConf] to the IEC103 Configurator
software.
Note: The instruction manual of IEC103 Configurator can be viewed by clicking
[Help][Manual] on IEC103 Configurator.
Requirements for IEC60870-5-103 master station
Polling cycle: 150ms or more
Timeout time (time till re-sending the request frame to relay): 100ms or more
IEC103 master
GR relay
Data request
Polling cycle:
150ms or more
Response frame
Data request
Response frame
IEC60870-5-103: Interoperability
1. Physical Layer
1.1 Electrical interface: EIA RS-485
Number of loads, 32 for one protection equipment
1.2 Optical interface
Glass fibre (option)
ST type connector (option)
1.3 Transmission speed
User setting: 9600 or 19200 bit/s
364
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
2. Application Layer
COMMON ADDRESS of ASDU
One COMMON ADDRESS OF ASDU (identical with station address)
3. List of Information
The following items can be customized with the original software tool IEC103 configurator.
(For details, refer to IEC103 configurator manual No.6F2S0839.)
-
Items for Time-tagged message: Type ID(1/2), INF, FUN, Transmission condition(Signal
number), COT
Items for Measurands: Type ID(3/9), INF, FUN, Number of measurand, Type of
measurand quantities
Common setting
Transmission cycle of Measurand frame
FUN of System function
Test mode, etc.
CAUTION: To be effective the setting data written via the RS232C, turn off the DC supply of
the relay and turn on again.
3. 1 IEC60870-5-103 Interface
3.1.1 Spontaneous events
The events created by the relay will be sent using Function type (FUN) / Information numbers
(INF) to the IEC60870-5-103 master station.
3.1.2 General interrogation
The GI request can be used to read the status of the relay, the Function types and Information
numbers that will be returned during the GI cycle are shown in the table below.
For details, refer to the standard IEC60870-5-103 section 7.4.3.
3.1.3 Cyclic measurements
The relay will produce measured values using Type ID=3 or 9 on a cyclical basis, this can be read
from the relay using a Class 2 poll. The rate at which the relay produces new measured values can
be customized.
3.1.4 Commands
The supported commands can be customized. The relay will respond to non-supported commands
with a cause of transmission (COT) of negative acknowledgement of a command.
For details, refer to the standard IEC60870-5-103 section 7.4.4.
3.1.5 Test mode
In test mode, both spontaneous messages and polled measured values, intended for processing in
the control system, are designated by means of the CAUSE OF TRANSMISSION test mode.
365
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
This means that CAUSE OF TRANSMISSION = 7 test mode is used for messages normally
transmitted with COT=1 (spontaneous) or COT=2 (cyclic).
For details, refer to the standard IEC60870-5-103 section 7.4.5.
3.1.6 Blocking of monitor direction
If the blocking of the monitor direction is activated in the protection equipment, all indications and
measurands are no longer transmitted.
For details, refer to the standard IEC60870-5-103 section 7.4.6.
3.2 List of Information
The followings are the default settings.
366
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
List of Information
IEC103 Configurator Default setting
INF
Description
Contents
GI Type
ID
COT
FUN
DPI
Signal No. OFF ON
--
10
255
--
--
--
Time Synchronization
--
255
--
--
--
Reset FCB
--
192
--
--
--
Reset CU
Reset CU ACK
--
192
--
--
--
Start/Restart
Relay start/restart
--
192
--
--
--
Power On
--
--
--
Not supported
Status Indications
16 Auto-recloser active
17 Teleprotection active
18 Protection active
19 LED reset
20 Monitor direction blocked
21 Test mode
22 Local parameter Setting
GI
1, 9, 11, 12
192
1411
GI
1, 9, 12
192
1412
GI
1, 9, 12
192
1413
--
1, 11, 12
192
1409
--
GI
9, 11
192
1241
GI
9, 11
192
1242
Not supported
23 Characteristic1
GI
1, 9, 11, 12
192
1243
24 Characteristic2
GI
1, 9, 11, 12
192
1244
25 Characteristic3
GI
1, 9, 11, 12
192
1245
26 Characteristic4
GI
1, 9, 11, 12
192
1246
27 Auxiliary input1
Binary input 1
No set
28 Auxiliary input2
Binary input 2
No set
29 Auxiliary input3
Binary input 3
No set
30 Auxiliary input4
Binary input 4
No set
Supervision Indications
32 Measurand supervision I
GI
1, 9
192
1267
33 Measurand supervision V
GI
1, 9
192
1268
GI
1, 9
192
1269
Not supported
37 I>>backup operation
Not supported
38 VT fuse failure
VT failure
39 Teleprotection disturbed
GI
1, 9
Not supported
192
226
46 Group warning
Only alarming
GI
1, 9
192
1258
47 Group alarm
GI
1, 9
192
1252
No set
49 Earth Fault L2
No set
50 Earth Fault L3
No set
Not supported
Not supported
367
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Description
Contents
GI
Type
ID
COT
FUN
DPI
Signal NO. OFF ON
Fault Indications
64
Start/pick-up L1
No set
65
Start/pick-up L2
No set
66
Start/pick-up L3
No set
67
Start/pick-up N
68
General trip
Any trip
69
Trip L1
No set
70
Trip L2
No set
71
Trip L3
No set
72
Trip I>>(back-up)
Back up trip
No set
No set
--
--
192
73
Fault location
74
Fault forward/line
Forward fault
Not supported
192
75
Fault reverse/Busbar
Reverse fault
Not supported
76
Teleprotection Signal
transmitted
Not supported
1280
--
1048
--
--
92
--
77
Not supported
78
Zone1
Zone 1 trip
Not supported
79
Zone2
Zone 2 trip
Not supported
80
Zone3
Zone 3 trip
Not supported
81
Zone4
Zone 4 trip
Not supported
82
Zone5
Zone 5 trip
Not supported
83
Zone6
Zone 6 trip
Not supported
84
General Start/Pick-up
85
Breaker Failure
86
Not supported
87
Not supported
88
Not supported
89
90
Trip I>
--
192
114
--
91
Trip I>>
--
192
113
--
92
Trip IN>
--
192
117
--
93
Trip IN>>
--
192
115
--
--
192
177
--
121
No set
--
192
Not supported
Autoreclose indications
128
CB 'ON' by Autoreclose
129
CB 'ON' by long-time
Autoreclose
130
Autoreclose Blocked
Not supported
Autoreclose block
GI
Tbl
73
short
Coeff
0.1
368
1, 9
192
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Description
Contents
GI
Type
COT
ID
FUN
Max. No.
Measurands
144 Measurand I
<meaurand I>
No
<meaurand I>
No
<meaurand I>
No
<meaurand I>
No
148
--
2, 7
192
Generic Function
240 Read Headings
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
Tbl
Limit
Coeff
Lower
Upper
Ia
36
short
4096
3.41333
Ib
40
short
4096
3.41333
Ic
44
short
4096
3.41333
Va
short
4096
0.26877
Vb
short
4096
0.26877
Vc
short
4096
0.26877
long
-4096
4096
0.00071661
12
long
-4096
4096
0.00071661
16
short
4096
0.34133
369
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
INF
Description
Contents
Control
direction
Type
ID
COT
FUN
--
255
--
255
192
Time synchronization
General commands
16
Auto-recloser on/off
ON/OFF
20
20
17
Teleprotection on/off
ON/OFF
20
20
192
18
Protection on/off
(*1)
ON/OFF
20
20
192
19
LED reset
ON
20
20
192
23
Activate characteristic 1
Setting Group 1
ON
20
20
192
24
Activate characteristic 2
Setting Group 2
ON
20
20
192
25
Activate characteristic 3
Setting Group 3
ON
20
20
192
26
Activate characteristic 4
Setting Group 4
ON
20
20
192
Generic functions
Read headings of all defined
240
groups
Read values or attributes of all
241
entries of one group
Read directory of a single
243
entry
Read values or attributes of a
244
single entry
General Interrogation of
245
generic data
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
(1) Note: While the relay receives the "Protection off" command, " IN SERVICE LED" is off.
INF
Sig off
Sig on
16
2684
2684
17
2685
2685
18
2686
2686
19
2688
200
23
2640
1000
24
2641
1000
25
2642
1000
26
2643
1000
Rev
Valid time
0
0
0
: signal reverse
370
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Description
Contents
GRL100 supported
Yes
Yes
Disturbance data
No
Generic services
No
Private data
Yes
Miscellaneous
Max. MVAL = rated
value times
Measurand
Current L1
Ia
Configurable
Current L2
Ib
Configurable
Current L3
Ic
Configurable
Voltage L1-E
Va
Configurable
Voltage L2-E
Vb
Configurable
Voltage L3-E
Vc
Configurable
Active power P
Configurable
Reactive power Q
Configurable
Frequency f
Configurable
Voltage L1 - L2
Vab
Configurable
371
Comment
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
[Legend]
GI: General Interrogation (refer to IEC60870-5-103 section 7.4.3)
Type ID: Type Identification (refer to IEC60870-5-103 section 7.2.1)
1 : time-tagged message
2 : time-tagged message with relative time
3 : measurands I
4 : time-tagged measurands with relative time
5 : identification
6 : time synchronization
8 : general interrogation termination
9 : measurands II
10: generic data
11: generic identification
20: general command
23: list of recorded disturbances
26: ready for transmission for disturbance data
27: ready for transmission of a channel
28: ready for transmission of tags
29: transmission of tags
30: transmission of disturbance values
31: end of transmission
COT: Cause of Transmission (refer to IEC60870-5-103 section 7.2.3)
1: spontaneous
2: cyclic
3: reset frame count bit (FCB)
4: reset communication unit (CU)
5: start / restart
6: power on
7: test mode
8: time synchronization
9: general interrogation
10: termination of general interrogation
11: local operation
12: remote operation
20: positive acknowledgement of command
21: negative acknowledgement of command
31: transmission of disturbance data
40: positive acknowledgement of generic write command
41: negative acknowledgement of generic write command
42: valid data response to generic read command
43: invalid data response to generic read command
44: generic write confirmation
FUN: Function type (refer to IEC60870-5-103 section 7.2.5.1)
DPI: Double-point Information (refer to IEC60870-5-103 section 7.2.6.5)
DCO: Double Command (refer to IEC60870-5-103 section 7.2.6.4)
372
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
_01.csv
Second draft:
_02.csv
Third draft:
_03.csv
Revision number
The name is recommended to be able to discriminate the relay type such as GRZ100 or
GRL100, etc. The setting files remark field of IEC103 is able to enter up to 12 one-byte
characters. It is utilized for control of IEC103 setting data.
373
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Troubleshooting
No.
Phenomena
Supposed causes
Check / Confirmation
Object
Communication
trouble (IEC103
communication is
not available.)
Procedure
BCU
RY
BCU
BCU
RY
RY
PRTCL1
=HDLC
PRTCL1
=IEC
COM1 (CH1)
HDLC
IEC
COM2 (CH2)
IEC
Cable
Converter
BCU
cable
BCU
BCU
374
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
No.
Phenomena
Supposed causes
Check / Confirmation
Object
Time can be
synchronised with
IEC103
communication.
Procedure
RY
RY
RY
RY
BCU
RY
SAS
375
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
376
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Appendix R
Failed Module Tracing and Replacement
377
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Procedure
Countermeasure
No
No
No failure
Not displayed
Press [VIEW] key
Yes
Yes
Press [VIEW] key
Not displayed
Contact the vendor.
DC supply OFF
Module replacement
As shown in the table, some of the messages cannot
identify the fault location definitely but suggest plural
possible failure locations. In these cases, the failure
location is identified by replacing the suggested
failed modules with spare modules one by one until
the "ALARM" LED is turned off.
DC supply ON
No
ALARM LED OFF?
End
378
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Table R-1 LCD Message and Failure Location
Message
Failure location
VCT
SPM
(GCOM)
Checksum err
ROM-RAM err
SRAM err
BU-RAM err
DPRAM err
EEPROM err
A/D err
IO1
or
IO8(*)
IO2
IO3,
IO5,
IO6
IO4
FD
HMI
Channel
Disconnector
AC
cable
V0 err
(2)
(1)
(2)
V2 err
(2)
(1)
(2)
I0 err
(2)
(1)
(2)
Id err
(2)
(1)
(2)
CT err
(2)
(2)
(1)
Sampling err
DIO err
(2)
(1)
RSM err
(2)
(1)
COM_ .err
(1)
(1)
(1)
FD: err
(2)
(1)
(1)
(2)
(1)
(1)
DS fail
(2)
(2)
(2)*
(2)*
(2)*
(1)*
(2)*
(2)*
(2)*
(1)*
(1)*
(2)*
(2)*
(1)*
(2)*
(2)*
(2)*
(1)*
(2)*
(2)*
(2)*
(1)*
(2)*
(1)*
(2)*
(1)*
CT fail
(2)
No-working of LCD
(1)
(2)
(1)
(2)
(1)
379
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
CAUTION
After replacing the SPM and/or FD modules, check all of the settings including
the data related the PLC and IEC103, etc. are restored the original settings.
Hazardous voltage may remain in the DC circuit just after switching off the
DC power supply. It takes about 30 seconds for the voltage to discharge.
380
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
5). Unplug the cables.
Unplug the ribbon cable running among the modules by nipping the catch (in case of black
connector) and by pushing the catch outside (in case of gray connector) on the connector.
Gray connector
Black connector
SPM module
Supply DC power after checking that all the modules are in their original
positions and the ribbon cables are plugged in. If the ribbon cables are not
plugged in enough (especially the gray connectors), the module could suffer
damage.
Details of the gray connector on modules (top side)
Not enough
381
Enough
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
9). Lamp Test
Checking the IN SERVICE LED light on and ALARM LED light off.
382
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Appendix S
PLC Setting Sample
383
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
PLC setting sample for autoreclosing (UARCSW application)
If the follower Terminal is reclosed after checking the leader Terminal reclosed in the autoreclose
mode SPAR, the leader Terminal is assigned to the signal number 1 with signal name
CONSTANT_1 and the follower Terminal assigned to the signal number 498 with signal name
3PLL as shown in Figure S-1.
TSPR1
t
0
TW1
&
Single-phase trip
&
&
[ARC-M]
+
"SPAR", "SPAR & TPAR"
0.01-10s
0.1 - 10s
ARC
1824 SPR.L-REQ
ARC
(For Leader CB)
&
[ARC-M]
MSARC
+
"MPAR2", "MPAR3"
CONSTANT 1
Leader Terminal
TSPR1
t
0
TW1
&
Single-phase trip
&
0.01-10s
[ARC-M]
+
"SPAR", "SPAR & TPAR"
No-Link & Single-phase trip
&
0.1 - 10s
ARC
(For Leader CB)
ARC
1824 SPR.L-REQ
&
[ARC-M]
MSARC
+
"MPAR2", "MPAR3"
3PLL
Follower Terminal
Figure S-1
In this case, the reclosing condition of [SPR.L-REQ] is the difference between the leader Terminal
and the follower Terminal. If the same setting is required for the reclosing condition of
[SPR.L-REQ], set the PLC using the [UARCSW] described in 2.10.2 as follows:
TSPR1
t
0
&
TW1
&
0.01-10s
"3PLL"
&
0.1 - 10s
ARC
(For Leader CB)
ARC
1824 SPR.L-REQ
"P1"
[UARCSW]
+
"P2"
MSARC
Figure S-2
384
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Appendix T
Ordering
385
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Ordering
1. Line Differential Protection Relay
a. Two-terminal application
GRL100
Relay Type:
Line differential protection relay
Relay Model:
-Model100: No autoreclose
18 BIs, 13 BOs, 6 trip BOs
18 BIs, 23 BOs, 6 trip BOs
-Model200: With autoreclose for single breaker scheme
25 BIs, 19 BOs, 6 trip BOs
28 BIs, 37 BOs, 6 trip BOs
22 BIs (12-independent), 19 BOs, 3 trip BOs
25 BIs (12-independent), 37 BOs, 3 trip BOs
-Model300: With autoreclose for one and a half breaker scheme
25 BIs, 19 BOs, 6 trip BOs
28 BIs, 37 BOs, 6 trip BOs
-Model400: With autoreclose for single breaker scheme
/ with fault detector
28 BIs, 31 BOs, 6 trip BOs
-Model500: With autoreclose for one and a half breaker scheme
/ with fault detector
28 BIs, 31 BOs, 6 trip BOs
28 BIs, 31 BOs, 6 trip BOs
Ratings:
1A, 50Hz, 110V/125Vdc
1A, 60Hz, 110V/125Vdc
5A, 50Hz, 110V/125Vdc
5A, 60Hz, 110V/125Vdc
1A, 50Hz, 220V/250Vdc
1A, 60Hz, 220V/250Vdc
5A, 50Hz, 220V/250Vdc
5A, 60Hz, 220V/250Vdc
1A, 50Hz, 48V/54V/60Vdc
1A, 60Hz, 48V/54V/60Vdc
5A, 50Hz, 48V/54V/60Vdc
5A, 60Hz, 48V/54V/60Vdc
1A, 50Hz, 24V/30Vdc
1A, 60Hz, 24V/30Vdc
5A, 50Hz, 24V/30Vdc
5A, 60Hz, 24V/30Vdc
Differential relay communication interface:
Electrical interface (CCITT-G703-1.2.1)
Electrical interface (CCITT-G703-1.2.2 or 1.2.3)
Optical interface(Short wavelength light: GI: 2km class)
Optical interface(Long wavelength light: SM: 30km class)
Optical interface(Long wavelength light: DSF: 80km class)
Electrical interface (RS530, X.21)
Communications:
RS485
Dual RS485
Dual Fibre optic (for model 202, 206, 302, 401, 501,503)
RS485 + Fibre optic (for model 202, 206, 302, 401, 501,503)
GRL100
101
102
201
202
204
206
301
302
401
501
503
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
1
2
3
6
7
9
1
3
4
9
0
1
None
J
Terminal A
GRL100
386
Terminal B
Communication route
GRL100
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
b. Three-terminal application
GRL100
Relay Type:
Line differential protection relay
Relay Model:
-Model100: No autoreclose
18 BIs, 13 BOs, 6 trip BOs
18 BIs, 23 BOs, 6 trip BOs
-Model200: With autoreclose for single breaker scheme
25 BIs, 19 BOs, 6 trip BOs
28 BIs, 37 BOs, 6 trip BOs
22 BIs (12-independent), 19 BOs, 3 trip BOs
25 BIs (12-independent), 37 BOs, 3 trip BOs
-Model300: With autoreclose for one and a half breaker scheme
25 BIs, 19 BOs, 6 trip BOs
28 BIs, 37 BOs, 6 trip BOs
-Model400: With autoreclose for single breaker scheme
/ with fault detector
28 BIs, 31 BOs, 6 trip BOs
-Model500: With autoreclose for one and a half breaker scheme
/ with fault detector
28 BIs, 31 BOs, 6 trip BOs
28 BIs, 31 BOs, 6 trip BOs
Ratings:
1A, 50Hz, 110V/125Vdc
1A, 60Hz, 110V/125Vdc
5A, 50Hz, 110V/125Vdc
5A, 60Hz, 110V/125Vdc
1A, 50Hz, 220V/250Vdc
1A, 60Hz, 220V/250Vdc
5A, 50Hz, 220V/250Vdc
5A, 60Hz, 220V/250Vdc
1A, 50Hz, 48V/54V/60Vdc
1A, 60Hz, 48V/54V/60Vdc
5A, 50Hz, 48V/54V/60Vdc
5A, 60Hz, 48V/54V/60Vdc
1A, 50Hz, 24V/30Vdc
1A, 60Hz, 24V/30Vdc
5A, 50Hz, 24V/30Vdc
5A, 60Hz, 24V/30Vdc
Differential relay communication interface:
Electrical interface (CCITT-G703-1.2.1) x 2
Electrical interface (CCITT-G703-1.2.2 or 1.2.3) x 2
Optical interface(Short wavelength light: GI: 2km class) x 2
Optical interface(Long wavelength light: SM: 30km class) x 2
Optical interface(Long wavelength light: DSF: 80km class) x 2
Electrical interface (RS530, X.21) x 2
Optical I/F (2km class) + Optical I/F (30km class)
Optical I/F (2km class) + Optical I/F (80km class)
Communications:
RS485
Dual RS485
Dual Fibre optic (for model 212, 216, 312, 411, 511,513)
RS485 + Fibre optic (for model 212, 216, 312, 411, 511,513)
GRL100
111
112
211
212
214
216
311
312
411
511
513
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
1
2
3
6
7
9
G
H
1
3
4
9
0
1
None
J
Terminal B
Terminal A
GRL100
Communication route #1
Communication route #2
387
GRL100
GRL100
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
2. Optical Interface Unit (Option)
G1IF1
Type:
Communication interface box
G1IF1
Model:
For X21 ()
For CCITT-G703-1.2.1
For CCITT-G703-1.2.2 or 1.2.3
For X21
01
02
03
04
01
02
03
Note (): With Outer case. For details, see the G1IF1 instruction manual.
388
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Version-up Records
Version
No.
0.0
0.1
0.2
Date
May. 19, 2005
Jul. 12, 2005
Jul. 25, 2005
0.3
0.4
2.2.9
2.6
3.3.4
3.3.10
6.7.2
Appendices
2.2.13
2.12.3
3.3.6
Appendices
2. 2.13
1.4
3.2.1
Appendices
2.10.2
1.5
1.6
1.7
1.8
1.9
2.0
Revised Section
Appendices
2.10.2.1
2.10.2.2
2.10.2.3
3.1.5
4.2.6.7
Appendices
2.2.7.1
2.2.9
2.2.13
2.12.1
2.12.2
3.3.6
3.3.10.1
Appendices
4.1.2
4.2.6.4
4.2.6.6
Appendices
2.2.13
Appendices
2.2.8
3.1.5
3.3.2
4.1.1
4.2.1
4.2.4.1
4.2.6.10
Appendices
4.2.4.6
4.4
5.5
6.7.2
Appendices
Contents
First issue.
Added Section 2.2.9 Blind Zone Protection.
Added the description (Note).
Added Section 3.3.4.
Modified Table 3.3.10.1.
Modified Table 6.7.2.1.
Modified Appendix B, H, P and R.
Modified the setting range table and the Setting of TDSV, TCDT1 and TCDT2.
Modified the description and Figure 2.12.3.1, and deleted Figure 2.12.3.4.
Modified the description.
Modified Appendix S.
Modified the setting range table and the description, and added the Setting of
T.SFT1, T.SFT2, B.SYN1 and B.SYN2.
Modified Tables 3.2.1.2 and 3.2.1.3.
Corrected the terminal No. in Appendix G (206B).
Modified the description and Figures 2.10.2.1, 2.10.2.3 and 2.10.2.9, and
added Figure 2.10.2.8.
Modified Appendix B, H and M.
Modified the description and Figure 2.10.2.1.
Modified the description and Figure 2.10.2.8.
Modified the setting range table.
Modified the description.
Modified the LCD sample screen (Scheme switch).
Modified the Appendix B and H, and added Appendix S. (Old Appendix S T)
Modified the description.
Modified the description.
Modified the description of setting range table and TDSV, TCDT1 and TCDT2
setting.
Modified the description.
Modified the description and Figure 2.12.2.1.
Modified the description.
Modified Table 3.3.10.1.
Modified Appendix E, G, H, K and T.
Modified the description.
Modified the description of <PRTCL1>.
Modified the description.
Modified Appendix G.
Modified the description of the CT Ratio matching.
Modified Appendix T.
Modified the description and added Figure 2.2.8.1.
Modified the description of user configurable LED.
Modified the description of DC supply monitoring.
Modified the description of LED.
Modified the description of latch LED operation.
Modified the description of Note.
Modified the description.
Modified Appendix Q and R.
Modified the description.
Modified the description.
Modified the description.
Modified the description and Table 6.7.2.1.
Modified Appendix E, F, K, R, Q and T.
389
6 F 2 S 0 8 3 5
Version
No.
2.1
Date
Sep. 27, 2007
2.2
Aug. 1, 2008
2.3
2.4
2.5
2.6
2.7
Oct. 7, 2010
Revised Section
2.10.2.2
2.12.2
4.2.3.1
4.2.7.5
6.7.3
Appendices
2.2.5
2.2.13
2.3
2.5
2.6
2.7
2.8
3.2.1
3.3.4
4.2.7.1
6.5.1.8
6.5.5
Appendices
Precautions
2.2.2
4.2.2
4.2.6.2
4.2.7
Appendices
Precautions
Appendices
Precautions
4.2.1
2.12.2
Appendices
2.12.2
Appendices
Contents
Modified the description and Figure 2.10.2.8.
Modified the description.
Added the description on the sample of fault record screen.
Added the description of Note.
Modified the description of CAUTION.
Modified Appendix G, K, R and T.
Modified Figure 2.2.5.2.
Modified the tables of setting range and setting depending on communication
mode.
Modified Figure 2.3.1.
Modified Figure 2.5.3.
Modified Figure 2.6.2 and the description of Note.
Modified Figure 2.7.1.
Modified Figure 2.8.1.
Modified Tables 3.2.1.2 and 3.2.1.3.
Modified Figure 3.3.4.1.
Modified the description of THMRST.
Modified Figure 6.5.1.9.
Modified the description.
Modified Appendix H and K.
Modified the description of Disposal.
Modified Figure 2.2.2.2.
Modified the description.
Modified the description. (Added password trap in Test menu.)
Modified the description.
Modified Appendix G (Added the note in Model 1*1.) and T.
Modified the description.
Modified Appendix K and T.
Modified the description.
Modified the description.
Modified the description.
Modified Appendix K and T.
Modified the description.
Modified Appendix K and T.
390